10-K
Table of Contents

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

 

 

Form 10-K

(Mark One)

 

þ ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2012

 

¨ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

Commission file Number 001-35066

 

 

IMAX Corporation

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 

Canada   98-0140269

(State or other jurisdiction of

incorporation or organization)

 

(I.R.S. Employer

Identification Number)

2525 Speakman Drive,

Mississauga, Ontario, Canada L5K 1B1

(905) 403-6500

 

110 E. 59th Street, Suite 2100

New York, New York, USA 10022

(212) 821-0100

(Address of principal executive offices, zip code, telephone numbers)

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of Each Class

 

Name of Exchange on Which Registered

Common Shares, no par value   The New York Stock Exchange

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

None

(Title of class)

 

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act    Yes  þ    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.    Yes  ¨    No  þ

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes  þ    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes  þ    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of the registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

 

Large accelerated filer   þ    Accelerated filer   ¨
Non-accelerated filer   ¨  (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)    Smaller reporting company   ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell Company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act).    Yes  ¨    No  þ

The aggregate market value of the common shares of the registrant held by non-affiliates of the registrant, computed by reference to the last sale price of such shares as of the close of trading on June 30, 2012 was $1,366.2 million (56,855,012 common shares times $24.03).

As of January 31, 2013, there were 66,591,749 common shares of the registrant outstanding.

 

 

Document Incorporated by Reference

Portions of the registrant’s definitive Proxy Statement to be filed within 120 days of the close of IMAX Corporation’s fiscal year ended December 31, 2012, with the Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant to Regulation 14A involving the election of directors and the annual meeting of the stockholders of the registrant (the “Proxy Statement”) are incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K to the extent described therein.

 

 

 


Table of Contents

IMAX CORPORATION

December 31, 2012

Table of Contents

 

         Page  

PART I

  

Item 1.

  Business      4   

Item 1A.

  Risk Factors      18   

Item 1B.

  Unresolved Staff Comments      26   

Item 2.

  Properties      26   

Item 3.

  Legal Proceedings      27   

Item 4.

  Mine Safety Disclosures      28   

PART II

  

Item 5.

  Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities      29   

Item 6.

  Selected Financial Data      33   

Item 7.

  Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations      38   

Item 7A.

  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk      75   

Item 8.

  Financial Statements and Supplementary Data      77   

Item 9.

  Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure      135   

Item 9A.

  Controls and Procedures      135   

Item 9B.

  Other Information      135   

PART III

  

Item 10.

  Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance      136   

Item 11.

  Executive Compensation      136   

Item 12.

  Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters      136   

Item 13.

  Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence      136   

Item 14.

  Principal Accounting Fees and Services      136   

PART IV

  

Item 15.

  Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules      136   

Signatures

     139   

 

2


Table of Contents

IMAX CORPORATION

EXCHANGE RATE DATA

Unless otherwise indicated, all dollar amounts in this document are expressed in United States (“U.S.”) dollars. The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, certain exchange rates based on the noon buying rate in the City of New York for cable transfers in foreign currencies as certified for customs purposes by the Bank of Canada (the “Noon Buying Rate”). Such rates quoted are the number of U.S. dollars per one Canadian dollar and are the inverse of rates quoted by the Bank of Canada for Canadian dollars per U.S. $1.00. The average exchange rate is based on the average of the exchange rates on the last day of each month during such periods. The Noon Buying Rate on December 31, 2012 was U.S. $1.0051.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011      2010      2009      2008  

Exchange rate at end of period

     1.0051        0.9833        1.0054        0.9555        0.8170  

Average exchange rate during period

     1.0006        1.0151        0.9709        0.8757        0.9381  

High exchange rate during period

     1.0299        1.0583        1.0054        0.9716        1.0291  

Low exchange rate during period

     0.9599        0.9430        0.9278        0.7692        0.7710  

SPECIAL NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING INFORMATION

Certain statements included in this annual report may constitute “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the United States Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. These forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to, references to future capital expenditures (including the amount and nature thereof), business and technology strategies and measures to implement strategies, competitive strengths, goals, expansion and growth of business, operations and technology, plans and references to the future success of IMAX Corporation together with its wholly-owned subsidiaries (the “Company”) and expectations regarding the Company’s future operating, financial and technological results. These forward-looking statements are based on certain assumptions and analyses made by the Company in light of its experience and its perception of historical trends, current conditions and expected future developments, as well as other factors it believes are appropriate in the circumstances. However, whether actual results and developments will conform with the expectations and predictions of the Company is subject to a number of risks and uncertainties, including, but not limited to, general economic, market or business conditions; the opportunities (or lack thereof) that may be presented to and pursued by the Company; the performance of IMAX DMR films; competitive actions by other companies; conditions in the in-home and out-of-home entertainment industries; the signing of theater system agreements; changes in laws or regulations; conditions, changes and developments in the commercial exhibition industry; the failure to convert theater system backlog into revenue; risks associated with investments and operations in foreign jurisdictions and any future international expansion, including those related to economic, political and regulatory policies of local governments and laws and policies of the United States and Canada; risks related to the Company’s growth and operations in China; the failure to respond to change and advancements in digital technology; risks related to the acquisition of AMC Entertainment Holdings, Inc. by Dalian Wanda Group Co., Ltd.; risks related to new business initiatives; the potential impact of increased competition in the markets within which the Company operates; risks related to the Company’s inability to protect the Company’s intellectual property; risks related to Eastman Kodak bankruptcy and the possibility of constrained analog film supply; risks related to the Company’s implementation of a new enterprise resource planning system; risks related to the Company’s prior restatements and the related litigation; and other factors, many of which are beyond the control of the Company. Consequently, all of the forward-looking statements made in this annual report are qualified by these cautionary statements, and actual results or anticipated developments by the Company may not be realized, and even if substantially realized, may not have the expected consequences to, or effects on, the Company. The Company undertakes no obligation to update publicly or otherwise revise any forward-looking information, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise.

 

 

IMAX®, IMAX® Dome, IMAX® 3D, IMAX® 3D Dome, Experience It In IMAX®, The IMAX Experience®, An IMAX Experience®, An IMAX 3D Experience®, IMAX DMR®, DMR®, IMAX think big®, think big® and IMAX Is Believing are trademarks and trade names of the Company or its subsidiaries that are registered or otherwise protected under laws of various jurisdictions.

 

3


Table of Contents

PART I

 

Item 1. Business

GENERAL

IMAX Corporation, together with its wholly-owned subsidiaries (the “Company”), is one of the world’s leading entertainment technology companies, specializing in motion picture technologies and presentations. The Company’s principal businesses are the design and manufacture of premium theater systems (“IMAX theater systems”) and the sale, lease or contribution of those systems to customers under theater arrangements and the Digital Re-Mastering of films into the IMAX format and the exhibition of those films in the IMAX theater network.

IMAX theater systems are based on proprietary and patented technology developed over the course of the Company’s 45-year history. The Company’s customers who purchase, lease or otherwise acquire the IMAX theater systems are theater exhibitors that operate commercial theaters (particularly multiplexes), museums, science centers, or destination entertainment sites. The Company generally does not own IMAX theaters, but licenses the use of its trademarks to exhibitors along with the sale, lease or contribution of its equipment. The Company refers to all theaters using the IMAX theater system as “IMAX theaters.”

IMAX theater systems combine:

 

   

IMAX DMR (Digital Re-Mastering) movie conversion technology, which results in higher image and sound fidelity than conventional cinema experiences;

 

   

advanced, high-resolution projectors with specialized equipment and automated theater control systems, which generate significantly more contrast and brightness than conventional theater systems;

 

   

large screens and proprietary theater geometry, which result in a substantially larger field of view so that the screen extends to the edge of a viewer’s peripheral vision and creates more realistic images;

 

   

sound system components, which deliver more expansive sound imagery and pinpointed origination of sound to any specific spot in an IMAX theater; and

 

   

specialized theater acoustics, which result in a four-fold reduction in background noise.

The combination of these components causes audiences in IMAX theaters to feel as if they are a part of the on-screen action, creating a more intense, immersive and exciting experience than in a traditional theater. In addition, the Company’s IMAX 3D theater systems combine the same theater systems with 3D images that further enhance the audience’s feeling of being immersed in the film.

As a result of the immersiveness and superior image and sound quality of The IMAX Experience, the Company’s exhibitor customers typically charge a premium for IMAX DMR films over films exhibited in their other auditoriums. The premium pricing, combined with the higher attendance levels associated with IMAX, generates incremental box office for the Company’s exhibitor customers and for the movie studios releasing their films to the IMAX network. The incremental box office generated by IMAX DMR films has helped establish IMAX as a key premium distribution and marketing platform for Hollywood blockbuster films, which is separate and distinct from their wider theatrical release.

The Company believes the IMAX theater network is the most extensive premium theater network in the world with 731 theater systems (617 commercial, 114 institutional) operating in 53 countries as at December 31, 2012. This compares to 634 theater systems (517 commercial, 117 institutional) operating in 50 countries as at December 31, 2011. The success of the Company’s digital and joint revenue sharing strategies and the strength of its film slate has enabled the Company’s theater network to expand significantly, with the Company’s overall network increasing by 144.5% and the Company’s commercial network increasing by 245% from the beginning of 2008. In 2012 and 2011, the Company signed theater agreements for 142 and 209 systems, respectively, which is expected to drive additional growth in 2013 and thereafter.

The Company has identified approximately 1,700 IMAX zones worldwide. The Company believes that these zones present the potential for the IMAX theater network to grow significantly from the 598 commercial multiplex IMAX theaters operating as of December 31, 2012. While the Company continues to grow domestically, particularly in small to mid-tier markets, it believes that the majority of its future growth will come from underpenetrated international markets. In 2012, 63.6% of the Company’s 121 new theater signings were for theaters in international markets. Key international growth markets include Greater China (which includes the People’s Republic of China, Hong Kong, Taiwan and Macau), India, Latin America (which includes South America, Central America and Mexico) and Eastern and Western Europe.

 

4


Table of Contents

During 2011, the Company formed IMAX (Shanghai) Multimedia Technology Co., Ltd. (“IMAX China”), a wholly-owned subsidiary, to enable further growth in Greater China, the Company’s second-largest and fastest-growing market. The Company believes that favorable market trends in China, including government initiatives to foster cinema screen growth, to increase the number of Hollywood films distributed in China (particularly IMAX and 3D films), and to support the film industry, present opportunities for additional growth, though the Company cautions that its expansion in China faces a number of challenges. See Risk Factors – “The Company faces risks in connection with the continued expansion of its business in China” in Item 1A. In March 2011, the Company announced a 75-theater joint revenue sharing arrangement with Wanda Cinema Line Corporation, China’s largest cinema chain (“Wanda”). The agreement with Wanda, which represents IMAX’s largest single international joint revenue sharing arrangement to date, brings the total number of IMAX theaters open or in backlog in Greater China to 250. As at December 31, 2012, IMAX China had offices in Shanghai and Beijing and a total of 51 employees. On February 18, 2012, the U.S. and Chinese governments announced the terms of an agreement to expand the number of Hollywood films to be released in China to include 14 additional IMAX or 3D format films and to permit distributors to receive higher distribution fees. The Company believes this is a positive development for its business in China and elsewhere.

Over the years, several technological breakthroughs have established IMAX as an important distribution platform for Hollywood’s biggest event films. These include:

 

   

DMR — IMAX’s proprietary DMR technology digitally converts live-action 35mm or digital films to its large-format, while meeting the Company’s high standards of image and sound quality. In a typical IMAX DMR film arrangement, the Company will receive a percentage, which generally ranges from 10-15%, of net box-office receipts of a film from the film studio in exchange for the conversion of the film to the IMAX DMR format and for access to the IMAX distribution platform. At December 31, 2012, the Company had released 119 IMAX DMR films since the introduction of IMAX DMR in 2002. As digital technology has been introduced to the DMR process and improvements have been made in the conversion time, and as the Company’s relationships with the major Hollywood studios have become increasingly strong, the number of films released on an annual basis that have been converted through the DMR process has increased as well. Accordingly, 35 films converted through the IMAX DMR process were released in 2012, as compared to 25 in 2011 and 4 in 2005.

 

   

IMAX Digital Projection System — The Company introduced its digital xenon projection system in 2008. Prior to 2008, all of IMAX’s large format projectors were film-based and required analog film prints. The IMAX digital projection system, which operates without the need for such film prints, was designed specifically for use by commercial multiplex operators and allows operators to reduce the capital and operating costs required to run an IMAX theater without sacrificing the image and sound quality of The IMAX Experience. By making The IMAX Experience more accessible for commercial multiplex operators, the introduction of the IMAX digital projection system paved the way for a number of important joint revenue sharing arrangements which have allowed the Company to rapidly expand its theater network. Since announcing that the Company was developing digital projection technology, the vast majority of the Company’s theater system signings have been for digital systems. As at December 31, 2012, the Company has signed agreements for 831 digital xenon systems since 2007 (including the upgrade of film-based systems), 136 of which were signed in 2012 alone. As at December 31, 2012, 564 IMAX digital xenon projection systems were in operation, an increase of 27.3% over the 443 digital projection systems in operation as at December 31, 2011.

As one of the world’s leading entertainment technology companies, the Company strives to remain at the forefront of advancements in cinema technology. Accordingly, one of the Company’s key near-term initiatives is the development of a next-generation laser-based digital projection system. In 2011, the Company announced the completion of a deal in which it secured certain exclusive license rights to a portfolio of intellectual property in the digital cinema field owned by the Eastman Kodak Company (“Kodak”). The transaction involves rights to technology related to laser projection as well as rights in the digital cinema field to a broader range of Kodak technology. On February 7, 2012, the Company announced an agreement with Barco N.V. (“Barco”) to co-develop a laser-based digital projection system that incorporates Kodak technology. The Company believes that these arrangements with Kodak and Barco will enable IMAX projectors to present greater brightness and clarity, a wider color gamut and deeper blacks, and consume less power and last longer than existing digital technology. The Company believes that a laser projection solution, which it plans to begin rolling out in the second half of 2014, will allow IMAX’s network to show the highest quality digital content available and provide the Company the ability to illuminate the largest screens in its network, which are currently film-based. In addition to its laser-based projection initiative, during 2012, the Company has re-invested in its brand with a consumer brand marketing campaign that encompassed social media, in-theater marketing and Internet advertising. Finally, the Company remains focused on growing its theater network, particularly, in key international territories such as Greater China, India, Latin America and Eastern and Western Europe.

In addition to the design and manufacture of premium theater systems, the Company is also engaged in the production and distribution of original large-format films, the provision of services in support of the IMAX theater network, the provision of post-production services for large-format films, the operation of four IMAX theaters and, from time-to-time the conversion of two-

 

5


Table of Contents

dimensional (“2D”) and three-dimensional (“3D”) Hollywood feature films for exhibition on IMAX theater systems around the world. IMAX Corporation, a Canadian corporation, was formed in March 1994 as a result of an amalgamation between WGIM Acquisition Corp. and the former IMAX Corporation (“Predecessor IMAX”). Predecessor IMAX was incorporated in 1967.

PRODUCT LINES

The Company believes it is the world’s largest designer and manufacturer of specialty premium projection and sound system components for large-format theaters around the world, as well as a significant producer and distributor of large-format films. The Company’s theater systems include specialized IMAX projectors, advanced sound systems and specialty screens. The Company derives its revenues from:

 

   

IMAX theater systems (design, manufacture, sale or lease of, and provision of services related to, its theater systems);

 

   

Films (production and digital re-mastering of films, the distribution of film products to the IMAX theater network, post-production and print services for films);

 

   

Joint revenue sharing arrangements (the provision of its theater system to an exhibitor in exchange for a certain percentage of theater revenue and, in some cases, a small upfront or initial payment);

 

   

Theater system maintenance (the use of maintenance services related to its theater systems); and

 

   

Other activities, which include theater operations (owning equipment, operating, managing or participating in the revenues of IMAX theaters), the sale of after-market parts and camera rentals.

Segmented information is provided in note 20 to the accompanying audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8.

IMAX Systems, Theater System Maintenance and Joint Revenue Sharing Arrangements

The Company’s primary products are its theater systems. The Company’s digital projection systems include a projector that offers superior image quality and stability and a digital theater control system, a 6-channel, digital audio system delivering up to 12,000 watts of sound; a screen with a proprietary coating technology, and, if applicable, 3D glasses cleaning equipment. IMAX’s digital projection system also operates without the need for analog film prints. Traditional IMAX film-based theater systems contain the same components as the digital projection systems but include a rolling loop 15/70-format projector and require the use of analog film prints. Since its introduction in 2008, the vast majority of the Company’s theater sales have been digital systems and the Company expects that nearly all of its future theater systems sales will be IMAX digital systems. Furthermore, a majority of the Company’s film-based theater systems have been upgraded, at a cost to the exhibitor, to an IMAX digital system. As part of the arrangement to sell or lease its theater systems, the Company provides extensive advice on theater planning and design and supervision of installation services. Theater systems are also leased or sold with a license for the use of the world-famous IMAX brand. Historically, IMAX theater systems come in five configurations:

 

   

the GT projection systems, film-based theater systems for the largest IMAX theaters;

 

   

the SR systems, film-based theater systems for smaller theaters than the GT systems;

 

   

the IMAX MPX systems, which are film-based systems targeted for multiplex theaters (“MPX” theater systems);

 

   

the IMAX digital systems, which are digital-based systems; and

 

   

theater systems featuring heavily curved and tilted screens that are used in dome-shaped theaters.

The GT, SR, IMAX MPX and IMAX digital systems are “flat” screens that have a minimum of curvature and tilt and can exhibit both 2D and 3D films, while the screen components in dome shaped theaters are 2D only and are popular with the Company’s institutional clients. All IMAX theaters, with the exception of dome configurations, feature a steeply inclined floor to provide each audience member with a clear view of the screen. The Company holds patents on the geometrical design of IMAX theaters.

The Company’s film-based projectors use the largest commercially available film format (15-perforation film frame, 70mm), which is nearly 10 times larger than conventional film (4-perforation film frame, 35mm) and therefore are able to project significantly more detail on a larger screen. The Company believes these projectors, which utilize the Company’s rolling loop technology, are unsurpassed in their ability to project film with maximum steadiness and clarity with minimal film wear, while substantially enhancing the quality of the projected image. As a result, the Company’s projectors deliver a higher level of clarity and detail as compared to conventional movies and competing projectors in order to compete and evolve with the market.

 

6


Table of Contents

The Company’s digital projection system provides a premium and differentiated experience to moviegoers that is consistent with what they have come to expect from the IMAX brand, while providing for the compelling economics and flexibility that digital technology affords. The relatively low cost of a digital file delivery (approximately $200 per movie per system compared to $20 thousand per 2D print and $45 thousand per 3D print for an IMAX analog film print) enables increased programming flexibility which in turn allows theaters to program significantly more IMAX DMR films per year. More programming increases customer choice and potentially increases total box-office revenue significantly. In 2012, 35 films converted through the IMAX DMR process were released to the IMAX theater network as compared to 25 in 2011 and 4 films in 2005. To date, the Company has contracted for the release of 23 DMR films to its theater network for 2013. The Company remains in active discussions with all the major studios regarding future titles for 2013 and beyond. The Company expects to announce additional local language IMAX DMR films to be released to the IMAX theater network in 2013 and beyond. Supplementing the Company’s film slate of Hollywood DMR titles with appealing local DMR titles is an important component of the Company’s international film strategy. The Company expects a similar number of films to be released to the network in 2013 as experienced in 2012. Digital systems represent 98.6% of the Company’s current backlog and 77.2% of the Company’s theater network. The Company continues to expect the vast majority of its future theater system arrangements to be for digital systems.

To complement its viewing experience, the Company provides digital sound system components which are specifically designed for IMAX theaters. These components are among the most advanced in the industry and help to heighten the realistic feeling of an IMAX presentation, thereby providing IMAX theater systems with an important competitive edge over other theater systems. The Company believes it is a world leader in the design and manufacture of digital sound system components for applications including traditional movie theaters, auditoriums and IMAX theaters.

The Company’s arrangements for theater system equipment involve either a lease or sale. As part of the purchase or lease of an IMAX theater system, the Company also advises the customer on theater design, supervises the installation of the theater systems and provides projectionists with training in using the equipment. The supervision of installation requires that the equipment also be put through a complete functional start-up and test procedure to ensure proper operation. Theater owners or operators are responsible for providing the theater location, the design and construction of the theater building, the installation of the system components and any other necessary improvements, as well as the theater’s marketing and programming. The Company’s typical arrangement also includes the trademark license rights whose term tracks the term of the underlying agreement. The theater system equipment components (including the projector, sound system, screen system, and, if applicable, 3D glasses cleaning machine), theater design support, supervision of installation, projectionist training and trademark rights are all elements of what the Company considers the system deliverable (the “System Deliverable”). For a separate fee, the Company provides ongoing maintenance and extended warranty services for the theater system. The Company’s contracts are generally denominated in U.S. dollars, except in Canada, China, Japan and parts of Europe, where contracts are sometimes denominated in local currency.

The Company offers certain commercial clients joint revenue sharing arrangements, pursuant to which the Company provides the System Deliverable in return for a portion of the customer’s IMAX box-office receipts, and in some cases, concession revenue and a small upfront or initial payment. Under these revenue sharing arrangements, the Company retains title to the theater system (including the projector, the sound system and the projection screen) and rent payments that are contingent instead of fixed or determinable. The Company has the right to remove the equipment for non-payment or other defaults by the customer. The contracts are generally non-cancellable by the customer unless the Company fails to perform its obligations. In rare cases, the contract provides certain performance thresholds that, if not met by either party, allows the other party to terminate the agreement. Generally, joint revenue sharing arrangements have 10-year initial terms that may be renewed by the customer for an additional term. By offering arrangements in which exhibitors do not need to invest the significant initial capital required of a lease or a sale arrangement, the Company has been able to expand its theater network at a significantly faster pace than it had previously. As at December 31, 2012, the Company has entered into joint revenue sharing arrangements for 453 systems with 29 partners, 316 of which were in operation as at December 31, 2012.

Leases generally have a 10-year initial term and are typically renewable by the customer for one or more additional 5 to 10-year terms. Under the terms of the typical lease agreement, the title to the theater system equipment (including the projector, the sound system and the projection screen) remains with the Company. The Company has the right to remove the equipment for non-payment or other defaults by the customer. The contracts are generally not cancelable by the customer unless the Company fails to perform its obligations.

The Company also enters into sale agreements with its customers. Under a sales agreement, the title to the theater system remains with the customer. In certain instances, however, the Company retains title or a security interest in the equipment until the customer has made all payments required under the agreement.

 

7


Table of Contents

The typical lease or sales arrangement provides for three major sources of cash flows for the Company: (i) initial fees; (ii) ongoing minimum fixed and contingent fees; and (iii) ongoing maintenance and extended warranty fees. Initial fees generally are received over the period of time from the date the arrangement is executed to the date the equipment is installed and customer acceptance has been received. However, in certain cases, the payments of the initial fee may be scheduled over a period of time after the equipment is installed and customer acceptance has been received. Ongoing minimum fixed and contingent fees and ongoing maintenance and extended warranty fees are generally received over the life of the arrangement and are usually adjusted annually based on changes in the local consumer price index. The ongoing minimum fixed and contingent fees generally provide for a fee which is the greater of a fixed amount or a certain percentage of the theater box-office. The terms of each arrangement vary according to the configuration of the theater system provided, the cinema market and the film distribution market relevant to the geographic location of the customer.

In the third quarter of 2012, Dalian Wanda Group Co., Ltd., the parent company of Wanda Cinema Line Corporation (“Wanda”), acquired AMC Entertainment Holdings, Inc. (“AMC”). Prior to this transaction, AMC and Wanda were the Company’s first and third largest customers. Under common ownership, the Wanda/AMC entity is the Company’s largest customer, representing approximately 12.2%, 14.4% and 12.2% of the Company’s total revenue in 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively. See Risk Factors — “With the acquisition of AMC by Wanda, the Company’s largest customer will account for a greater percentage of the Company’s revenue and backlog” in Item 1A.

Sales Backlog. Signed contracts for theater systems are listed as sales backlog prior to the time of revenue recognition. The value of sales backlog represents the total value of all signed theater system agreements that are expected to be recognized as revenue in the future. Sales backlog includes initial fees along with the estimated present value of contractual fixed minimum fees due over the term, however it excludes amounts allocated to maintenance and extended warranty revenues as well as fees in excess of contractual minimums that may be received in the future.

The Company’s sales backlog is as follows:

 

                                                               
     December 31, 2012      December 31, 2011  
     Number of
Systems
    Dollar Value
(in thousands)
     Number of
Systems
    Dollar Value
(in thousands)
 

Sales and sales-type lease arrangements

     139 (1)    $ 168,101         144 (1)    $ 176,184   

Joint revenue sharing arrangements

     137        31,652         119        21,516   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     276 (2)    $ 199,753         263 (2)    $ 197,700   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Includes 11 upgrades from film-based IMAX theater systems to IMAX digital theater systems (including one laser-based system in a commercial and 4 laser-based systems in institutional theaters) as at December 31, 2012, and 10 upgrades from film-based IMAX theater systems to IMAX digital theater systems as at December 31, 2011.
(2) Reflects the minimum number of theaters arising from signed contracts in backlog.

The value of sales backlog does not include revenue from theaters in which the Company has an equity-interest, operating leases, letters of intent or long-term conditional theater commitments. The value of theaters under joint revenue sharing arrangements is generally excluded from the dollar value or sales backlog, although certain theater systems under joint revenue sharing arrangements provide for contracted upfront payments and therefore carry a backlog value based these payments. The Company believes that the contractual obligations for theater system installations that are listed in sales backlog are valid and binding commitments.

 

8


Table of Contents

The following chart shows the number of the Company’s theater systems by configuration, opened theater network base and backlog as at December 31:

 

      2012     2011  
     Theater
Network
Base
     Backlog     Theater
Network
Base
     Backlog  

Flat Screen (2D)

     22        —         26        —    

Dome Screen (2D)

     61        —         60        —    

IMAX 3D Dome (3D)

     2        —         2        —    

IMAX 3D GT (3D)

     63        1       69        2  

IMAX 3D SR (3D)

     19        —         28        1  

IMAX MPX (3D)

     —          3       6        3  

IMAX Digital: Xenon (3D)

     564        267 (1)      443        257  

IMAX Digital: Laser (3D)

     —          5 (2)      —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     731        276       634        263  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) Includes 6 upgrades from film-based theater systems to digital theater systems in existing IMAX theater locations (2 commercial and 4 institutional)
(2) Backlog includes 5 upgrades to IMAX digital laser systems from IMAX digital xenon theater systems in existing IMAX theater locations (1 commercial and 4 institutional)

The Company estimates that it will install approximately 110-125 new theater systems (excluding digital upgrades) in 2013. Unlike in previous years in which the Company’s installation estimates were limited to scheduled installations from backlog, the Company now includes in its estimates not only scheduled systems from backlog, but also the Company’s estimate of installations from arrangements that will sign and install in the same calendar year. The Company cautions, however, that theater system installations slip from period to period in the course of the Company’s business, usually for reasons beyond its control.

IMAX Flat Screen and IMAX Dome Systems. There are 85 IMAX flat screen and IMAX Dome systems in the IMAX network. IMAX flat screen and IMAX Dome systems primarily reside in institutions such as museums and science centers. Flat screen IMAX theaters were introduced in 1970, while IMAX Dome theaters, which are designed for tilted dome screens, were introduced in 1973. There have been several significant proprietary and patented enhancements to these systems since their introduction.

IMAX 3D GT and IMAX 3D SR Systems. IMAX 3D theaters utilize a flat screen 3D system, which produces realistic 3D images on an IMAX screen. The Company believes that the IMAX 3D theater systems offer consumers one of the most realistic 3D experiences available today. To create the 3D effect, the audience uses either polarized or electronic glasses that separate the left-eye and right-eye images. The IMAX 3D projectors can project both 2D and 3D films, allowing theater owners the flexibility to exhibit either type of film.

In 1997, the Company launched a smaller IMAX 3D system called IMAX 3D SR, a patented theater system configuration that combines a proprietary theater design, a more automated projector and specialized sound system components to replicate the experience of a larger IMAX 3D theater in a smaller space.

As at December 31, 2012, there were 82 IMAX 3D GT and IMAX 3D SR theaters in operation compared to 97 IMAX 3D GT and IMAX 3D SR theaters in operation as at December 31, 2011. The decrease in the number of 3D GT and 3D SR systems is largely attributable to the conversion of existing 3D GT and 3D SR systems to IMAX digital systems.

IMAX MPX. In 2003, the Company launched a large-format theater system designed specifically for use in multiplex theaters. Known as IMAX MPX, this system had lower capital and operating costs than other IMAX systems and was intended to improve a multiplex owner’s financial returns and to allow for the installation of IMAX theater systems in markets that might previously not have been able to support one. As at December 31, 2012, there were no MPX systems in operation compared to 6 MPX systems as at December 31, 2011. The IMAX digital system has supplanted the MPX system as the Company’s multiplex product. The decrease in the number of MPX systems is attributable to the upgrade of existing MPX systems to IMAX digital systems.

 

9


Table of Contents

IMAX Digital: Xenon. In July 2008, the Company introduced a proprietary IMAX digital projection system that it believes delivers higher quality imagery compared with other digital systems and that is consistent with the Company’s brand. As at December 31, 2012, the Company had installed 564 digital theater systems, including 109 digital upgrades, and has an additional 267 digital systems in its backlog. Digital theater systems represent 98.6% of the total backlog and 77.2% of the total theater network, and the Company expects a majority of its future theater system arrangements to be for digital systems. Moreover, the Company believes that some of the film-based systems currently in its backlog, particularly uninstalled MPX systems, will ultimately become digital installations.

Films

Film Production and Digital Re-mastering (IMAX DMR)

In 2002, the Company developed technology that makes it possible for standard film footage to be digitally transformed into IMAX’s large-format at a current cost of roughly $800 thousand per film. This proprietary system, known as IMAX DMR, has opened up the IMAX theater network to film releases from Hollywood’s broad library of films. In a typical IMAX DMR film arrangement, the Company will receive a percentage, which generally ranges from 10-15%, of net box-office receipts of a film from the film studio in exchange for the conversion of the film to the IMAX DMR format and for access to IMAX’s premium distribution and marketing platform. The box-office performance of IMAX DMR releases has positioned IMAX theaters as a key premium distribution platform for Hollywood films, which is separate and distinct from their wider theatrical release. Factors other than the IMAX DMR format, and IMAX’s proprietary projection and sound technology, are increasingly differentiating IMAX content from other film content. For example, in July 2012, The Dark Knight Rises: The IMAX Experience, featured over an hour of footage shot with IMAX cameras, and in 2013, Star Trek: Into Darkness: An IMAX 3D Experience and The Hunger Games: Catching Fire: The IMAX Experience will feature footage shot with IMAX cameras. Furthermore, on November 8, 2012, Skyfall: The IMAX Experience was released in IMAX theaters in North America, one day earlier than its wide-release to conventional theaters, and in 2013, Oblivion: The IMAX Experience and Star Trek: Into Darkness: An IMAX 3D Experience will be released to the IMAX theater network ahead of their North American wide-releases. The Company believes that this early release strategy helps make the release of the IMAX film an event, which can help increase audience excitement and enthusiasm for a film. IMAX theaters therefore serve as an additional distribution platform for Hollywood films, just as home video and pay-per-view are ancillary distribution platforms. In some cases, the Company may also have certain distribution rights to the films produced using its IMAX DMR technology.

The IMAX DMR process involves the following:

 

   

in certain instances, scanning, at the highest possible resolution, each individual frame of the movie and converting it into a digital image;

 

   

optimizing the image using proprietary image enhancement tools;

 

   

enhancing the digital image using techniques such as sharpening, color correction, grain and noise removal and the elimination of unsteadiness and removal of unwanted artifacts;

 

   

recording the enhanced digital image onto IMAX 15/70-format film or IMAX digital cinema package (“DCP”) format; and

 

   

specially re-mastering the sound track to take full advantage of the unique sound system of IMAX theater systems.

The first IMAX DMR film, Apollo 13: The IMAX Experience, produced in conjunction with Universal Pictures and Imagine Entertainment, was released in September 2002 to 48 IMAX theaters. One of the more recent IMAX DMR films, The Hobbit: An Expected Journey: An IMAX 3D Experience was released to 496 IMAX theaters. Since the release of Apollo 13: The IMAX Experience, an additional 118 IMAX DMR films have been released to the IMAX theater network as at December 31, 2012.

Advances in the IMAX DMR process increasingly allow the re-mastering process to meet aggressive film production schedules. The Company has decreased the length of time it takes to reformat a film with its IMAX DMR technology. Apollo 13: The IMAX Experience, released in September 2002, was re-mastered in 16 weeks, while The Hobbit: An Expected Journey: An IMAX 3D Experience, released in December 2012, was re-mastered in less than one week. The IMAX DMR conversion of simultaneous, or “day-and-date” releases are done in parallel with the movie’s filming and editing, which is necessary for the simultaneous release of an IMAX DMR film with the domestic release to conventional theaters.

An IMAX film can also benefit from enhancements made by individual filmmakers exclusively for the IMAX release, including by using IMAX cameras in select scenes to further enhance the audience’s immersion in the film. Filmmakers such as Christopher Nolan

 

10


Table of Contents

and Michael Bay have used IMAX cameras to film select scenes in their films The Dark Knight: The IMAX Experience and Transformers: Revenge of the Fallen: The IMAX Experience. Most recently, filmmaker Brad Bird used IMAX cameras to film certain sequences in Mission: Impossible – Ghost Protocol: The IMAX Experience, released in December 2011 and Mr. Nolan used IMAX cameras to film over one hour of sequences’ in The Dark Knight Rises: The IMAX Experience, released in July 2012. Two of the films announced to date for 2013, Star Trek Into Darkness: An IMAX 3D Experience and The Hunger Games: Catching Fire: The IMAX Experience, will feature select sequences shot with IMAX cameras. Several movies in 2012 have featured footage taking advantage of the larger projected IMAX aspect ratio, including Prometheus: An IMAX 3D Experience, The Amazing Spider-Man: An IMAX 3D Experience and Skyfall: The IMAX Experience.

The original soundtracks of films to be released to the IMAX network are re-mastered for the IMAX five or six-channel digital sound systems for the IMAX DMR release. Unlike the soundtracks played in conventional theaters, IMAX re-mastered soundtracks are uncompressed and full fidelity. IMAX sound systems use proprietary loudspeaker systems and proprietary surround sound configurations that ensure every theater seat is in a good listening position.

In 2012, 35 films were converted through the IMAX DMR process and released to theaters in the IMAX network by film studios as compared to 25 films in 2011. These films were:

 

   

Underworld: Awakening: An IMAX 3D Experience (Sony Pictures Entertainment, January 2012);

 

   

Journey 2: The Mysterious Island An IMAX 3D Experience (New Line Cinema, February 2012);

 

   

The Lorax: An IMAX 3D Experience (Universal Pictures, March 2012);

 

   

John Carter: An IMAX 3D Experience (Walt Disney Studios, March 2012);

 

   

The Hunger Games: The IMAX Experience (Lionsgate, March 2012);

 

   

Wrath of the Titans: An IMAX 3D Experience (Warner Bros., March 2012);

 

   

Titanic: An IMAX 3D Experience (Paramount Pictures, Twentieth Century Fox, April 2012);

 

   

HOUBA! On the Trail of the Marsupilami: The IMAX Experience (Chez WAM, Pathé Distribution, April 2012, France only release);

 

   

Battleship: The IMAX Experience (Universal Pictures, April 2012, international only release);

 

   

The Avengers: An IMAX 3D Experience (Disney Studios, Marvel Studios, May 2012);

 

   

Dark Shadows: The IMAX Experience (Warner Bros., May 2012);

 

   

Men In Black III: An IMAX 3D Experience (Sony Pictures, May 2012);

 

   

Prometheus: An IMAX 3D Experience (Twentieth Century Fox, June 2012);

 

   

Madagascar 3: Europe’s Most Wanted: An IMAX 3D Experience (DreamWorks Animation, June 2012, international only release);

 

   

Rock of Ages: The IMAX Experience (Warner Bros., June 2012);

 

   

The Amazing Spider-Man: An IMAX 3D Experience (Sony Pictures, July 2012);

 

   

The Dark Knight Rises: The IMAX Experience (Warner Bros., July 2012);

 

   

Total Recall: The IMAX Experience (Sony Pictures, August 2012, late-breaking select international markets only);

 

   

The Bourne Legacy: The IMAX Experience (Universal Pictures, August 2012, late-breaking select international markets only);

 

   

Indiana Jones and the Raiders of the Lost Ark: The IMAX Experience (Paramount Pictures, September 2012);

 

   

Resident Evil: Retribution: An IMAX 3D Experience (Sony Pictures, September 2012);

 

   

Tai Chi 0: An IMAX 3D Experience (Huayi Bros., September 2012, Asia Only);

 

   

Frankenweenie: An IMAX 3D Experience (Walt Disney Pictures, October 2012);

 

   

Paranormal Activity 4: The IMAX Experience (Paramount Pictures, October 2012);

 

   

Tai Chi Hero: An IMAX 3D Experience (Huayi Bros., October 2012, Asia only);

 

   

Cloud Atlas: The IMAX Experience (Warner Bros., October 2012);

 

   

Skyfall: The IMAX Experience (Sony Pictures, November 2012);

 

   

Cirque du Soleil: Worlds Away: An IMAX 3D Experience (Paramount Pictures, November 2012, Asia only);

 

   

The Twilight Saga: Breaking Dawn – Part 2: The IMAX Experience (Lionsgate, November 2012, UK and select International markets);

 

   

Life of Pi: An IMAX 3D Experience (Twentieth Century Fox, November 2012);

 

   

Rise of the Guardians: An IMAX 3D Experience (DreamWorks Animation, November 2012);

 

   

Back to 1942: The IMAX Experience (Huayi Bros., November 2012, Asia only);

 

11


Table of Contents
   

CZ12: An IMAX 3D Experience (JCE Entertainment Ltd., Huayi Brothers & Emperor Motion Pictures, December 2012, Asia only);

 

   

The Hobbit: An Unexpected Journey: An IMAX 3D Experience (Warner Bros., December 2012); and

 

   

Les Misérables: The IMAX Experience (Universal Pictures, December 2012).

In addition, in conjunction with MacGillivray Freeman Films and Warner Bros., the Company released IMAX original production, To the Arctic 3D, in April 2012.

To date, the Company has announced the following 23 DMR films that will be released in 2013 to the IMAX theater network:

 

   

The Grandmaster: The IMAX Experience (Jet Tone Films and Sil-Metropole Organization, January 2013);

 

   

Hansel & Gretel: Witch Hunters: An IMAX 3D Experience (Paramount Pictures, January 2013);

 

   

Journey to the West: Conquering the Demons: An IMAX 3D Experience (Bingo Movie Development Ltd, February 2013);

 

   

Top Gun: An IMAX 3D Experience (Paramount Pictures, February 2013);

 

   

A Good Day to Die Hard: The IMAX Experience (Twentieth Century Fox, February 2013);

 

   

Jack the Giant Slayer: An IMAX 3D Experience (Warner Bros., March 2013);

 

   

Oz: The Great and Powerful: An IMAX 3D Experience (Walt Disney Pictures, March 2013);

 

   

G.I. Joe: Retaliation: An IMAX 3D Experience (Paramount Pictures, March 2013);

 

   

Dragon Ball Z: Battle of the Gods: An IMAX 3D Experience (Toei Animation Company, March 2013);

 

   

Oblivion: The IMAX Experience (Universal Pictures, April 2013);

 

   

Jurassic Park: An IMAX 3D Experience (Universal Pictures, April 2013);

 

   

Iron Man 3: An IMAX 3D Experience (Walt Disney Pictures, May 2013);

 

   

Star Trek: Into Darkness: An IMAX 3D Experience (Paramount Pictures, May 2013);

 

   

Man of Steel: The IMAX Experience (Warner Bros., June 2013);

 

   

Pacific Rim: An IMAX 3D Experience (Warner Bros., July 2013);

 

   

300: Rise of an Empire: An IMAX 3D Experience (Warner Bros., August 2013);

 

   

Riddick Sequel: The IMAX Experience (Universal Pictures, September 2013);

 

   

Gravity: An IMAX 3D Experience (Warner Bros., October 2013);

 

   

Stalingrad: An IMAX 3D Experience (AR Films, October 2013, Russia and the CIS only);

 

   

Seventh Son: An IMAX 3D Experience (Warner Bros., October 2013);

 

   

The Hunger Games: Catching Fire: The IMAX Experience (Lionsgate., November 2013);

 

   

The Hobbit: The Desolation of Smaug: An IMAX 3D Experience (Warner Bros., December 2013); and

 

   

Dhoom 3: The IMAX Experience (Yash Raj Films, 2013, India only).

The Company remains in active negotiations with all of Hollywood’s studios for additional films to fill out its short and long-term film slate and expects a similar number of IMAX DMR films to be released to the IMAX network in 2013 as were released 2012.

The Company expects to announce additional local language IMAX DMR films to be released to the IMAX theater network in 2013 and beyond. Supplementing the Company’s film slate of Hollywood DMR titles with appealing local DMR titles is an important component of the Company’s international film strategy.

Film Distribution

The Company is also a distributor of large-format films, that cater primarily to its institutional theater partners. The Company distributes films which it has produced or for which it has acquired distribution rights from independent producers. As a distributor, the Company receives a fixed fee and/or a percentage of the theater box-office receipts.

Films produced by the Company are typically financed through third parties. The Company will generally receive a film production fee in exchange for producing the film and a distribution fee for distributing the film. The ownership rights to such films may be held by the film sponsors, the film investors and/or the Company.

As at December 31, 2012, the Company’s film library consisted of 285 IMAX original films, which cover such subjects as space, wildlife, music, history and natural wonders. The Company currently has distribution rights with respect to 46 of such films. Large-format films that have been successfully distributed by the Company include: To the Arctic 3D: An IMAX 3D Experience, which was

 

12


Table of Contents

released in April 2012 and has grossed over $13.9 million as at the end of 2012; Born to be Wild 3D: An IMAX 3D Experience, which was released by the Company and Warner Bros. Pictures (“WB”) in April 2011 and has grossed over $32.0 million as at the end of 2012; Hubble 3D: An IMAX 3D Experience, which was released by the Company and WB in March 2010 and has grossed over $51.8 million as at the end of 2012; Under the Sea 3D: An IMAX 3D Experience, which was released by the Company and WB in February 2009 and has grossed over $44.5 million as at the end of 2012; Deep Sea 3D: An IMAX 3D Experience, which was released by the Company and WB in March 2006 and has grossed more than $93.5 million as at the end of 2012; SPACE STATION, which was released in April 2002 and has grossed over $120.8 million as at the end of 2012 and T-REX: Back to the Cretaceous, which was released by the Company in 1998 and has grossed over $103.9 million as at the end of 2012. Large-format films have significantly longer exhibition periods than conventional commercial films and many of the films in the large-format library have remained popular for many decades, including the films To Fly! (1976), Grand Canyon — The Hidden Secrets (1984and The Dream Is Alive (1985).

Film Post-Production

David Keighley Productions 70MM Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, provides film post-production and quality control services for large-format films (whether produced internally or externally), and digital post-production services.

Other

Theater Operations

As at December 31, 2012 and 2011, the Company had four owned and operated theaters on leased premises. In addition, the Company has a commercial arrangement with one theater resulting in the sharing of profits and losses. The Company also provides management services to two theaters.

Cameras

The Company rents its proprietary 2D and 3D large-format film and digital cameras to third party production companies. The Company also provides production technical support and post-production services for a fee. All IMAX 2D and 3D film cameras run 65mm negative film, exposing 15 perforations per frame and resulting in an image area nearly 10x larger than standard 35mm film. The Company’s film-based 3D camera, which is a patented, state-of-the-art dual and single filmstrip 3D camera, is among the most advanced motion picture cameras in the world and is the only 3D camera of its kind. The IMAX 3D camera simultaneously shoots left-eye and right-eye images and enables filmmakers to access a variety of locations, such as underwater or aboard aircraft. The Company has also recently developed a high speed 3D digital camera which utilizes a pair of the world’s largest digital sensors.

Due to the increasing success major Hollywood filmmakers have had with IMAX cameras, the Company has identified the development and manufacture of additional IMAX cameras as an important research and development initiative.

The Company maintains cameras and other film equipment and also offers production advice and technical assistance to both documentary and Hollywood filmmakers.

MARKETING AND CUSTOMERS

The Company markets its theater systems through a direct sales force and marketing staff located in offices in Canada, the United States, Greater China, Europe and Asia. In addition, the Company has agreements with consultants, business brokers and real estate professionals to locate potential customers and theater sites for the Company on a commission basis. During 2012, the Company re-invested in its brand with a consumer brand marketing campaign that encompasses social media, in-theater marketing and Internet advertising.

The commercial multiplex theater segment of the Company’s theater network is now its largest segment, comprising 598 theaters, or 81.8%, of the 731 theaters open as at December 31, 2012. The Company’s institutional customers include science and natural history museums, zoos, aquaria and other educational and cultural centers. The Company also sells or leases its theater systems to theme parks, tourist destination sites, fairs and expositions (the Commercial Destination segment). At December 31, 2012, approximately 45.8% of all opened IMAX theaters were in locations outside of the United States and Canada. The following table outlines the breakdown of the theater network by type and geographic location as at December 31:

 

13


Table of Contents
                                                                                                                               
     2012 Theater Network Base      2011 Theater Network Base  
     Commercial
Multiplex
     Commercial
Destination
     Institutional      Total      Commercial
Multiplex
     Commercial
Destination
     Institutional      Total  

United States

     290        6        57        353        269        6        61        336  

Canada

     34        2        7        43        26        2        7        35  

Greater China(1)

     108        —          20        128        70        —          18        88  

Western Europe

     42        7        11        60        36        7        10        53  

Asia (excluding Greater China)

     46        3        7        56        35        3        9        47  

Russia & the CIS

     32        —          —          32        22        —          —          22  

Latin America(2)

     19        —          10        29        15        —          10        25  

Rest of the World

     27        1        2        30        24        2        2        28  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total(3)

     598        19        114        731        497        20        117        634  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) Greater China includes the People’s Republic of China, Hong Kong, Taiwan and Macau.
(2) Latin America includes South America, Central America and Mexico.
(3) Includes 316 and 257 theater systems in operation as at December 31, 2012 and 2011, respectively, under joint revenue sharing arrangements.

For information on revenue breakdown by geographic area, see note 20 to the accompanying audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8. The Company’s foreign operations are subject to certain risks. See “Risk Factors – The Company conducts business internationally which exposes it to uncertainties and risks that could negatively affect its operations and sales” and “Risk Factors – The Company faces risks in connection with the continued expansion of its business in China” in Item 1A. The Company’s two largest customers as at December 31, 2012, collectively represent 32.1% of the Company’s network base of theaters and 15.9% of revenues.

INDUSTRY AND COMPETITION

In recent years, as the motion picture industry has transitioned from film projection to digital projection, a number of companies have introduced digital 3D projection technology and, since 2008, an increasingly large number of Hollywood features have been exhibited using these technologies. According to the National Association of Theater Owners, as at December 31, 2012, there were approximately 14,730 conventional-sized screens in U.S. multiplexes equipped with such digital 3D systems. In 2008, the Company introduced its proprietary digitally-based projector which is capable of 2D and 3D presentations on large screens and which comprises the majority of its current (and, the Company expects, future) theater system sales. Over the last several years, a number of commercial exhibitors have introduced their own large screen branded theaters. In addition, the Company has historically competed with manufacturers of large-format film projectors. The Company believes that all of these alternative film formats deliver images and experiences that are inferior to The IMAX Experience.

The Company may also face competition in the future from companies in the entertainment industry with new technologies and/or substantially greater capital resources to develop and support them. The Company also faces in-home competition from a number of alternative motion picture distribution channels such as home video, pay-per-view, video-on-demand, DVD, Internet and syndicated and broadcast television. The Company further competes for the public’s leisure time and disposable income with other forms of entertainment, including gaming, sporting events, concerts, live theater, social media and restaurants.

The Company believes that its competitive strengths include the value of the IMAX brand name, the premium IMAX consumer experience, the design, quality and historic reliability rate of IMAX theater systems, the return on investment of an IMAX theater, the number and quality of IMAX films that it distributes, the relationships the Company maintains with prominent Hollywood filmmakers, a number of whom desire to film portions of their movies with IMAX cameras, the quality of the sound system components included with the IMAX theater, the availability of Hollywood event films to IMAX theaters through IMAX DMR technology, consumer loyalty and the level of the Company’s service and maintenance and extended warranty efforts. The Company believes that all of the best performing premium theaters in the world are IMAX theaters.

 

14


Table of Contents

THE IMAX BRAND

The world-famous IMAX brand stands for the highest-quality, most immersive motion picture entertainment. Consumer research conducted for the Company in the U.S. by a third-party research firm shows that the IMAX brand is known for cutting-edge technology and an experience that immerses audiences in the movie. The research also shows that the brand inspires strong consumer loyalty and that consumers place a premium on it, often willing to travel significantly farther and pay more for The IMAX Experience than for a conventional movie. The Company believes that its significant brand loyalty among consumers provides it with a strong, sustainable position in the exhibition industry. Recognition of the IMAX brand name cuts across geographic and demographic boundaries. The Company believes that the strength of the IMAX brand has resulted in IMAX DMR films significantly outperforming other formats on a per screen basis.

The Company believes the strength of the IMAX brand is an asset that has helped to establish the IMAX theater network as a unique and desirable release window for Hollywood movies. In 2012, the Company has begun to reinvest in its brand with a consumer brand marketing campaign that encompasses social media, in-theater marketing and Internet advertising.

RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT

The Company believes that it is one of the world’s leading entertainment technology companies with significant proprietary expertise in digital and film-based projection and sound system component design, engineering and imaging technology, particularly in 3D. During 2012, the Company increased its level of research and development as it is developing its next-generation laser-based projection system which is expected to provide greater brightness and clarity, a wider colour gamut and deeper blacks, while consuming less power and lasting longer than existing digital technology, to ensure that the Company continues to provide the highest quality, premier movie going experience available to consumers. A high level of research and development is expected to continue in 2013 as the Company continues its efforts to develop its next-generation laser-based projection system. In addition, the Company plans to continue to fund research and development activity in other areas considered important to the Company’s continued commercial success, including further improving the reliability of its projectors, developing and manufacturing more IMAX cameras, enhancing the Company’s 2D and 3D image quality, expanding the applicability of the Company’s digital technology, developing IMAX theater systems’ capabilities in both home and live entertainment and further enhancing the IMAX theater and sound system design through the addition of more channels, improvements to the Company’s proprietary tuning system and mastering processes.

The motion picture industry has been, and will continue to be, affected by the development of digital technologies, particularly in the areas of content creation (image capture), post-production, digital re-mastering (such as IMAX DMR), distribution and display (projection). As such, the Company has made significant investments in digital technologies, including the development of a proprietary technology to digitally enhance image resolution and quality of motion picture films, the creation of an IMAX digital projector and the licensing of prominent laser illumination technology. Accordingly, the Company holds a number of patents, patents pending and other intellectual property rights in these areas. In addition, the Company holds numerous digital patents and relationships with key manufacturers and suppliers in digital technology.

In order to keep the Company at the forefront of digital technology, the Company has made strategic investments in laser technology. On October 17, 2011, the Company announced the completion of a deal in which it secured the exclusive license rights from Kodak to a portfolio of more than 50 patent families covering laser projection technology as well as rights in the digital cinema field to a broader range of Kodak technology. On February 7, 2012, the Company announced an agreement with Barco to jointly develop a laser-based digital projection system that incorporates Kodak technology. The Company believes that these arrangements with Kodak and Barco will enable IMAX theaters to present greater brightness and clarity, a wider color gamut and deeper blacks, and consume less power and last longer than existing digital technology. The Company believes that a laser projection solution will allow IMAX’s network to show the highest quality digital content available. As part of its investment in laser digital technology, in September 2010, the Company also made a $1.5 million preferred share investment in Laser Light Engines, Inc. (“LLE”), a developer and manufacturer of laser-driven light sources. The Company is in discussions with LLE regarding the development of laser technology to incorporate into its laser-based digital projection solution. The Company plans to deploy a laser-based digital projection solution in the second half of 2014. As part of its agreement with Barco, in addition to co-developing a laser-based digital projection system, Barco will serve as IMAX’s exclusive supplier of xenon-based projection systems. The Company has worked with Barco to ensure the compatability of the Barco projector with IMAX theater systems and to ensure that the Barco projectors meet the specifications of The IMAX Experience.

In 2009, the Company developed its first 3D digital camera primarily for use in IMAX documentary productions. Portions of Born to Be Wild 3D: An IMAX 3D Experience were filmed with the IMAX 3D digital camera and the camera has subsequently been used to film portions of a new wildlife documentary (working title Madagascar). Due to the increasing success major Hollywood

 

15


Table of Contents

filmmakers have had with IMAX cameras, the Company has identified the development and manufacture of addition IMAX cameras as an important research and development initiative. To that end, the Company is also in early stages of development of an IMAX 2D digital camera for use by Hollywood directors who are seeking IMAX differentiation for portions of their movies.

The Company’s participation in 3net, a 24/7 3D cable channel venture, operated by a limited liability corporation owned by the Company, Discovery Communications and Sony Corporation that premiered on February 13, 2011, is an example of its strategic entry into the field of in-home entertainment technology. The Company has deployed its proprietary expertise in image technology and 3D technology to help set broadcast and presentation standards for the new channel. The Company expects to continue to deploy its proprietary expertise in image technology and 3D technology, as well as its proprietary film content and the IMAX brand, for further applications in in-home entertainment technology. The Company is also evaluating the possibility of designing a proprietary IMAX theater system for the home that will deliver a premium entertainment experience in a home theater environment, consistent with the IMAX brand.

For the years ended December 31, 2012, 2011, and 2010, the Company recorded research and development expenses of $11.4 million, $7.8 million and $6.2 million, respectively. As at December 31, 2012, 64 of the Company’s employees were connected with research and development projects.

MANUFACTURING AND SERVICE

Projector Component Manufacturing

The Company assembles the projector of its theater systems at its office in Mississauga, Ontario, Canada (near Toronto). The Company develops and designs all of the key elements of the proprietary technology involved in this component. Fabrication of a majority of parts and sub-assemblies is subcontracted to a group of carefully pre-qualified third-party suppliers. Manufacture and supply contracts are signed for the delivery of the component on an order-by-order basis. The Company believes its significant suppliers will continue to supply quality products in quantities sufficient to satisfy its needs. The Company inspects all parts and sub-assemblies, completes the final assembly and then subjects the projector to comprehensive testing individually and as a system prior to shipment. In 2012, these projectors, including the Company’s digital projection system, had reliability rates based on scheduled shows of approximately 99.9%.

Sound System Component Manufacturing

The Company develops, designs and assembles the key elements of its theater sound system component. The standard IMAX theater sound system component comprises parts from a variety of sources, with approximately 50% of the materials of each sound system attributable to proprietary parts provided under original equipment manufacturers agreements with outside vendors. These proprietary parts include custom loudspeaker enclosures and horns, specialized amplifiers, and signal processing and control equipment. The Company inspects all parts and sub-assemblies, completes the final assembly and then subjects the sound system component to comprehensive testing individually and as a system prior to shipment.

Screen and Other Components

The Company purchases its screen component and glasses cleaning equipment from third parties. The standard screen system component is comprised of a projection screen manufactured to IMAX specifications and a frame to hang the projection screen. The proprietary glasses cleaning machine is a stand-alone unit that is connected to the theater’s water and electrical supply to automate the cleaning of 3D glasses.

Maintenance and Extended Warranty Services

The Company also provides ongoing maintenance and extended warranty services to IMAX theater systems. These arrangements are usually for a separate fee, although the Company often includes free service in the initial year of an arrangement. The maintenance and extended warranty arrangements include service, maintenance and replacement parts for theater systems.

To support the IMAX theater network, the Company has personnel stationed in major markets throughout the world who provide periodic and emergency maintenance and extended warranty services on existing theater systems. The Company provides various levels of maintenance and warranty services, which are priced accordingly. Under full service programs, Company personnel typically visit each theater every six months to provide preventative maintenance, cleaning and inspection services and emergency visits to

 

16


Table of Contents

resolve problems and issues with the theater system. Under some arrangements, customers can elect to participate in a service partnership program whereby the Company trains a customer’s technician to carry out certain aspects of maintenance. Under such shared maintenance arrangements, the Company participates in certain of the customer’s maintenance checks each year, provides a specified number of emergency visits and provides spare parts, as necessary. For digital systems, the Company provides pre-emptive maintenance through minor bug fixes, and also provides remote system monitoring and a network operations center that provides continuous access to product experts.

PATENTS AND TRADEMARKS

The Company’s inventions cover various aspects of its proprietary technology and many of these inventions are protected by Letters of Patent or applications filed throughout the world, most significantly in the United States, Canada, Belgium, Japan, France, Germany and the United Kingdom. The subject matter covered by these patents, applications and other licenses encompasses theater design and geometry, electronic circuitry and mechanisms employed in projectors and projection equipment (including 3D projection equipment), a method for synchronizing digital data, a method of generating stereoscopic (3D) imaging data from a monoscopic (2D) source, a process for digitally re-mastering 35mm films into large-format, a method for increasing the dynamic range and contrast of projectors, a method for visibly seaming or superimposing images from multiple projectors and other inventions relating to digital projectors. In 2011, the Company entered into a deal in which it secured the exclusive license rights from Kodak to a portfolio of more than 50 patent families covering laser projection technology as well as certain exclusive rights to a broad range of Kodak patents in the field of digital cinema. The Company has been and will continue to be diligent in the protection of its proprietary interests.

As at December 31, 2012, the Company holds or licenses 96 patents, has 38 patents pending in the United States and has corresponding patents or filed applications in many countries throughout the world. While the Company considers its patents to be important to the overall conduct of its business, it does not consider any particular patent essential to its operations. Certain of the Company’s patents in the United States, Canada and Japan for improvements to the IMAX projection system components expire between 2016 and 2028.

The Company owns or otherwise has rights to trademarks and trade names used in conjunction with the sale of its products, systems and services. The following trademarks are considered significant in terms of the current and contemplated operations of the Company: IMAX®, Experience It In IMAX®, The IMAX Experience®, An IMAX Experience®, An IMAX 3D Experience®, IMAX DMR®, IMAX® 3D, IMAX® Dome, IMAX is Believing®, IMAX think big® and think big®. These trademarks are widely protected by registration or common law throughout the world. The Company also owns the service mark IMAX THEATRETM.

EMPLOYEES

The Company had 526 employees as at December 31, 2012, compared to 442 employees as at December 31, 2011. Both employee counts exclude hourly employees at the Company’s owned and operated theaters.

AVAILABLE INFORMATION

The Company makes available, free of charge, its Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q and Current Reports on Form 8-K as soon as reasonably practicable after such filings have been made with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”). Reports may be obtained through the Company’s website at www.imax.com or by calling the Company’s Investor Relations Department at 212-821-0100.

 

17


Table of Contents
Item 1A. Risk Factors

If any of the risks described below occurs, the Company’s business, operating results and financial condition could be materially adversely affected.

The risks described below are not the only ones the Company faces. Additional risks not presently known to the Company or that it deems immaterial, may also impair its business or operations.

The Company depends principally on commercial movie exhibitors to purchase or lease IMAX theater systems, to supply box office revenue under joint revenue sharing arrangements and under its sales and sales-type lease agreements and to supply venues in which to exhibit IMAX DMR films and the Company can make no assurances that exhibitors will continue to do any of these things.

The Company’s primary customers are commercial multiplex exhibitors, whose systems represent 98.2% of the 276 systems in the Company’s backlog as at December 31, 2012. The Company is unable to predict if, or when, they or other exhibitors will purchase or lease IMAX theater systems or enter into joint revenue sharing arrangements with the Company, or whether any of the Company’s existing customers will continue to do any of the foregoing. If exhibitors choose to reduce their levels of expansion or decide not to purchase or lease IMAX theater systems or enter into joint revenue sharing arrangements with the Company, the Company’s revenues would not increase at an anticipated rate and motion picture studios may be less willing to convert their films into the Company’s format for exhibition in commercial IMAX theaters. As a result, the Company’s future revenues and cash flows could be adversely affected.

The success of the IMAX theater network is directly related to the availability and success of IMAX DMR films for which there can be no guarantee.

An important factor affecting the growth and success of the IMAX theater network is the availability of films for IMAX theaters and the box office performance of such films. The Company itself produces only a small number of such films and, as a result, the Company relies principally on films produced by third party filmmakers and studios, in particular Hollywood features converted into the Company’s large format using the Company’s IMAX DMR technology. In 2012, 35 IMAX DMR films were released by Hollywood studios to the worldwide IMAX theater network. The Company expects to announce additional local language IMAX DMR films to be released to the IMAX theater network in 2013 and beyond. Supplementing the Company’s film slate of Hollywood DMR titles with appealing local DMR titles is an important component of the Company’s international film strategy. There is no guarantee that filmmakers and studios will continue to release films to the IMAX theater network, or that the films they produce will be commercially successful. The steady flow and successful box office performance of IMAX DMR releases have become increasingly important to the Company’s financial performance as the number of joint revenue sharing arrangements included in the overall IMAX network has grown considerably. The Company is increasingly directly impacted by box-office results for the films released to the IMAX network through its joint revenue sharing arrangements as well as through the percentage of the box-office receipts the Company receives from the studios releasing IMAX DMR films, and the Company’s continued ability to find suitable partners for joint revenue share arrangements and to sell IMAX theater systems also depends on the number and commercial success of films released to its network. The commercial success of films released to IMAX theaters depends on a number of factors outside of the Company’s control, including whether the film receives critical acclaim, the timing of its release, the success of the marketing efforts of the studio releasing the film and consumer preferences. Moreover, films can be subject to delays in production or changes in release schedule, which can negatively impact the number, timing and quality of IMAX DMR and IMAX original films released to the IMAX theater network.

The introduction of new, competing products and technologies could harm the Company’s business.

The out-of-home entertainment industry is very competitive, and the Company faces a number of competitive challenges. According to the National Association of Theater Owners, as at December 31, 2012, there were approximately 14,730 conventional-sized screens in North American multiplexes equipped with digital 3D systems. In addition, some commercial exhibitors have introduced their own branded, large-screen 3D auditoriums and in many cases have marketed those auditoriums as having the same quality or attributes as an IMAX theater. The Company also may face competition in the future from companies in the entertainment industry with new technologies and/or substantially greater capital resources to develop and support them. If the Company is unable to continue to deliver a premium movie-going experience, or if other technologies surpass those of the Company, the Company may be unable to continue to produce theater systems which are premium to, or differentiated from, other theater systems. If the Company is unable to produce a premium theater experience, consumers may be unwilling to pay the price premiums associated with the cost of IMAX theater tickets and box office performance of IMAX films may decline. Declining box office performance of IMAX films

 

18


Table of Contents

would materially and adversely harm the Company’s business and prospects. The Company also faces in-home competition from a number of alternative motion picture distribution channels such as home video, pay-per-view, video-on-demand, DVD, Internet and syndicated and broadcast television. The Company further competes for the public’s leisure time and disposable income with other forms of entertainment, including gaming, sporting events, concerts, live theater, social media and restaurants.

Failure to respond adequately or in a timely fashion to changes and advancements in digital technology could negatively affect the Company’s business.

There have been a number of advancements in the digital cinema field in recent years. In order to keep pace with these changes and in order to continue to provide an experience which is premium to and differentiated from conventional cinema experiences, the Company has made, and expects to continue to make, significant investments in digital technology in the form of research and development and the acquisition of third party intellectual property and/or proprietary technology. Recently, the Company has made significant investments in laser technology as part of its effort to develop a next-generation laser-based digital projection system. The process of developing new technologies is inherently uncertain, and the Company can provide no assurance its investments will result in commercially viable advancements to the Company’s existing products or in commercially successful new products, or that any such advancements or products will be developed within the timeframe expected.

The Company conducts business internationally, which exposes it to uncertainties and risks that could negatively affect its operations, sales and future growth prospects.

A significant portion of the Company’s revenues are generated by customers located outside the United States and Canada. Approximately 48%, 46% and 39% of its revenues were derived outside of the United States and Canada in 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively. As at December 31, 2012, approximately 80.1% of IMAX theater systems arrangements in backlog are scheduled to be installed in international markets. Accordingly, the Company expects to expand its international operations to account for an increasingly significant portion of its revenues in the future. There are a number of risks associated with operating in international markets that could negatively affect the Company’s operations, sales and future growth prospects. These risks include:

 

   

new restrictions on access to markets, both for theater systems and films;

 

   

unusual or burdensome foreign laws or regulatory requirements or unexpected changes to those laws or requirements;

 

   

fluctuations in the value of foreign currency versus the U.S. dollar and potential currency devaluations;

 

   

new tariffs, trade protection measures, import or export licensing requirements, trade embargoes and other trade barriers;

 

   

imposition of foreign exchange controls in such foreign jurisdictions;

 

   

dependence on foreign distributors and their sales channels;

 

   

difficulties in staffing and managing foreign operations;

 

   

adverse changes in monetary and/or tax policies;

 

   

poor recognition of intellectual property rights;

 

   

inflation;

 

   

requirements to provide performance bonds and letters of credit to international customers to secure system component deliveries; and

 

   

political, economic and social instability.

As the Company begins to expand the number of its theaters under joint revenue sharing arrangements in international markets, the Company’s revenues from its international operations will become increasingly dependent on the box office performance of its films. In addition, as the Company’s international network has expanded, the Company has signed deals with movie studios in other countries to convert their films to the Company’s large format and release them to IMAX theaters. The Company may be unable to select films which will be successful in international markets or unsuccessful in selecting the right mix of Hollywood and local DMR

 

19


Table of Contents

films in a particular country or region. Also, conflicts in international release schedules may make it difficult to release every IMAX film in certain markets. Finally, box office reporting in certain countries may be less accurate and therefore less reliable than in the United States and Canada.

The Company faces risks in connection with the continued expansion of its business in China.

At present, Greater China is the Company’s second-largest and fastest growing market. As at December 31, 2012, the Company had 128 theaters operating in Greater China with an additional 122 theaters in backlog that are scheduled to be installed in Greater China by 2018. In order to enable further growth in China, in 2011, the Company formed IMAX China, a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company. Also in 2011, the Company entered into key joint revenue sharing relationships in China, including a 75-theater arrangement with Wanda Cinema Line Corporation (“Wanda”), which is the Company’s largest single international partnership to date, and reflects an even greater financial investment in China. In addition, the Company has begun to release an increasing number of Chinese IMAX DMR films to its growing network in Greater China. As the Company furthers its commitment to China, it is increasingly exposed to risks in that region. These risks include changes in laws and regulations, currency fluctuations, increased competition and changes in economic conditions including consumer spending. Adverse developments in these areas could cause the Company to lose some or all of its investment in China and could cause the Company to fail to achieve anticipated growth.

Moreover, certain risks and uncertainties of doing business in China are solely within the control of the Chinese government, and Chinese law regulates both the scope of the Company’s investment in China and the business conducted by it within China. For instance, the Chinese government regulates both the number and timing of Hollywood films released to the China market. The Company cannot provide assurance that the Chinese government will continue to permit the release of IMAX films in China or that the timing of IMAX releases will be favorable to the Company. There are also uncertainties regarding the interpretation and application of laws and regulations and the enforceability of intellectual property and contract rights in China. If the Company were unable to navigate China’s regulatory environment, or if the Company were unable to enforce its intellectual property or contract rights in China, the Company’s business would be adversely impacted.

With the acquisition of AMC by Wanda, the Company’s largest customer will account for a greater percentage of the Company’s revenue and backlog.

In the third quarter of 2012, Dalian Wanda Group Co., Ltd., the parent company of Wanda, acquired AMC Entertainment Holdings, Inc. (“AMC”). Prior to this transaction, AMC and Wanda were the Company’s first and third largest customers. Under common ownership Wanda/AMC is the Company’s largest customer, representing approximately 12.2%, 14.1% and 12.2% of the Company’s total revenue in 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively. The share of the Company’s revenue and backlog that is generated by Wanda/AMC may grow as and if the Company and Wanda and/or AMC enter into additional arrangements for IMAX theater systems. Under common ownership, Wanda/AMC may be able to command increased leverage, and no assurance can be given that Wanda/AMC will continue to purchase theater systems and/or enter into joint revenue sharing arrangements with the Company and if so, whether contractual terms will be affected. If the Company does business with Wanda/AMC less frequently or on less favorable terms than currently, the Company’s operating results may be adversely affected.

The Company may not be able to adequately protect its intellectual property, and competitors could misappropriate its technology or brand, which could weaken its competitive position.

The Company depends on its proprietary knowledge regarding IMAX theater systems and digital and film technology. The Company relies principally upon a combination of copyright, trademark, patent and trade secret laws, restrictions on disclosures and contractual provisions to protect its proprietary and intellectual property rights. These laws and procedures may not be adequate to prevent unauthorized parties from attempting to copy or otherwise obtain the Company’s processes and technology or deter others from developing similar processes or technology, which could weaken the Company’s competitive position and require the Company to incur costs to secure enforcement of its intellectual property rights. The protection provided to the Company’s proprietary technology by the laws of foreign jurisdictions may not protect it as fully as the laws of Canada or the United States. The lack of protection afforded to intellectual property rights in certain international jurisdictions may be increasingly problematic given the extent to which future growth of the Company is anticipated to come from foreign jurisdictions. Finally, some of the underlying technologies of the Company’s products and system components are not covered by patents or patent applications.

The Company owns or licenses patents issued and patent applications pending, including those covering its digital projector, digital conversion technology and laser illumination technology. The Company’s patents are filed in the United States, often with corresponding patents or filed applications in other jurisdictions, such as Canada, China, Belgium, Japan, France, Germany and the United Kingdom. The patent applications pending may not be issued or the patents may not provide the Company with any

 

20


Table of Contents

competitive advantages. The patent applications may also be challenged by third parties. Several of the Company’s issued patents in the United States, Canada and Japan for improvements to IMAX projectors, IMAX 3D Dome and sound system components expire between 2016 and 2028. Any claims or litigation initiated by the Company to protect its proprietary technology could be time consuming, costly and divert the attention of its technical and management resources.

In 2011, the Company licensed digital laser technology from Kodak. In January 2012, Kodak filed for bankruptcy protection in the Southern District of New York. While the Company believes it has incorporated sufficient protections into its license agreement with Kodak, there are no guarantees the intellectual property it licensed from Kodak could not be adversely affected by Kodak’s bankruptcy filing.

The IMAX brand stands for the highest quality, most immersive motion picture entertainment. Protecting the IMAX brand is a critical element in maintaining the Company’s relationships with studios and its exhibitor clients. Though the Company relies on a combination of trademark and copyright law as well as its contractual provisions to protect the IMAX brand, those protections may not be adequate to prevent erosion of the brand over time, particularly in foreign jurisdictions. Erosion of the brand could threaten the demand for the Company’s products and services and impair its ability to grow future revenue streams.

The Company’s supply of analog film may be constrained as a result of the bankruptcy of Eastman Kodak Company.

Kodak, which is the Company’s sole supplier of analog film, filed for bankruptcy protection in the Southern District of New York in January 2012. In August 2012 the court overseeing Kodak’s bankruptcy proceedings granted Kodak’s motion to reject its film supply agreement with the Company. Kodak has stated publicly that it intends to continue to own and operate its film products business, and to date, Kodak has continued to supply the Company with analog film. However, the Company can provide no assurance that Kodak either will continue to supply analog film under terms acceptable to the Company, or that it will continue to manufacture film at all. Furthermore, Fujifilm Corporation, which had been another significant supplier of analog film to the movie industry, announced in September 2012 that it would cease production for motion pictures beginning in March 2013. As of December 31, 2012, the Company had 167 film-based theaters in its network, and the Company also uses analog film in its film-based cameras. Without a sufficient supply of analog film, the Company may be unable to supply film prints to its film-based theater customers, and it may be unable to utilize its film-based cameras for shooting IMAX films.

The Company is undertaking new lines of business and these new business initiatives may not be successful.

The Company is actively exploring new areas of brand extension, particularly in in-home theater entertainment and alternative theater content. These initiatives represent new areas of growth for the Company, which may not prove to be successful. Some of these initiatives could include the offering of new products and services that may not be accepted by the market. For instance, the Company’s equity investment in 3net, a 3D television channel operated by a limited liability corporation owned by the Company, Discovery Communications and Sony Corporation which debuted on February 13, 2011, recorded an equity loss of approximately $1.4 million, $1.8 million and $0.5 million in 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively. Some areas of potential growth for the Company are in the field of in-home entertainment technology, which is an intensively competitive business and which is dependent on consumer demand, over which the Company has no control. If any new business in which the Company invests or attempts to develop does not progress as planned, the Company may be adversely affected by investment expenses that have not led to the anticipated results, by the distraction of management from its core business or by damage to its brand or reputation.

In addition, these initiatives may involve the formation of joint ventures and business alliances. While the Company seeks to employ the optimal structure for each such business alliance, there is a possibility that the Company may have disagreements with its relevant partner in a joint venture or business with respect to financing, technological management, product development, management strategies or otherwise. Any such disagreement may cause the joint venture or business alliance to be terminated.

The Company may experience adverse effects due to exchange rate fluctuations.

A substantial portion of the Company’s revenues are denominated in U.S. dollars, while a substantial portion of its expenses are denominated in Canadian dollars. The Company also generates revenues in Chinese Yuan Renminbi, Euros and Japanese Yen. While the Company periodically enters into forward contracts to hedge its exposure to exchange rate fluctuations between the U.S. and the Canadian dollar, the Company may not be successful in reducing its exposure to these fluctuations. The use of derivative contracts is intended to mitigate or reduce transactional level volatility in the results of foreign operations, but does not completely eliminate volatility.

 

21


Table of Contents

Current economic conditions beyond the Company’s control could materially affect the Company’s business by reducing both revenue generated from existing IMAX theater systems and the demand for new IMAX theater systems.

The macro-economic outlook for 2013 remains uncertain in many markets and the U.S. and global economies could remain significantly challenged for an indeterminate period of time. While historically the movie industry has proved to be somewhat resistant to economic downturns, present economic conditions, which are beyond the Company’s control, could lead to a decrease in discretionary consumer spending. It is difficult to predict the severity and the duration of any decrease in discretionary consumer spending resulting from the economic downturn and what affect it may have on the movie industry, in general, and box office results of the Company’s films in particular. In recent years, the majority of the Company’s revenue has been directly derived from the box-office revenues of its films. Accordingly, any decline in attendance at commercial IMAX theaters could materially and adversely affect several sources of key revenue streams for the Company.

The Company also depends on the sale and lease of IMAX theater systems to commercial movie exhibitors to generate revenue. Commercial movie exhibitors generate revenues from consumer attendance at their theaters, which depends on the willingness of consumers to spend discretionary income at movie theaters. While in the past, the movie industry has proven to be somewhat resistant to economic downturns, in the event of declining box office and concession revenues, commercial exhibitors may be less willing to invest capital in new IMAX theaters. In addition, as a result of continuing tight credit conditions that may limit exhibitors’ access to capital, exhibitors may be unable to invest capital in new IMAX theaters. A decline in demand for new IMAX theater systems could materially and adversely affect the Company’s results of operations.

The issuance of the Company’s common shares and the accumulation of shares by certain shareholders could result in the loss of the Company’s ability to use certain of the Company’s net operating losses.

As at December 31, 2012, the Company had approximately $14.8 million of U.S. consolidated federal tax and certain other state tax net operating loss carryforwards. Realization of some or all of the benefit from these U.S. net tax operating losses is dependent on the absence of certain “ownership changes” of the Company’s common shares. An “ownership change,” as defined in the applicable federal income tax rules, would place possible limitations, on an annual basis, on the use of such net operating losses to offset any future taxable income that the Company may generate. Such limitations, in conjunction with the net operating loss expiration provisions, could significantly reduce or effectively eliminate the Company’s ability to use its U.S. net operating losses to offset any future taxable income.

The Company’s revenues from existing customers are derived in part from financial reporting provided by its customers, which may be inaccurate or incomplete, resulting in lost or delayed revenues.

The Company’s revenue under its joint revenue sharing arrangements, a portion of the Company’s payments under lease or sales arrangements and its film license fees are based upon financial reporting provided by its customers. If such reporting is inaccurate, incomplete or withheld, the Company’s ability to receive the appropriate payments in a timely fashion that are due to it may be impaired. The Company’s contractual ability to audit IMAX theaters may not rectify payments lost or delayed as a result of customers not fulfilling their contractual obligations with respect to financial reporting.

There is collection risk associated with payments to be received over the terms of the Company’s theater system agreements.

The Company is dependent in part on the viability of its exhibitors for collections under long-term leases, sales financing agreements and joint revenue sharing arrangements. Exhibitors or other operators may experience financial difficulties that could cause them to be unable to fulfill their contractual payment obligations to the Company. As a result, the Company’s future revenues and cash flows could be adversely affected.

The Company may not convert all of its backlog into revenue and cash flows.

At December 31, 2012, the Company’s sales backlog included 276 theater systems, consisting of 139 systems under sales arrangements and 137 theater systems under joint revenue sharing arrangements. The Company lists signed contracts for theater systems for which revenue has not been recognized as sales backlog prior to the time of revenue recognition. The total value of the sales backlog represents all signed theater system sale or lease agreements that are expected to be recognized as revenue in the future and includes initial fees along with the present value of fixed minimum ongoing fees due over the term, but excludes contingent fees in excess of fixed minimum ongoing fees that might be received in the future and maintenance and extended warranty fees. Notwithstanding the legal obligation to do so, not all of the Company’s customers with which it has signed contracts may accept delivery of theater systems that are included in the Company’s backlog. This could adversely affect the Company’s future revenues

 

22


Table of Contents

and cash flows. In addition, customers with theater system obligations in backlog sometimes request that the Company agree to modify or reduce such obligations, which the Company has agreed to in the past under certain circumstances. Customer requested delays in the installation of theater systems in backlog remain a recurring and unpredictable part of the Company’s business.

The Company’s operating results and cash flow can vary substantially from quarter to quarter and could increase the volatility of its share price.

The Company’s operating results and cash flow can fluctuate substantially from quarter to quarter. In particular, fluctuations in theater system installations and gross box office performance of IMAX DMR content can materially affect operating results. Factors that have affected the Company’s operating results and cash flow in the past, and are likely to affect its operating results and cash flow in the future, include, among other things:

 

   

the timing of signing and installation of new theater systems;

 

   

the timing and commercial success of films distributed to the Company’s theater network;

 

   

the demand for, and acceptance of, its products and services;

 

   

the recognition of revenue of sales and sales-type leases;

 

   

the classification of leases as sales-type versus operating leases;

 

   

the volume of orders received and that can be filled in the quarter;

 

   

the level of its sales backlog;

 

   

the signing of film distribution agreements;

 

   

the financial performance of IMAX theaters operated by the Company’s customers and by the Company;

 

   

financial difficulties faced by customers, particularly customers in the commercial exhibition industry;

 

   

the magnitude and timing of spending in relation to the Company’s research and development efforts and related investments as well as new business initiatives; and

 

   

the number and timing of joint revenue sharing arrangement installations, related capital expenditures and timing of related cash receipts.

Most of the Company’s operating expenses are fixed in the short term. The Company may be unable to rapidly adjust its spending to compensate for any unexpected shortfall in sales, joint revenue sharing arrangements revenue or IMAX DMR revenue which would harm quarterly operating results, although the results of any quarterly period are not necessarily indicative of its results for any other quarter or for a full fiscal year.

The Company’s theater system revenue can vary significantly from its cash flows under theater system sales or lease agreements.

The Company’s theater systems revenue can vary significantly from the associated cash flows. The Company often provides financing to customers for theater systems on a long-term basis through long-term leases or notes receivables. The terms of leases or notes receivable are typically 10 years. The Company’s sale and lease-type agreements typically provide for three major sources of cash flow related to theater systems:

 

   

initial fees, which are paid in installments generally commencing upon the signing of the agreement until installation of the theater systems;

 

   

ongoing fees, which are paid monthly after all theater systems have been installed and are generally equal to the greater of a fixed minimum amount per annum and a percentage of box-office receipts; and

 

23


Table of Contents
   

ongoing annual maintenance and extended warranty fees, which are generally payable commencing in the second year of theater operations.

Initial fees generally make up the vast majority of cash received under theater system sales or lease agreements for a theater arrangement.

For sales and sales-type leases, the revenue recorded is generally equal to the sum of initial fees and the present value of minimum ongoing fees due under the agreement. Cash received from initial fees in advance of meeting the revenue recognition criteria for the theater systems is recorded as deferred revenue. Contingent fees are recognized as they are reported by the theaters after annual minimum fixed fees are exceeded.

Leases that do not transfer substantially all of the benefits and risks of ownership to the customer are classified as operating leases. For these leases, initial fees and minimum fixed ongoing fees are recognized as revenue on a straight-line basis over the lease term. Contingent fees are recognized as they are reported by the theaters after annual minimum fixed fees are exceeded.

As a result of the above, the revenue set forth in the Company’s financial statements does not necessarily correlate with the Company’s cash flow or cash position. Revenues include the present value of future contracted cash payments and there is no guarantee that the Company will receive such payments under its lease and sale agreements if its customers default on their payment obligations.

The Company’s implementation of a new enterprise resource planning (“ERP”) system may adversely affect the Company’s business and results of operations or the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting.

Beginning in the first quarter of 2013, the Company is implementing a new ERP system that will deliver a new generation of work processes and information systems. ERP implementations are complex and time-consuming projects that involve substantial expenditures on system software and implementation activities that take several years. ERP implementations also require transformation of business and financial processes in order to reap the benefits of the ERP system. If the Company does not effectively implement the ERP system as planned or if the system does not operate as intended, it could adversely affect the Company’s operations, financial reporting systems, the Company’s ability to produce financial reports, and/or the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting.

The Company’s stock price has historically been volatile and declines in market price, including as a result a market downturn, may negatively affect its ability to raise capital, issue debt, secure customer business and retain employees.

The Company is listed on the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) and the Toronto Stock Exchange (“TSX”) and its publicly traded shares have in the past experienced, and may continue to experience, significant price and volume fluctuations. This market volatility could reduce the market price of its common stock, regardless of the Company’s operating performance. A decline in the capital markets generally, or an adjustment in the market price or trading volumes of the Company’s publicly traded securities, may negatively affect its ability to raise capital, issue debt, secure customer business or retain employees. These factors, as well as general economic and geopolitical conditions, may have a material adverse effect on the market price of the Company’s publicly traded securities.

The credit agreement governing the Company’s senior secured credit facility contains significant restrictions that limit its operating and financial flexibility.

The credit agreement governing the Company’s senior secured credit facility contains certain restrictive covenants that, among other things, limit its ability to:

 

   

incur additional indebtedness;

 

   

pay dividends and make distributions;

 

   

repurchase stock;

 

   

make certain investments;

 

   

transfer or sell assets;

 

24


Table of Contents
   

create liens;

 

   

enter into transactions with affiliates;

 

   

issue or sell stock of subsidiaries;

 

   

create dividend or other payment restrictions affecting restricted subsidiaries; and

 

   

merge, consolidate, amalgamate or sell all or substantially all of its assets to another person.

These restrictive covenants impose operating and financial restrictions on the Company that limit the Company’s ability to engage in acts that may be in the Company’s long-term best interests.

The Company is subject to impairment losses on its film assets.

The Company amortizes its film assets, including IMAX DMR costs capitalized using the individual film forecast method, whereby the costs of film assets are amortized and participation costs are accrued for each film in the ratio of revenues earned in the current period to management’s estimate of total revenues ultimately expected to be received for that title. Management regularly reviews, and revises when necessary, its estimates of ultimate revenues on a title-by-title basis, which may result in a change in the rate of amortization of the film assets and write-downs or impairments of film assets. Results of operations in future years include the amortization of the Company’s film assets and may be significantly affected by periodic adjustments in amortization rates.

The Company is subject to impairment losses on its inventories.

The Company records provisions for excess and obsolete inventory based upon current estimates of future events and conditions, including the anticipated installation dates for the current backlog of theater system contracts, technological developments, signings in negotiation and anticipated market acceptance of the Company’s current and pending theater systems. Since the Company introduced a proprietary digitally-based IMAX projection system, increased customer acceptance and preference for the Company’s digital projection system may subject existing film-based inventories to further write-downs (resulting in lower margins) as these theater systems become less desirable in the future.

If the Company’s goodwill or long lived assets become impaired the Company may be required to record a significant charge to earnings.

Under United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (“U.S. GAAP”), the Company reviews its long lived assets for impairment when events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying value may not be recoverable. Goodwill is required to be qualitatively assessed at least annually and when events or changes in circumstances arise or can be quantitatively tested for impairment. Factors that may be considered a change in circumstances include (but are not limited to) a decline in stock price and market capitalization, declines in future cash flows, and slower growth rates in the Company’s industry. The Company may be required to record a significant charge to earnings in its financial statements during the period in which any impairment of its goodwill or long lived assets is determined.

Changes in accounting and changes in management’s estimates may affect the Company’s reported earnings and operating income.

U.S. GAAP and accompanying accounting pronouncements, implementation guidelines and interpretations for many aspects of the Company’s business, such as revenue recognition, film accounting, accounting for pensions and other postretirement benefits, accounting for income taxes, and treatment of goodwill or long lived assets, are highly complex and involve many subjective judgments. Changes in these rules, their interpretation, management’s estimates, or changes in the Company’s products or business could significantly change its reported future earnings and operating income and could add significant volatility to those measures, without a comparable underlying change in cash flow from operations. See “Critical Accounting Policies” in Item 7.

The Company relies on its key personnel, and the loss of one or more of those personnel could harm its ability to carry out its business strategy.

 

25


Table of Contents

The Company’s operations and prospects depend in large part on the performance and continued service of its senior management team. The Company may not find qualified replacements for any of these individuals if their services are no longer available. The loss of the services of one or more members of the Company’s senior management team could adversely affect its ability to effectively pursue its business strategy.

Because the Company is incorporated in Canada, it may be difficult for plaintiffs to enforce against the Company liabilities based solely upon U.S. federal securities laws.

The Company is incorporated under the federal laws of Canada, some of its directors and officers are residents of Canada and a substantial portion of its assets and the assets of such directors and officers are located outside the United States. As a result, it may be difficult for U.S. plaintiffs to effect service within the United States upon those directors or officers who are not residents of the United States, or to realize against them or the Company in the United States upon judgments of courts of the United States predicated upon the civil liability under the U.S. federal securities laws. In addition, it may be difficult for plaintiffs to bring an original action outside of the United States against the Company to enforce liabilities based solely on U.S. federal securities laws.

 

Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments

None.

 

Item 2. Properties

The Company’s principal executive offices are located in Mississauga, Ontario, Canada, New York, New York, and Santa Monica, California. The Company’s principal facilities are as follows:

 

    

Operation

  

Own/Lease

  

Expiration

Mississauga, Ontario(1)

   Headquarters, Administrative, Assembly and Research and Development    Own    N/A

Santa Monica, California

   Sales, Marketing, Film Production and Post-Production    Lease    2015

Beijing, China

   Sales    Lease    2015

New York, New York

   Executive    Lease    2014

Tokyo, Japan

   Sales, Marketing and Maintenance    Lease    2014

Shanghai, China

   Sales, Marketing, Maintenance and Administrative    Lease    2014

Moscow, Russia

   Sales    Lease    2014

London, United Kingdom

   Sales    Lease    2013

 

(1) This facility is subject to a charge in favor of Wells Fargo Bank in connection with a secured term and revolving credit facility (see note 12 to the accompanying audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8).

 

26


Table of Contents
Item 3. Legal Proceedings

In March 2005, the Company, together with Three-Dimensional Media Group, Ltd. (“3DMG”), filed a complaint in the U.S. District Court for the Central District of California, Western Division, against In-Three, Inc. (“In-Three”) alleging patent infringement. On March 10, 2006, the Company and In-Three entered into a settlement agreement settling the dispute between the Company and In-Three. Despite the settlement reached between the Company and In-Three, co-plaintiff 3DMG refused to dismiss its claims against In-Three. Accordingly, the Company and In-Three moved jointly for a motion to dismiss the Company’s and In-Three’s claims. On August 24, 2010, the Court dismissed all of the claims pending between the Company and In-Three, thus dismissing the Company from the litigation.

On May 15, 2006, the Company initiated arbitration against 3DMG before the International Centre for Dispute Resolution in New York (the “ICDR”), alleging breaches of the license and consulting agreements between the Company and 3DMG. On June 15, 2006, 3DMG filed an answer denying any breaches and asserting counterclaims that the Company breached the parties’ license agreement. On June 21, 2007, the ICDR unanimously denied 3DMG’s Motion for Summary Judgment filed on April 11, 2007 concerning the Company’s claims and 3DMG’s counterclaims. The proceeding was suspended on May 4, 2009 due to failure of 3DMG to pay fees associated with the proceeding. The proceeding was further suspended on October 11, 2010 pending resolution of reexamination proceedings currently pending involving one of 3DMG’s patents. The Company will continue to pursue its claims vigorously and believes that all allegations made by 3DMG are without merit. The Company further believes that the amount of loss, if any, suffered in connection with the counterclaims would not have a material impact on the financial position or results of operations of the Company, although no assurance can be given with respect to the ultimate outcome of the arbitration.

In January 2004, the Company and IMAX Theatre Services Ltd., a subsidiary of the Company, commenced an arbitration seeking damages before the International Court of Arbitration of the International Chambers of Commerce (the “ICC”) with respect to the breach by Electronic Media Limited (“EML”) of its December 2000 agreement with the Company. In June 2004, the Company commenced a related arbitration before the ICC against EML’s affiliate, E-City Entertainment (I) PVT Limited (“E-City”), seeking damages as a result of E-City’s breach of a September 2000 lease agreement. An arbitration hearing took place in November 2005 against E-City which considered all claims by the Company. On February 1, 2006, the ICC issued an award on liability finding unanimously in the Company’s favor on all claims. Further hearings took place in July 2006 and December 2006. On August 24, 2007, the ICC issued an award unanimously in favor of the Company in the amount of $9.4 million, consisting of past and future rents owed to the Company under its lease agreements, plus interest and costs. In the award, the ICC upheld the validity and enforceability of the Company’s theater system contract. The Company thereafter submitted its application to the arbitration panel for interest and costs. On March 27, 2008, the arbitration plan issued a final award in favor of the Company in the amount of $11.3 million, plus an additional $2,512 each day in interest from October 1, 2007 until the date the award is paid, which the Company is seeking to enforce and collect in full. In July 2008, E-City commenced a proceeding in Mumbai, India seeking an order that the ICC award may not be recognized in India. The Company has opposed that application on a number of grounds and seeks to have the ICC award recognized in India. That Mumbai proceeding is still pending. On June 24, 2011, the Company commenced an application to the Ontario Superior Court of Justice for recognition of the final award. On December 2, 2011, the Ontario court issued an order recognizing the final award and requiring E-City to pay the Company $30,000 to cover the costs of the application. On January 18, 2012, the Company filed an application in New York State Supreme Court seeking recognition of the Ontario order in New York. On April 11, 2012, the New York court issued an order granting the Company’s application, leading to an entry of $15.5 million judgment in favor of the Company on May 4, 2012. On January 30, 2013, the Company filed an action in the New York Supreme Court seeking to collect the amount due under the New York judgment from certain entities and individuals affiliated with E-City.

In June 2003, Robots of Mars, Inc. (“Robots”) initiated an arbitration proceeding against the Company in California with the American Arbitration Association pursuant to arbitration provisions in two film production agreements entered into in 1994 and 1995 between Robots’ predecessor-in-interest and a discontinued subsidiary of the Company (“Ridefilm”), asserting claims for breach of contract, fraud, breach of fiduciary duty and intentional interference with the contract. The Company discontinued its Ridefilm business through a sale of the Ridefilm business and its assets to a third party in March 2001. Robots sought an award of over $5.0 million in damages including contingent compensation that it claims was owed under two production agreements, damages for tort claims, and punitive damages. The arbitration hearings of this matter occurred in June and October 2009. The arbitrator issued a final award on March 16, 2011, awarding Robots $0.4 million in damages and $0.3 million in pre-judgment interest to date on its claim for breach of one of the Ridefilm production agreements. The arbitrator found in the Company’s favor on Robots’ tort claims, and awarded Robots no damages on its claim for breach of the second production agreement. Despite finding in the Company’s favor on the vast majority of Robots’ claims, the arbitrator awarded Robots $1.2 million in attorneys’ fees and costs pursuant to the attorneys’ fee provision set forth in the production agreements. Robots initiated two separate proceedings in California and in Ontario, Canada, to confirm the award. On July 13, 2011, a California district court granted Robots’ petition to confirm the award, and denied the Company’s petition to vacate the award. On August 18, 2011, the Company appealed the district court’s denial of its petition to vacate

 

27


Table of Contents

to the United States Court of Appeals for the Ninth Circuit. On January 12, 2012, the Company, Ridefilm and Robots entered into a confidential settlement agreement, pursuant to which the parties fully and finally resolved and settled all claims between them relating to this dispute. The Company dismissed the Ninth Circuit appeal on January 27, 2012, and is in the process of dismissing the Ontario proceedings.

The Company and certain of its officers and directors were named as defendants in eight purported class action lawsuits filed between August 11, 2006 and September 18, 2006, alleging violations of U.S. federal securities laws. These eight actions were filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York. On January 18, 2007, the Court consolidated all eight class action lawsuits and appointed Westchester Capital Management, Inc. as the lead plaintiff and Abbey Spanier Rodd & Abrams, LLP as lead plaintiff’s counsel. On October 2, 2007, plaintiffs filed a consolidated amended class action complaint. The amended complaint, brought on behalf of shareholders who purchased the Company’s common stock on the NASDAQ between February 27, 2003 and July 20, 2007 (the “U.S. Class”), alleges primarily that the defendants engaged in securities fraud by disseminating materially false and misleading statements during the class period regarding the Company’s revenue recognition of theater system installations, and failing to disclose material information concerning the Company’s revenue recognition practices. The amended complaint also added PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, the Company’s auditors, as a defendant. On April 14, 2011, the Court issued an order appointing The Merger Fund as the lead plantiff and Abbey Spanier Rodd & Abrams, LLP as lead plantiff’s counsel. On November 2, 2011, the parties entered into a memorandum of understanding containing the terms and conditions of a settlement of this action. On January 26, 2012, the parties executed and filed with the Court a formal stipulation of settlement and proposed form of notice to the class, which the Court preliminarily approved on February 1, 2012. Under the terms of the settlement, members of the U.S. Class who do not opt out of the settlement will release defendants from liability for all claims that were alleged in this action or could have been alleged in this action or any other proceeding (including the Canadian Action) relating to the purchase of IMAX securities on the NASDAQ from February 27, 2003 and July 20, 2007 or the subject matter and facts relating to this action. As part of the settlement and in exchange for the release, defendants will pay $12.0 million to a settlement fund which amount will be funded by the carriers of the Company’s directors and officers insurance policy and by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP. On March 26, 2012, the parties executed and filed with the Court an amended formal stipulation of settlement and proposed form of notice to the class, which the court preliminarily approved on March 28, 2012. On June 20, 2012, the court issued an order granting final approval of the settlement. The settlement is conditioned on the Company’s receipt of an order from the court in the Canadian Action excluding from the class in the Canadian Action every member of the class in both actions who has not opted out of the U.S. settlement. The hearing on the motion for the order from the court in the Canadian Action occurred on July 30, 2012 and a decision from the court is pending.

A class action lawsuit was filed on September 20, 2006 in the Ontario Superior Court of Justice against the Company and certain of its officers and directors, alleging violations of Canadian securities laws. This lawsuit was brought on behalf of shareholders who acquired the Company’s securities between February 17, 2006 and August 9, 2006. The lawsuit is in an early procedural stage and seeks compensatory and punitive damages, as well as costs and expenses. The Company is unable to estimate a potential loss exposure at this time. For reasons released December 14, 2009, the Court granted leave to the Plaintiffs to amend their statement of claim to plead certain claims pursuant to the Securities Act (Ontario) against the Company and certain individuals and granted certification of the action as a class proceeding. These are procedural decisions, and do not contain any conclusions binding on a judge at trial as to the factual or legal merits of the claim. Leave to appeal those decisions was denied. The Company believes the allegations made against it in the statement of claim are meritless and will vigorously defend the matter, although no assurance can be given with respect to the ultimate outcome of such proceedings. The Company’s directors and officers insurance policy provides for reimbursement of costs and expenses incurred in connection with this lawsuit as well as potential damages awarded, if any, subject to certain policy limits, exclusions and deductibles.

In addition to the matters described above, the Company is currently involved in other legal proceedings which, in the opinion of the Company’s management, will not materially affect the Company’s financial position or future operating results, although no assurance can be given with respect to the ultimate outcome of any such proceedings.

 

Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures

Not applicable.

 

28


Table of Contents

PART II

 

Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters, and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

The Company’s common shares are listed for trading under the trading symbol “IMAX” on the NYSE. Prior to February 11, 2011, the Company’s common shares were listed for trading on the NASDAQ Global Select Market (“NASDAQ”). The common shares are also listed on the TSX under the trading symbol “IMX.” The following table sets forth the range of high and low sales prices per share for the common shares on NYSE and the TSX.

 

      U.S. Dollars  
     High      Low  

NYSE

  

  

Year ended December 31, 2012

     

Fourth quarter

   $ 23.20      $ 20.23  

Third quarter

   $ 25.34      $ 19.21  

Second quarter

   $ 25.03      $ 19.19  

First quarter

   $ 26.43      $ 17.83  

Year ended December 31, 2011

     

Fourth quarter

   $ 21.43      $ 13.57  

Third quarter

   $ 32.60      $ 14.00  

Second quarter

   $ 37.26      $ 29.04  

First quarter

   $ 32.35      $ 25.57  
      Canadian Dollars  
     High      Low  

TSX

     

Year ended December 31, 2012

     

Fourth quarter

   $ 23.22      $ 19.76  

Third quarter

   $ 25.73      $ 18.89  

Second quarter

   $ 24.64      $ 19.94  

First quarter

   $ 26.15      $ 18.03  

Year ended December 31, 2011

     

Fourth quarter

   $ 21.83      $ 14.25  

Third quarter

   $ 31.94      $ 13.86  

Second quarter

   $ 36.40      $ 28.46  

First quarter

   $ 31.43      $ 25.53  

As at January 31, 2013, the Company had approximately 259 registered holders of record of the Company’s common shares.

Within the last three years, the Company has not paid and has no current plans to pay, cash dividends on its common shares. The payment of dividends by the Company is subject to certain restrictions under the terms of the Company’s indebtedness (see note 12 to the accompanying audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8 and “Liquidity and Capital Resources” in Item 7). The payment of any future dividends will be determined by the Board of Directors in light of conditions then existing, including the Company’s financial condition and requirements, future prospects, restrictions in financing agreements, business conditions and other factors deemed relevant by the Board of Directors.

 

29


Table of Contents

Equity Compensation Plans

The following table sets forth information regarding the Company’s Equity Compensation Plan as at December 31, 2012:

 

Plan Category

   Number of Securities to be
Issued Upon Exercise of

Outstanding Options,
Warrants and Rights
(a)
     Weighted Average
Exercise Price of
Outstanding Options
(b)
     Number of  Securities
Remaining Available for
Future Issuance Under
Equity Compensation Plans
(Excluding Securities
Reflected in Column (a))
(c)
 

Equity compensation plans approved by security holders

     7,441,068      $ 18.48        5,855,417  

Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders

     nil         nil         nil   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     7,441,068      $ 18.48        5,855,417  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Performance Graph

The following graph compares the total cumulative shareholder return for $100 invested (assumes that all dividends were reinvested) in common shares of the Company against the cumulative total return of the NYSE Composite Index, the S&P/TSX Composite Index and the Bloomberg Hollywood Reporter Index on December 31, 2007 to the end of the most recently completed fiscal year.

 

LOGO

 

30


Table of Contents

CERTAIN INCOME TAX CONSIDERATIONS

United States Federal Income Tax Considerations

The following discussion is a general summary of the material U.S. federal income tax consequences of the ownership and disposition of the common shares by a holder of common shares that is an individual resident of the United States or a United States corporation (a “U.S. Holder”). This discussion does not discuss all aspects of U.S. federal income taxation that may be relevant to investors subject to special treatment under U.S. federal income tax law (including, for example, owners of 10.0% or more of the voting shares of the Company).

Distributions on Common Shares

In general, distributions (without reduction for Canadian withholding taxes) paid by the Company with respect to the common shares will be taxed to a U.S. Holder as dividend income to the extent that such distributions do not exceed the current and accumulated earnings and profits of the Company (as determined for U.S. federal income tax purposes). Subject to certain limitations, under current law dividends paid to non-corporate U.S. Holders may be eligible for a reduced rate of taxation as long as the Company is considered to be a “qualified foreign corporation”. A qualified foreign corporation includes a foreign corporation that is eligible for the benefits of an income tax treaty with the United States. The amount of a distribution that exceeds the earnings and profits of the Company will be treated first as a non-taxable return of capital to the extent of the U.S. Holder’s tax basis in the common shares and thereafter as taxable capital gain. Corporate holders generally will not be allowed a deduction for dividends received in respect of distributions on common shares. Subject to the limitations set forth in the U.S. Internal Revenue Code, as modified by the U.S.-Canada Income Tax Treaty, U.S. Holders may elect to claim a foreign tax credit against their U.S. federal income tax liability for Canadian income tax withheld from dividends. Alternatively, U.S. Holders may claim a deduction for such amounts of Canadian tax withheld.

Disposition of Common Shares

Upon the sale or other disposition of common shares, a U.S. Holder generally will recognize capital gain or loss equal to the difference between the amount realized on the sale and such holder’s tax basis in the common shares. Gain or loss upon the disposition of the common shares will be long-term if, at the time of the disposition, the common shares have been held for more than one year. Long-term capital gains of non-corporate U.S. Holders may be eligible for a reduced rate of taxation. The deduction of capital losses is subject to limitations for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

Canadian Federal Income Tax Considerations

This summary is applicable to a holder or prospective purchaser of common shares who, for the purposes of the Income Tax Act (Canada) and any applicable treaty and at all relevant times, is not (and is not deemed to be) resident in Canada, does not (and is not deemed to) use or hold the common shares in, or in the course of, carrying on a business in Canada, and is not an insurer that carries on an insurance business in Canada and elsewhere.

This summary is based on the current provisions of the Income Tax Act (Canada), the regulations thereunder, all specific proposals to amend such Act and regulations publicly announced by or on behalf of the Minister of Finance (Canada) prior to the date hereof and the Company’s understanding of the administrative and assessing practices published in writing by the Canada Revenue Agency prior to the date hereof. This summary does not otherwise take into account any change in law or administrative practice, whether by judicial, governmental, legislative or administrative decision or action, nor does it take into account other federal or provincial, territorial or foreign tax consequences, which may vary from the Canadian federal income tax considerations described herein.

This summary is of a general nature only and it is not intended to be, nor should it be construed to be, legal or tax advice to any holder of the common shares and no representation with respect to Canadian federal income tax consequences to any holder of common shares is made herein. Accordingly, prospective purchasers and holders of the common shares should consult their own tax advisers with respect to their individual circumstances.

Dividends on Common Shares

Canadian withholding tax at a rate of 25.0% (subject to reduction under the provisions of any relevant tax treaty) will be payable on dividends (or amounts paid on account or in lieu of payment of, or in satisfaction of, dividends) paid or credited to a holder of common shares outside of Canada. Under the Canada—U.S. Income Tax Convention (1980), as amended (the “Canada—U.S. Income

 

31


Table of Contents

Tax Treaty”) the withholding tax rate is generally reduced to 15.0% for a holder entitled to the benefits of the Canada—U.S. Income Tax Treaty who is the beneficial owner of the dividends (or 5.0% if the holder is a company that owns at least 10.0% of the common shares).

Capital Gains and Losses

Subject to the provisions of any relevant tax treaty, capital gains realized by a holder on the disposition or deemed disposition of common shares held as capital property will not be subject to Canadian tax unless the common shares are taxable Canadian property (as defined in the Income Tax Act (Canada)), in which case the capital gains will be subject to Canadian tax at rates which will approximate those payable by a Canadian resident. Common shares generally will not be taxable Canadian property to a holder provided that, at the time of the disposition or deemed disposition, the common shares are listed on a designated stock exchange (which currently includes the TSX) unless at any time within the 60 month period immediately preceding such time (a) such holder, persons with whom such holder did not deal at arm’s length or such holder together with all such persons, owned 25.0% or more of the issued shares of any class or series of shares of the Company and (b) more than 50% of the fair market value of the common shares was derived directly or indirectly from one or any combination of (i) real or immovable property situated in Canada, (ii) Canadian resource properties, (iii) timber resource properties, and (iv) options in respect of, or interests in, or for civil law rights in, property described in any of paragraphs (i) to (iii), whether or not the property exists. In certain circumstances set out in the Income Tax Act (Canada), the common shares may be deemed to be taxable Canadian property. Under the Canada-U.S. Income Tax Treaty, a holder entitled to the benefits of the Canada—U.S. Income Tax Treaty and to whom the common shares are taxable Canadian property will not be subject to Canadian tax on the disposition or deemed disposition of the common shares unless at the time of disposition or deemed disposition, the value of the common shares is derived principally from real property situated in Canada.

 

32


Table of Contents
Item 6. Selected Financial Data

The selected financial data set forth below is derived from the consolidated financial information of the Company. The financial information has been prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP. All financial information referred to herein is expressed in U.S. dollars unless otherwise noted.

Revision of Previously Issued Financial Statements

As explained in note 4 to the accompanying audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of the Company’s 2012 Form 10-K, during a review of the Company’s existing benefit packages, the Company determined that Canadian employees, upon meeting certain eligibility requirements, are entitled to postretirement health and welfare benefits for which the obligation had not been included in the prior financial statements as required under the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 715 “Compensation – Retirement Benefits”. The summary table below presents the impact of the revision adjustments for each of the years in the five year period ended December 31(1):

 

      2011     2010     2009     2008  

Net income (loss), as previously reported

   $ 15,543      $ 100,779      $ 5,021      $ (33,602

Less: Selling, general and administrative expenses

     (378     (328     (293     (284

Add: Recovery of income taxes

     95        789        —          62   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss), as revised

   $ 15,260      $ 101,240      $ 4,728      $ (33,824
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted EPS, as reported

   $ 0.23      $ 1.51      $ 0.09      $ (0.79
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted EPS, as revised

   $ 0.22      $ 1.52      $ 0.09      $ (0.80
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) The net impact of the revision adjustments to shareholders’ equity (deficiency) as of December 31, 2007 was a net increase of $2.5 million to the deficiency.

 

33


Table of Contents
Item 6. Selected Financial Data (continued)

The selected financial data set forth below is derived from the consolidated financial information of the Company. The financial information has been prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP. All financial information referred to herein is expressed in U.S. dollars unless otherwise noted.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
(In thousands of U.S. dollars, except per share amounts)    2012     2011     2010     2009     2008  
           As Revised     As Revised     As Revised     As Revised  

Statements of Operations Data:

          

Revenues

          

Equipment and product sales

   $ 78,161      $ 85,016      $ 72,578      $ 57,304      $ 27,853   

Services

     136,606        106,720        123,911        82,052        61,477   

Rentals

     61,268        34,810        46,936        25,758        8,207   

Finance income

     7,523        6,162        4,789        4,235        4,300   

Other(1)

     732        3,848        400        1,862        881   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     284,290        236,556        248,614        171,211        102,718   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Costs and expenses applicable to revenues

          

Equipment and product sales(2)(3)

     37,538        38,742        36,394        29,040        17,182   

Services(2)(3)

     72,617        69,277        63,425        49,891        40,771   

Rentals(3)

     21,402        14,301        11,111        10,093        7,043   

Other

     —          1,018        32        635        169   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     131,557        123,338        110,962        89,659        65,165   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross margin

     152,733        113,218        137,652        81,552        37,553   

Selling, general and administrative expenses(4)

     81,560        73,157        78,757        56,500        43,965   

Provision for arbitration award(5)

     —          2,055        —          —          —     

Research and development

     11,411        7,829        6,249        3,755        7,461   

Amortization of intangibles

     706        465        513        546        526   

Receivable provisions, net of recoveries

     524        1,570        1,443        1,067        1,977   

Asset impairments(6)

     —          28        45        180        —     

Impairment of available-for-sale investment(7)

     150        —          —          —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

     58,382        28,114        50,645        19,504        (16,376

Interest income

     85        57        399        98        381   

Interest expense

     (689     (1,827     (1,885     (13,845     (17,707

Loss on repurchase of Senior Notes due December 2010(8)

     —          —          —          (579     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

     57,778        26,344        49,159        5,178        (33,702

(Provision for) recovery of income taxes(9)

     (15,079     (9,293     52,574        (274     (30

Loss from equity-accounted investments

     (1,362     (1,791     (493     —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) from continuing operations

     41,337        15,260        101,240        4,904        (33,732

Net loss from discontinued operations(10)

     —          —          —          (176     (92
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ 41,337      $ 15,260      $ 101,240      $ 4,728      $ (33,824
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per share—basic and diluted:

          

Net income (loss) per share—basic:

          

Net income (loss) from continuing operations

   $ 0.63      $ 0.24      $ 1.59      $ 0.09      $ (0.80

Net income from discontinued operations

   $ —        $ —        $ —        $ —        $ —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 0.63      $ 0.24      $ 1.59      $ 0.09      $ (0.80
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per share—diluted:

          

Net income (loss) from continuing operations

   $ 0.61      $ 0.22      $ 1.52      $ 0.09      $ (0.80

Net income from discontinued operations

   $ —        $ —        $ —        $ —        $ —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 0.61      $ 0.22      $ 1.52      $ 0.09      $ (0.80
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

34


Table of Contents

 

(1) The Company enters into theater system arrangements with customers that typically contain customer payment obligations prior to the scheduled installation of the theater systems. During the period of time between signing and theater system installation, certain customers each year are unable to, or elect not to, proceed with the theater system installation for a number of reasons, including business considerations, or the inability to obtain certain consents, approvals or financing. Once the determination is made that the customer will not proceed with installation, the customer and/or the Company may terminate the arrangement by default or by entering into a consensual buyout. In these situations the parties are released from their future obligations under the arrangement, and the initial payments that the customer previously made to the Company and recognized as revenue are typically not refunded. In addition, the Company enters into agreements with customers to terminate their obligations for a theater system configuration and enter into a new arrangement for a different configuration. Other revenues from settlement arrangements were $0.7 million, $3.8 million, $0.4 million, $1.9 million, and $0.9 million in 2012, 2011, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.
(2) In 2012, the Company recognized a charge of $0.9 million in costs and expenses applicable to revenues for the write-down of certain service parts and film-based inventories. Included for the periods 2008 through 2012 are the following inventory write-downs:

 

                                                                               
     2012      2011      2010      2009      2008  

Equipment and product sales

   $ 795      $ —        $ 827      $ 48      $ 2,397  

Services

     103        —          172        849        93  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 898      $ —        $ 999      $ 897      $ 2,490  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(3) The Company recorded advertising, marketing, and commission costs for the periods 2008 through 2012 as listed below:

 

                                                                               
     2012      2011      2010      2009      2008  

Equipment and product sales

   $ 2,690      $ 2,394      $ 1,925      $ 2,041      $ 1,035  

Services

     4,773        5,648        2,793        2,381        1,622  

Rentals

     3,381        5,432        4,236        3,405        1,788  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Advertising, marketing, and commission costs

   $ 10,844      $ 13,474      $ 8,954      $ 7,827      $ 4,445  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(4) Includes share-based compensation expense of $13.1 million, $11.7 million, $26.0 million, $17.5 million and $1.0 million for 2012, 2011, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.
(5) In 2011, the Company recorded a provision of $2.1 million regarding an award issued in connection with an arbitration proceeding brought against the Company, relating to agreements entered into in 1994 and 1995 by its former Ridefilm subsidiary, whose business the Company discontinued through a sale to a third party in March 2001. The award was vacated as the parties entered into a confidential settlement agreement in which the parties agreed to dismiss any outstanding disputes among them. See note 14(c) of the accompanying audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8 for more information.
(6) In 2012, the Company recorded asset impairment charges of $nil. Asset impairment charges related to the impairment of assets of certain theater operations amounted to less than $0.1 million, less than $0.1 million, $0.2 million and $nil in 2011, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, after the Company assessed the carrying value of certain assets.
(7) In 2012, the Company recognized a $0.2 million other-than-temporary impairment of its available-for-sale investment as the value is not expected to recover based on the length of time and extent to which the market value has been less than cost.

 

35


Table of Contents
(8) In 2009, the Company repurchased all of its outstanding $160.0 million aggregate principal amount of the Company’s 9.625% Senior Notes. The Company paid cash to reacquire its bonds, thereby releasing the Company from further obligations to various holders under the indenture governing the Senior Notes. The Company accounted for the bond repurchase in accordance with the Debt Topic of the FASB ASC whereby the net carrying amount of the debt extinguished was the face value of the bonds adjusted for any unamortized premium, discount and costs of issuance, which resulted in a loss of $0.6 million.
(9) The recovery for income taxes in the year ended December 31, 2010 includes a net non-cash income tax benefit of $55.5 million related to a decrease in the valuation allowance for the Company’s deferred tax assets and other tax adjustments. This release of the valuation allowance was recorded after it was determined that realization of this deferred income tax benefit is now more likely than not based on current and anticipated future earnings trends.
(10) In 2009, the Company closed its owned and operated Vancouver and Tempe IMAX theaters. The net loss from the operation of the theaters are reflected as discontinued operations, as there are no continuing cash flows from either a migration or a continuation of activities

BALANCE SHEET DATA

 

                                                                                              
(in thousands of U.S. dollars)    As at December 31,  
     2012      2011(2)      2010(2)      2009(2)      2008(2)  

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 21,336       $ 18,138       $ 30,390       $ 20,081       $ 27,017   

Total assets(1)

   $ 421,872       $ 407,249       $ 349,948       $ 247,546       $ 228,667   

Total indebtedness

   $ 11,000       $ 55,083       $ 17,500       $ 50,000       $ 180,000   

Total shareholders’ equity (deficiency)

   $ 253,079       $ 189,868       $ 155,878       $ 42,136       $ (99,333 )(3) 

 

(1) 2009 and 2008 balance sheet data includes the assets of discontinued operations.
(2) 2011, 2010, 2009 and 2008 total assets and total shareholders’ equity (deficiency) have been revised to reflect an unfunded postretirement obligation of the Company.
(3) Includes opening retained earnings net decrease of $2.5 million for years prior to 2008 as a result of the revision adjustments.

 

36


Table of Contents

QUARTERLY STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS SUPPLEMENTARY DATA (UNAUDITED)

 

     2012  
(in thousands of U.S. dollars, except per share amounts)    Q1(1)     Q2(1)     Q3(1)     Q4  

Revenues

   $ 55,596     $ 70,210     $ 80,711     $ 77,773  

Costs and expenses applicable to revenues

     28,735       31,377       35,961       35,484  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross margin

   $ 26,861     $ 38,833     $ 44,750     $ 42,289  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income—as previously reported

   $ 2,588     $ 11,080     $ 14,990    

Adjustment resulting from a correction to reflect an unfunded postretirement obligation

     (79     (46     (79  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

Net income—as revised (for Q1 through Q3)

   $ 2,509     $ 11,034     $ 14,911     $ 12,883  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income per share—basic—as previously reported

   $ 0.04     $ 0.17     $ 0.23    

Net income per share—basic—as revised (for Q1 through Q3)

   $ 0.04     $ 0.17     $ 0.23     $ 0.19  

Net income per share—diluted—as previously reported

   $ 0.04     $ 0.16     $ 0.22    

Net income per share—diluted—as revised (for Q1 through Q3)

   $ 0.04     $ 0.16     $ 0.22     $ 0.19  
      2011  
     Q1(1)     Q2(1)     Q3(1)     Q4(1)  

Revenues

   $ 45,160     $ 57,232     $ 67,488     $ 66,676  

Costs and expenses applicable to revenues

     24,514       30,930       31,050       36,844  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross margin

   $ 20,646     $ 26,302     $ 36,438     $ 29,832  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (loss) income—as previously reported

   $ (1,003   $ 1,825     $ 8,392     $ 6,329  

Adjustment resulting from a correction to reflect an unfunded postretirement obligation

     (71     (71     (70     (71
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (loss) income—as revised

   $ (1,074   $ 1,754     $ 8,322     $ 6,258  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (loss) income per share—basic—as previously reported

   $ (0.02   $ 0.03     $ 0.13     $ 0.10  

Net (loss) income per share—basic—as revised

   $ (0.02   $ 0.03     $ 0.13     $ 0.10  

Net (loss) income per share—diluted—as previously reported

   $ (0.02   $ 0.03     $ 0.13     $ 0.09  

Net (loss) income per share—diluted—as revised

   $ (0.02   $ 0.03     $ 0.12     $ 0.09  

 

(1) As disclosed in note 4 to the accompanying audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8, the Company identified an error in the fourth quarter of 2012. Management has assessed the materiality of the error and has determined it was not material to any prior period. The Company will revise the comparative numbers presented in future quarterly filings as filed.

 

37


Table of Contents
Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

GENERAL

IMAX Corporation, together with its wholly-owned subsidiaries (the “Company”), is one of the world’s leading entertainment technology companies, specializing in motion picture technologies and presentations. The Company refers to all theaters using the IMAX theater system as “IMAX theaters.” The Company combines proprietary software, architecture and equipment to create the highest-quality, most immersive motion picture experience for which the IMAX® brand has become known globally. Top filmmakers and studios are utilizing IMAX theaters to connect with audiences in extraordinary ways, and, as such, IMAX’s network is among the most important and successful theatrical distribution platforms for major event films around the world. As of December 31, 2012 there were 731 IMAX theater systems (598 commercial multiplexes, 19 commercial destinations, 114 institutional) operating in 53 countries. This compares to 634 theater systems (497 commercial multiplexes, 20 commercial destinations, 117 institutional) operating in 50 countries as of December 31, 2011.

IMAX theater systems combine:

 

   

IMAX DMR (Digital Re-Mastering) movie conversion technology, which results in higher image and sound fidelity than conventional cinema experiences;

 

   

advanced, high-resolution projectors with specialized equipment and automated theater control systems, which generate significantly more contrast and brightness than conventional theater systems;

 

   

large screens and proprietary theater geometry, which result in a substantially larger field of view so that the screen extends to the edge of a viewer’s peripheral vision and creates more realistic images;

 

   

sound system components, which deliver more expansive sound imagery and pinpointed origination of sound to any specific spot in an IMAX theater; and

 

   

specialized theater acoustics, which result in a four-fold reduction in background noise.

The combination of these components causes audiences in IMAX theaters to feel as if they are a part of the on-screen action, creating a more intense, immersive and exciting experience than in a traditional theater. In addition, the Company’s IMAX 3D theater systems combine the same theater systems with 3D images that further enhance the audience’s feeling of being immersed in the film.

As a result of the immersiveness and superior image and sound quality of The IMAX Experience, the Company’s exhibitor customers typically charge a premium for IMAX DMR films over films exhibited in their other auditoriums. The premium pricing, combined with the higher attendance levels associated with IMAX, generates incremental box office for the Company’s exhibitor customers and for the movie studios releasing their films to the IMAX network. The incremental box office generated by IMAX DMR films has helped establish IMAX as a key premium distribution and marketing platform for Hollywood blockbuster films. Driven by the introduction of its digital projection system into the marketplace in 2008, the number of IMAX DMR films released to the theater network per year has increased to 35 films in 2012, up from 25 films in 2011 and 6 films in 2007. The Company expects to release a similar number of IMAX DMR films in 2013 as compared to 2012.

As one of the world’s leaders in entertainment technology, the Company strives to remain at the forefront of advancements in cinema technology. Accordingly, one of the Company’s key short-term initiatives is the development of a next-generation laser-based digital projection system. In 2011, the Company announced the completion of a deal in which it secured certain exclusive license rights to a portfolio of intellectual property in the digital cinema field owned by the Eastman Kodak Company (“Kodak”). The transaction involves rights to technology related to laser projection as well as rights in the digital cinema field to a broader range of Kodak technology. On February 7, 2012, the Company announced an agreement with Barco N.V. (“Barco”) to co-develop a laser-based digital projection system that incorporates Kodak technology. The Company believes that these arrangements with Kodak and Barco will enable IMAX laser projectors to present greater brightness and clarity, a wider color gamut and deeper blacks, and consume less power and last longer than existing digital technology. The Company believes that a laser projection solution, which it plans to start to roll-out in the second half of 2014, will allow IMAX’s network to show the highest quality of digital content and provide the Company the ability to illuminate the largest screens in its network, which are currently film-based.

Important factors that the Company’s Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”) Richard L. Gelfond uses in assessing the Company’s business and prospects include:

 

   

the signing, installation and financial performance of theater system arrangements (particularly its joint revenue sharing arrangements);

 

   

film performance and the securing of new film projects (particularly IMAX DMR films);

 

   

revenue and gross margins from the Company’s operating segments;

 

38


Table of Contents
   

operating leverage;

 

   

earnings from operations as adjusted for unusual items that the Company views as non-recurring;

 

   

short—and long-term cash flow projections;

 

   

the continuing ability to invest in and improve the Company’s technology to enhance its differentiation of presentation versus other cinematic experiences; and

 

   

the overall execution, reliability and consumer acceptance of The IMAX Experience, related technologies and new initiatives.

The primary revenue sources for the Company can be categorized into two main groups: theater systems and films. On the theater systems side, the Company derives revenues from theater exhibitors primarily through either a sale or sales-type lease arrangement or a joint revenue sharing arrangement. Theater exhibitors also pay for associated maintenance and extended warranty services. Film revenue is derived primarily from film studios for the provision of film production and digital re-mastering services for exhibition on IMAX theater systems around the world. A portion of the Company’s film revenues are also derived from the distribution of certain films and the provision of post-production services. The Company also derives a small portion of other revenues from the operation of its own theaters, the provision of aftermarket parts for its system components, and camera rentals.

IMAX Theater Systems: IMAX Systems (Sales and Sales-type Leases), Joint Revenue Sharing Arrangements and Theater System Maintenance

One of the Company’s principal businesses is the design, manufacture and delivery of premium theater systems (“IMAX theater systems”). The theater system equipment components (including the projection system, sound system, screen system and, if applicable, 3D glasses cleaning machine), theater design support, supervision of installation, projectionist training and the use of the IMAX brand are all elements of what the Company considers the system deliverable (the “System Deliverable”). The IMAX theater systems are based on proprietary and patented technology developed over the course of the Company’s 45-year history. The Company’s customers who purchase, lease or otherwise acquire the IMAX theater systems through joint revenue sharing arrangements are theater exhibitors that operate commercial theaters (particularly multiplexes), museums, science centers, or destination entertainment sites. The Company generally does not own IMAX theaters, but licenses the use of its trademarks along with the sale, lease or contribution of the IMAX theater system.

IMAX Systems

The Company provides IMAX theater systems to customers on a sales or long-term lease basis, typically with an initial 10-year term. These agreements typically comprise of initial fees and ongoing fees (which can include a fixed minimum amount per annum and contingent fees in excess of the minimum payments) and maintenance and extended warranty fees. The initial fees vary depending on the system configuration and location of the theater and generally are paid to the Company in installments between the time of system signing and the time of system installation, which is when the total of these fees, in addition to the present value of future annual minimum payments, are recognized as revenue. Ongoing fees are paid over the term of the contract, commencing after the theater system has been installed and are generally equal to the greater of a fixed minimum amount per annum or a percentage of box-office receipts. Contingent payments in excess of fixed minimum ongoing payments are recognized as revenue when reported by theater operators, provided collectibility is reasonably assured. Typically, ongoing fees are indexed to a local consumer price index. Finance income is derived over the term of a financed sale or sales-type lease arrangement as the unearned income on that financed sale or sales-type lease is earned.

Under a sales agreement, title to the theater system equipment components passes to the customer. In certain instances, however, the Company retains title or a security interest in the equipment until the customer has made all payments required under the agreement. Under the terms of a sales-type lease agreement, title to the theater system equipment components remains with the Company. The Company has the right to remove the equipment for non-payment or other defaults by the customer.

The revenue earned from customers under the Company’s theater system sales or lease agreements can vary from quarter to quarter and year to year based on a number of factors, including the number and mix of theater system configurations sold or leased, the timing of installation of the theater systems, the nature of the arrangement and other factors specific to individual contracts.

Joint Revenue Sharing Arrangements

The Company also provides IMAX theater systems to customers under joint revenue sharing arrangements, pursuant to which the Company provides the IMAX theater system in return for a portion of the customer’s IMAX box-office receipts, and in some cases concession revenues and/or a small upfront or initial payment. Pursuant to these revenue-sharing arrangements, the Company retains

 

39


Table of Contents

title to the theater system equipment components and rent payments are contingent, instead of fixed or determinable, on film performance. Joint revenue sharing arrangements generally have a 10-year initial term are typically renewable by the customer for one or more additional terms of between 5 and 10 years. The Company has the right to remove the equipment for non-payment or other defaults by the customer. The contracts are generally non-cancellable by the customer unless the Company fails to perform its obligations.

The introduction of joint revenue sharing arrangements has been an important factor in the expansion of the Company’s commercial theater network, which has grown by approximately 245% since 2008. Joint revenue sharing arrangements allow commercial theater exhibitors to install IMAX theater systems without the significant initial capital investment required in a sale or sales-type lease arrangement. Since customers under joint revenue sharing arrangements pay the Company a portion of their ongoing box office, joint revenue sharing arrangements also drive recurring cash flows and earnings for the Company. The retirement of a significant portion of the Company’s debt during 2009, increased cash flows from operations during subsequent years and the Company’s expanded credit facility has allowed the Company the financial flexibility to fund the expansion of its joint revenue sharing strategy. As at December 31, 2012, the Company had 316 theaters in operation under joint revenue sharing arrangements, a 23.0% increase as compared to the 257 joint revenue sharing arrangements open as at December 31, 2011. The Company also had contracts in backlog for an additional 137 theaters under joint revenue sharing arrangements as at December 31, 2012.

The Company cautions that as an increasing portion of its revenues are derived from IMAX theaters under joint revenue sharing arrangements, it is increasingly subject to the success or failure of its IMAX DMR film slate. The revenue earned from customers under the Company’s joint revenue sharing arrangements can vary from quarter to quarter and year to year based on a number of factors including film performance, the mix of theater system configurations, the timing of installation of these theater systems, the nature of the arrangement, the location, size and management of the theater and other factors specific to individual arrangements. Ongoing revenue from theater systems under joint revenue sharing arrangements is derived from box-office results and concession revenues reported by the theater operator, provided collectibility is reasonably assured.

Theater System Maintenance

For all IMAX theaters, theater owners or operators are also generally responsible for paying the Company an annual maintenance and extended warranty fee. Annual maintenance fees are generally paid throughout the duration of the term of the theater agreements and are typically indexed to a local consumer price index.

Films: Digital Re-Mastering (IMAX DMR) and other film revenue

Production and Digital Re-Mastering (IMAX DMR)

In 2002, the Company developed a proprietary technology to digitally re-master Hollywood films into IMAX digital cinema package format or 15/70-format film at a modest cost incurred by the Company for exhibition in IMAX theaters. This system, known as IMAX DMR, digitally enhances the image resolution of motion picture films for projection on IMAX screens while maintaining or enhancing the visual clarity and sound quality to levels for which The IMAX Experience is known. This technology enabled the IMAX theater network to release Hollywood films simultaneously with their broader domestic release. The development of this technology was critical in helping the Company execute its strategy of expanding its commercial theater network by establishing IMAX theaters as a key, premium distribution platform for Hollywood films. In a typical IMAX DMR film arrangement, the Company will receive a percentage of net box-office receipts of any commercial films released in the IMAX network, which is generally 10-15%, from a film studio for the conversion of the film to the IMAX DMR format and access to its premium distribution platform. In 2012, 35 films converted through the IMAX DMR process were released to theaters within the IMAX network (2011—25 films converted through the IMAX DMR process). To date, the Company has announced the release of 23 IMAX DMR titles to theaters within the IMAX network in 2013. The Company remains in active discussions with every major studio regarding future titles for 2013 and beyond, and expects a similar number of IMAX DMR films to be released to the IMAX network in 2013 as in 2012.

The Company believes that its international expansion is an important driver of future growth for the Company. In fact, during 2012, 49.3% of the Company’s gross box-office from DMR films was generated in international markets, as compared to 47.6% in 2011. To support growth in international markets, the Company has sought to bolster its international film slate through local language IMAX DMR releases in select international markets, as well as early international releases. During 2012, five local language IMAX DMR films were released, including one French film, Houba! On the Trail of the Marsupilami: The IMAX Experience and four Chinese IMAX DMR titles: Tai Chi 0: An IMAX 3D Experience, Tai Chi Hero: An IMAX 3D Experience, Back to 1942: The IMAX Experience and CZ12: The IMAX Experience. In 2013, additional Chinese IMAX DMR films are expected to be released to IMAX

 

40


Table of Contents

theaters in Greater China, including the recent releases of The Grandmaster: The IMAX Experience and Journey to the West: Conquering the Demons: An IMAX 3D Experience. Also in 2013, Dragon Ball Z: Battle of the Gods: An IMAX 3D Experience, a Japanese IMAX DMR film, Stalingrad: An IMAX 3D Experience, a Russian IMAX DMR film, Dhoom 3: The IMAX Experience, an Indian IMAX DMR film will be released to IMAX theaters within the respective markets. The Company expects to announce additional local language IMAX DMR films to be released to the IMAX network in 2013 and beyond. Supplementing the Company’s film slate of Hollywood DMR titles with appealing local DMR titles is an important component of the Company’s international film strategy.

Film Distribution and Post-Production

The Company is also a distributor of large-format films, primarily catering to its institutional theater partners. The Company generally distributes films which it produces or for which it has acquired distribution rights from independent producers. The Company generally receives a percentage of the theater box-office receipts as a distribution fee.

Films produced by the Company are typically financed through third parties, whereby the Company will generally receive a film production fee in exchange for producing the film and a distribution fee for distributing the film. The ownership rights to such films may be held by the film sponsors, the film investors and/or the Company. The Company utilizes third-party funding for the majority of original films it produces and distributes. In 2012, the Company, along with Warner Bros. Pictures (“WB”) and MacGillivray Freeman Films (“MFF”) released an original title, To the Artic 3D: An IMAX 3D Experience. In 2011, the Company, along with WB, released Born to be Wild 3D: An IMAX 3D Experience. In January 2013, the Company announced an agreement with MFF to jointly finance, market and distribute up to four films (with an option for four additional films) produced by MFF to be released exclusively to IMAX theaters. The agreement will provide IMAX’s institutional theater partners access to a steady flow of the highest-quality, large-format documentaries over the years to come.

David Keighley Productions 70MM Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, provides film post-production and quality control services for large-format films (whether produced internally or externally), and digital post-production services.

Other Revenues

The Company derives a small portion of its revenues from other sources. As at December 31, 2012 and 2011, the Company had four owned and operated theaters. In addition, the Company has a commercial arrangement with one theater resulting in the sharing of profits and losses and provides management services to two theaters. The Company also rents its proprietary 2D and 3D large-format film and digital cameras to third party production companies. The Company maintains cameras and other film equipment and also offers production advice and technical assistance to both documentary and Hollywood filmmakers. Additionally, the Company generates revenues from the sale of after-market parts and 3D glasses.

See “Critical Accounting Policies” below for further discussion on the Company’s revenue recognition policies.

 

41


Table of Contents

IMAX Theater Network

The following table outlines the breakdown of the theater network by type and geographic location as at December 31:

 

     2012 Theater Network Base      2011 Theater Network Base  
     Commercial
Multiplex
     Commercial
Destination
     Institutional      Total      Commercial
Multiplex
     Commercial
Destination
     Institutional      Total  

United States

     290        6        57        353        269        6        61        336  

Canada

     34        2        7        43        26        2        7        35  

Greater China(1)

     108        —          20        128        70        —          18        88  

Asia (excluding Greater China)

     46        3        7        56        35        3        9        47  

Western Europe

     42        7        11        60        36        7        10        53  

Russia & the CIS

     32        —          —          32        22        —          —          22  

Latin America(2)

     19        —          10        29        15        —          10        25  

Rest of the World

     27        1        2        30        24        2        2        28  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     598        19        114        731        497        20        117        634  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) Greater China includes China, Hong Kong, Taiwan and Macau.
(2) Latin America includes South America, Central America and Mexico.

As of December 31, 2012, approximately 54.2% of IMAX systems in operation are located in the United States and Canada compared to 58.5% as at the end of last year. Approximately 19.9% of IMAX theater systems arrangements in backlog are scheduled to be installed in the United States and Canada compared to 16.0% last year. The commercial exhibitor market in the United States and Canada represents an important customer base for the Company in terms of both collections under existing arrangements and potential future theater system contracts. The Company has targeted these operators for the sale or sales-type lease of its IMAX digital projection system, as well as for joint revenue sharing arrangements. While the Company is pleased with its progress in the U.S. and Canadian exhibitor markets, there is no assurance that the Company’s progress in these markets will continue, particularly as a higher percentage of these markets are penetrated. To minimize the Company’s credit risk in this area, the Company retains title to the underlying theater systems leased, performs initial and ongoing credit evaluations of its customers and makes ongoing provisions for its estimates of potentially uncollectible amounts.

While the Company continues to grow domestically, it believes that the majority of its future growth will come from underpenetrated, international markets. As at December 31, 2012, approximately 45.8% of IMAX systems in operation were located within international markets (defined as all countries other than the United States and Canada), as compared to 41.5% as at December 31, 2011. The Company expects growth in international markets to be an increasingly significant part of its business. There are, however, risks associated with the Company’s international business. See Risk Factors – “The Company conducts business internationally, which exposes it to uncertainties and risks that could negatively affect its operations, sales and future growth prospects” in Item 1A of the Company’s 2012 Form 10-K.

During 2011, the Company formed IMAX (Shanghai) Multimedia Technology Co., Ltd. (“IMAX China”), a wholly-owned subsidiary, to enable further growth in Greater China, the Company’s second-largest and fastest-growing market. The Company believes that favorable market trends in China, including government initiatives to foster cinema screen growth, to increase the number of Hollywood films distributed in China (particularly IMAX and 3D films), and to support the film industry, present opportunities for additional growth, though the Company cautions that its expansion in China faces a number of challenges. See Risk Factors – “The Company faces risks in connection with the continued expansion of its business in China” in Item 1A of the Company’s 2012 Form 10-K. In March 2011, the Company announced a 75-theater joint revenue sharing arrangement with Wanda Cinema Line Corporation, China’s largest cinema chain (“Wanda”). The agreement with Wanda, which represents IMAX’s largest single international joint revenue sharing arrangement to date, brings the total number of IMAX theaters open or in backlog in Greater China to 250. As at December 31, 2012, IMAX China had offices in Shanghai and Beijing and a total of 51 employees. On February 18, 2012, the U.S. and Chinese governments announced the terms of an agreement to expand the number of Hollywood films to be released in China to include 14 additional IMAX or 3D format films and to permit distributors to receive higher distribution fees. The Company believes this is a positive development for its business in China and elsewhere.

 

42


Table of Contents

The following table outlines the breakdown of the Commercial Multiplex theater network by arrangement type and geographic location as at December 31:

 

     2012      2011  
     IMAX Commercial Multiplex Theater Network      IMAX Commercial Multiplex Theater Network  
     JRSA      Sale / Sales-
type lease
     Total      JRSA      Sale / Sales-
type lease
     Total  

Domestic Total (United States & Canada)

     212        112        324        192        103        295  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

International:

                 

Greater China

     54        54        108        30        40        70  

Asia (excluding Greater China)

     26        20        46        22        13        35  

Western Europe

     24        18        42        13        23        36  

Russia & the CIS

     —          32        32        —          22        22  

Latin America

     —          19        19        —          15        15  

Rest of the World

     —          27        27        —          24        24  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

International Total

     104        170        274        65        137        202  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Worldwide Total

     316        282        598        257        240        497  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

As at December 31, 2012, 212 (2011 — 192) of the 316 (2011 — 257) theaters under joint revenue sharing arrangements in operation, or 67.1% (2011 — 74.7%) were located in the United States and Canada, with the remaining 104 (2011 — 65) or 32.9% of arrangements being located in international markets. The Company continues to seek to expand the number of theaters under joint revenue sharing arrangements it has in select international markets.

Sales Backlog

The number of theater systems in the backlog and their dollar value fluctuates depending on the number of new theater system arrangements signed from quarter to quarter, which adds to backlog, and its installation and acceptance of theater systems and the settlement of contracts, both of which reduce backlog. Sales backlog typically represents the fixed contracted revenue under signed theater system sale and lease agreements that the Company believes will be recognized as revenue upon installation and acceptance of the associated theater. Sales backlog includes initial fees along with the estimated present value of contractual ongoing fees due over the lease term; however, it excludes amounts allocated to maintenance and extended warranty revenues as well as fees in excess of contractual ongoing fees that may be received in the future. The value of sales backlog does not include revenue from theaters in which the Company has an equity interest, operating leases, letters of intent or long-term conditional theater commitments. The value of theaters under joint revenue sharing arrangements is generally excluded from the dollar value or sales backlog, although certain theater systems under joint revenue sharing arrangements provide for contracted upfront payments and therefore carry a backlog value based on these payments. The Company believes that the contractual obligations for theater system installations that are listed in sales backlog are valid and binding commitments.

The Company’s sales backlog is as follows:

 

     December 31, 2012      December 31, 2011  
     Number of
Systems
    Dollar Value
(
in thousands)
     Number of
Systems
    Dollar Value
(
in thousands)
 

Sales and sale-type lease arrangements

     139 (1)    $ 168,101        144 (1)    $ 176,184  

Joint revenue sharing arrangements

     137       31,652        119       21,516  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     276     $ 199,753        263     $ 197,700  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Includes 11 upgrades from a film-based theater system to a digital theater system in an existing IMAX theater location (including one laser-based system in a commercial theater and 4 laser-based systems in institutional theaters).

 

43


Table of Contents

The following table outlines the breakdown of the total backlog by arrangement type and geographic location as at December 31:

 

     2012     2011  
     JRSA      Sale / Sales-
type lease
    Total     JRSA      Sale / Sales-
type lease
    Total  

Domestic Total (United States & Canada)

     39        16       55       24        18       42  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

International:

              

Greater China

     80        42       122       81        43       124  

Asia (excluding Greater China)

     14        19       33       9        16       25  

Western Europe

     4        1       5       5        1       6  

Russia & the CIS

     —          23       23       —          23       23  

Latin America

     —          35       35       —          38       38  

Rest of the World

     —          3       3       —          5       5  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

International Total

     98        123       221       95        126       221  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Worldwide Total

     137        139 (1)      276 (1)      119        144  (2)      263  (2) 
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Includes 11 upgrades from a film-based theater system to a digital theater system in an existing IMAX theater location (including one laser-based system in a commercial theater and 4 laser-based systems in institutional theaters).
(2) Includes 10 upgrades from a film-based theater system to a digital theater system in an existing IMAX theater location (all commercial theaters).

The Company believes that over time its commercial multiplex theater network could grow to approximately 1,700 IMAX theaters worldwide from 598 commercial multiplex IMAX theaters operating as of December 31, 2012 and expects the majority of its future growth to come from underpenetrated, international markets. Approximately 80.1% of IMAX theater system arrangements in backlog as at December 31, 2012 are scheduled to be installed within international markets, compared with 84.0% as at December 31, 2011. Of the Company’s 121 new theater signings in 2012, 77 were signings for theaters in international markets.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012     2011  

Theater System Signings:

    

Full new sales and sale-type lease arrangements

     43        58  

New joint revenue sharing arrangements

     78        132  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total new theaters

     121        190  

Upgrades of IMAX theater systems

     21 (1)(2)      19  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total theater signings

     142        209  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012     2011  

Theater System Installations:

    

Full new sales and sale-type lease arrangements

     47        51  

New joint revenue sharing arrangements

     60        86  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total new installations

     107        137  

Upgrades of IMAX theater systems

     18        33  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total theater installations

     125        170  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

Includes three IMAX theaters acquired from another existing customer that had been operating under a joint revenue sharing

 

44


Table of Contents
  arrangement. These theaters were purchased from the Company under a sales arrangement. This transaction is not included in the Company’s theater system installations table presented above.
(2) Includes 17 upgrades from film-based theater systems to digital theater systems in existing IMAX theater locations, including one laser-based system in a commercial theater and 4 laser-based systems in institutional theaters.

The Company estimates that it will install approximately 110 to 125 new theater systems (excluding digital upgrades) in 2013. Unlike in previous years in which the Company’s installation estimates were limited to scheduled installations from backlog, the Company now includes in its estimates not only scheduled systems from backlog, but also the Company’s estimate of installations from arrangements that will sign and install in the same calendar year. The Company cautions, however, that theater system installations slip from period to period in the course of the Company’s business, usually for reasons beyond its control.

From time to time, in the normal course of its business, the Company, will have customers who are unable to proceed with a theater system installation for a number of reasons, including the inability to obtain certain consents, approvals or financing. Once the determination is made that the customer will not proceed with installation, the agreement with the customer is generally terminated or amended. If the agreement is terminated, once the Company and the customer are released from all their future obligations under the agreement, all or a portion of the initial rents or fees that the customer previously made to the Company are recognized as revenue.

CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES

The Company prepares its consolidated financial statements in accordance with United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (“U.S. GAAP”).

The preparation of these consolidated financial statements requires management to make estimates and judgments that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses. On an ongoing basis, management evaluates its estimates, including those related to selling prices associated with the individual elements in multiple element arrangements; residual values of leased theater systems; economic lives of leased assets; allowances for potential uncollectibility of accounts receivable, financing receivables and net investment in leases; provisions for inventory obsolescence; ultimate revenues for film assets; impairment provisions for film assets, long-lived assets and goodwill; depreciable lives of property, plant and equipment; useful lives of intangible assets; pension plan and post retirement assumptions; accruals for contingencies including tax contingencies; valuation allowances for deferred income tax assets; and, estimates of the fair value and expected exercise dates of stock-based payment awards. Management bases its estimates on historic experience, future expectations and other assumptions that are believed to be reasonable at the date of the consolidated financial statements. Actual results may differ from these estimates due to uncertainty involved in measuring, at a specific point in time, events which are continuous in nature, and differences may be material. The Company’s significant accounting policies are discussed in note 2 to its audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of the Company’s 2012 Form 10-K.

The Company considers the following significant estimates, assumptions and judgments to have the most significant effect on its results:

Revenue Recognition

The Company generates revenue from various sources as follows:

 

   

design, manufacture, sale and lease of proprietary theater systems for IMAX theaters principally owned and operated by commercial and institutional customers located in 53 countries as at December 31, 2012;

 

   

production, digital re-mastering, post-production and/or distribution of certain films shown throughout the IMAX theater network;

 

   

operation of certain IMAX theaters primarily in the United States;

 

   

provision of other services to the IMAX theater network, including ongoing maintenance and extended warranty services for IMAX theater systems; and

 

   

other activities, which includes short-term rental of cameras and aftermarket sales of projector system components.

 

45


Table of Contents

Multiple Element Arrangements

The Company’s revenue arrangements with certain customers may involve multiple elements consisting of a theater system (projector, sound system, screen system and, if applicable, 3D glasses cleaning machine); services associated with the theater system including theater design support, supervision of installation, and projectionist training; a license to use of the IMAX brand; 3D glasses; maintenance and extended warranty services; and licensing of films. The Company evaluates all elements in an arrangement to determine what are considered typical deliverables for accounting purposes and which of the deliverables represent separate units of accounting based on the applicable accounting guidance in the Leases Topic of the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC” or “Codification”); the Guarantees Topic of the FASB ASC; the Entertainment – Films Topic of the FASB ASC; and the Revenue Recognition Topic of the FASB ASC. If separate units of accounting are either required under the relevant accounting standards or determined to be applicable under the Revenue Recognition Topic, the total consideration received or receivable in the arrangement is allocated based on the applicable guidance in the above noted standards.

Theater Systems

The Company has identified the projection system, sound system, screen system and, if applicable, 3D glasses cleaning machine, theater design support, supervision of installation, projectionist training and the use of the IMAX brand to be a single deliverable and a single unit of accounting (the “System Deliverable”). When an arrangement does not include all the elements of a System Deliverable, the elements of the System Deliverable included in the arrangement are considered by the Company to be a single deliverable and a single unit of accounting. The Company is not responsible for the physical installation of the equipment in the customer’s facility; however, the Company supervises the installation by the customer. The customer has the right to use the IMAX brand from the date the Company and the customer enter into an arrangement.

The Company’s System Deliverable arrangements involve either a lease or a sale of the theater system. Consideration in the Company’s arrangements that are not joint revenue sharing arrangements, consists of upfront or initial payments made before and after the final installation of the theater system equipment and ongoing payments throughout the term of the lease or over a period of time, as specified in the arrangement. The ongoing payments are the greater of an annual fixed minimum amount or a certain percentage of the theater box-office. Amounts received in excess of the annual fixed minimum amounts are considered contingent payments. The Company’s arrangements are non-cancellable, unless the Company fails to perform its obligations. In the absence of a material default by the Company, there is no right to any remedy for the customer under the Company’s arrangements. If a material default by the Company exists, the customer has the right to terminate the arrangement and seek a refund only if the customer provides notice to the Company of a material default and only if the Company does not cure the default within a specified period.

Sales Arrangements

For arrangements qualifying as sales, the revenue allocated to the System Deliverable is recognized in accordance with the Revenue Recognition Topic of the FASB ASC, when all of the following conditions have been met: (i) the projector, sound system and screen system have been installed and are in full working condition, (ii) the 3D glasses cleaning machine, if applicable, has been delivered, (iii) projectionist training has been completed, and (iv) the earlier of (a) receipt of written customer acceptance certifying the completion of installation and run-in testing of the equipment and the completion of projectionist training or (b) public opening of the theater, provided there is persuasive evidence of an arrangement, the price is fixed or determinable and collectibility is reasonably assured.

The initial revenue recognized consists of the initial payments received and the present value of any future initial payments and fixed minimum ongoing payments that have been attributed to this unit of accounting. Contingent payments in excess of the fixed minimum ongoing payments are recognized when reported by theater operators, provided collectibility is reasonably assured.

The Company has also agreed, on occasion, to sell equipment under lease or at the end of a lease term. Consideration agreed to for these lease buyouts is included in revenues from equipment and product sales, when persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, the fees are fixed or determinable, collectibility is reasonably assured and title to the theater system passes from the Company to the customer.

In a certain sales arrangement not subject to the provisions of the amended FASB ASC 605-25, “Revenue Recognition: Multiple-Element Arrangements” (“ASC 605-25”), the Company provided a customer with digital upgrades on several systems, including several specified upgrades to an as-of-yet undeveloped product. At the current period-end, the Company has not yet established the fair value of this product, and as a result, the Company cannot determine the arrangement’s consideration, nor its allocation of consideration between delivered and undelivered items. Consequently, revenue recognition has been deferred for all delivered items in

 

46


Table of Contents

the arrangement. Once the Company determines an objective and reliable fair value of the undeveloped specified upgrade, the Company will be able to calculate total arrangement consideration and consequently, the Company will be able to recognize revenue on the delivered elements of the arrangement. If the arrangement is materially modified in the future such that contract consideration becomes fixed, the arrangement in its entirety would be subject to the provisions of the amended FASB ASC 605-25 and the Company would be required to develop, absent an established selling price for the undeveloped specified upgrade, a best estimated selling price for the undeveloped specified upgrade, allocate the arrangement’s consideration on a relative selling price allocation basis, and recognize revenue on the delivered elements based on that allocation.

Lease Arrangements

The Company uses the Leases Topic of the FASB ASC to evaluate whether an arrangement is a lease and the classification of the lease. Arrangements not within the scope of the accounting standard are accounted for either as a sales or services arrangement, as applicable.

For lease arrangements, the Company determines the classification of the lease in accordance with the Leases Topic of the FASB ASC. A lease arrangement that transfers substantially all of the benefits and risks incident to ownership of the equipment is classified as a sales-type lease based on the criteria established in the accounting standard; otherwise the lease is classified as an operating lease. Prior to commencement of the lease term for the equipment, the Company may modify certain payment terms or make concessions. If these circumstances occur, the Company reassesses the classification of the lease based on the modified terms and conditions.

For sales-type leases, the revenue allocated to the System Deliverable is recognized when the lease term commences, which the Company deems to be when all of the following conditions have been met: (i) the projector, sound system and screen system have been installed and are in full working condition, (ii) the 3D glasses cleaning machine, if applicable, has been delivered, (iii) projectionist training has been completed, and (iv) the earlier of (a) receipt of the written customer acceptance certifying the completion of installation and run-in testing of the equipment and the completion of projectionist training or (b) public opening of the theater, provided collectibility is reasonably assured.

The initial revenue recognized for sales-type leases consists of the initial payments received and the present value of future initial payments and fixed minimum ongoing payments computed at the interest rate implicit in the lease. Contingent payments in excess of the fixed minimum payments are recognized when reported by theater operators, provided collectibility is reasonably assured.

For operating leases, initial payments and fixed minimum ongoing payments are recognized as revenue on a straight-line basis over the lease term. For operating leases, the lease term is considered to commence when all of the following conditions have been met: (i) the projector, sound system and screen system have been installed and are in full working condition, (ii) the 3D glasses cleaning machine, if applicable, has been delivered, (iii) projectionist training has been completed, and (iv) the earlier of (a) receipt of the written customer acceptance certifying the completion of installation and run-in testing of the equipment and the completion of projectionist training or (b) public opening of the theater. Contingent payments in excess of fixed minimum ongoing payments are recognized as revenue when reported by theater operators, provided collectibility is reasonably assured.

Revenue from joint revenue sharing arrangements with upfront payments that qualify for classification as sales-type leases is recognized in accordance with the sales-type lease criteria discussed above. Contingent revenues from joint revenue sharing arrangements is recognized as box office results and concessions revenues are reported by the theater operator, provided collectibility is reasonably assured.

Equipment and components allocated to be used in future joint revenue sharing arrangements, as well as direct labor costs and an allocation of direct production costs, are included in assets under construction until such equipment is installed and in working condition, at which time the equipment is depreciated on a straight-line basis over the lesser of the term of the joint revenue sharing arrangement and the equipment’s anticipated useful life.

Finance Income

Finance income is recognized over the term of the lease or over the period of time specified in the sales arrangement, provided collectibility is reasonably assured. Finance income recognition ceases when the Company determines that the associated receivable is not collectible.

Finance income is suspended when the Company identifies a theater that is delinquent, non-responsive or not negotiating in good faith with the Company. Once the collectibility issues are resolved the Company will resume recognition of finance income.

 

47


Table of Contents

Terminations, Consensual Buyouts and Concessions

The Company enters into theater system arrangements with customers that provide for customer payment obligations prior to the scheduled installation of the theater system. During the period of time between signing and the installation of the theater system, which may extend several years, certain customers may be unable to, or elect not to, proceed with the theater system installation for a number of reasons including business considerations, or the inability to obtain certain consents, approvals or financing. Once the determination is made that the customer will not proceed with installation, the arrangement may be terminated under the default provisions of the arrangement or by mutual agreement between the Company and the customer (a “consensual buyout”). Terminations by default are situations when a customer does not meet the payment obligations under an arrangement and the Company retains the amounts paid by the customer. Under a consensual buyout, the Company and the customer agree, in writing, to a settlement and to release each other of any further obligations under the arrangement or an arbitrated settlement is reached. Any initial payments retained or additional payments received by the Company are recognized as revenue when the settlement arrangements are executed and the cash is received, respectively. These termination and consensual buyout amounts are recognized in Other revenues.

In addition, the Company could agree with customers to convert their obligations for other theater system configurations that have not yet been installed to arrangements to acquire or lease the IMAX digital theater system. The Company considers these situations to be a termination of the previous arrangement and origination of a new arrangement for the IMAX digital theater system. For all arrangements entered into or modified prior to the date of adoption of the amended FASB ASC 605-25, the Company continues to defer an amount of any initial fees received from the customer such that the aggregate of the fees deferred and the net present value of the future fixed initial and ongoing payments to be received from the customer equals the selling price of the IMAX digital theater system to be leased or acquired by the customer. Any residual portion of the initial fees received from the customer for the terminated theater system is recorded in Other revenues at the time when the obligation for the original theater system is terminated and the new theater system arrangement is signed. Under the amended FASB ASC 605-25, as described in note 2(m) to the accompanying notes to the audited consolidated financial statements, for all arrangements entered into or materially modified after the date of adoption, the total arrangement consideration to be received is allocated on a relative selling price basis to the digital upgrade and the termination of the previous theater system. The arrangement consideration allocated to the termination of the existing arrangement is recorded in Other revenues at the time when the obligation for the original theater system is terminated and the new theater system arrangement is signed.

The Company may offer certain incentives to customers to complete theater system transactions including payment concessions or free services and products such as film licenses or 3D glasses. Reductions in, and deferral of, payments are taken into account in determining the sales price either by a direct reduction in the sales price or a reduction of payments to be discounted in accordance with the Leases or Interests Topic of the FASB ASC. Free products and services are accounted for as separate units of accounting. Other consideration given by the Company to customers are accounted for in accordance with the Revenue Recognition Topic of the FASB ASC.

Maintenance and Extended Warranty Services

Maintenance and extended warranty services may be provided under a multiple element arrangement or as a separately priced contract. Revenues related to these services are deferred and recognized on a straight-line basis over the contract period and are recognized in Services revenues. Maintenance and extended warranty services includes maintenance of the customer’s equipment and replacement parts. Under certain maintenance arrangements, maintenance services may include additional training services to the customer’s technicians. All costs associated with this maintenance and extended warranty program are expensed as incurred. A loss on maintenance and extended warranty services is recognized if the expected cost of providing the services under the contracts exceeds the related deferred revenue.

Film Production and IMAX DMR Services

In certain film arrangements, the Company produces a film financed by third parties, whereby the third party retains the copyright and the Company obtains exclusive distribution rights. Under these arrangements, the Company is entitled to receive a fixed fee or to retain as a fee the excess of funding over cost of production (the “production fee”). The third parties receive a portion of the revenues received by the Company from distributing the film, which is charged to costs and expenses applicable to revenues-services. The production fees are deferred, and recognized as a reduction in the cost of the film, based on the ratio of the Company’s distribution revenues recognized in the current period to the ultimate distribution revenues expected from the film.

 

48


Table of Contents

Revenue from film production services where the Company does not hold the associated distribution rights are recognized in Service revenues when performance of the contractual service is complete, provided there is persuasive evidence of an agreement, the fee is fixed or determinable and collectibility is reasonably assured.

Revenues from digitally re-mastering (IMAX DMR) films where third parties own or hold the copyrights and the rights to distribute the film are derived in the form of processing fees and recoupments calculated as a percentage of box-office receipts generated from the re-mastered films. Processing fees are recognized as Service revenues when the performance of the related re-mastering service is completed, provided there is persuasive evidence of an arrangement, the fee is fixed or determinable and collectibility is reasonably assured. Recoupments, calculated as a percentage of box-office receipts, are recognized as Services revenues when box-office receipts are reported by the third party that owns or holds the related film rights, provided collectibility is reasonably assured.

Losses on film production and IMAX DMR services are recognized as costs and expenses applicable to revenues-services in the period when it is determined that the Company’s estimate of total revenues to be realized by the Company will not exceed estimated total production costs to be expended on the film production and the cost of IMAX DMR services.

Film Distribution

Revenue from the licensing of films is recognized in Services revenues when persuasive evidence of a licensing arrangement exists, the film has been completed and delivered, the license period has begun, the fee is fixed or determinable and collectibility is reasonably assured. When license fees are based on a percentage of box-office receipts, revenue is recognized when box-office receipts are reported by exhibitors, provided collectibility is reasonably assured.

Film Post-Production Services

Revenues from post-production film services are recognized in Services revenue when performance of the contracted services is complete provided there is persuasive evidence of an arrangement, the fee is fixed or determinable and collectibility is reasonably assured.

Other

The Company recognizes revenue in Services revenue from its owned and operated theaters resulting from box-office ticket and concession sales as tickets are sold, films are shown and upon the sale of various concessions. The sales are cash or credit card transactions with theatergoers based on fixed prices per seat or per concession item.

In addition, the Company enters into commercial arrangements with third party theater owners resulting in the sharing of profits and losses which are recognized in Service revenues when reported by such theaters. The Company also provides management services to certain theaters and recognizes revenue over the term of such services.

Revenues on camera rentals are recognized in Rental revenue over the rental period.

Revenue from the sale of 3D glasses is recognized in Equipment and product sales revenue when the 3D glasses have been delivered to the customer.

Other service revenues are recognized in Service revenues when the performance of contracted services is complete.

Allowances for Accounts Receivable and Financing Receivables

Allowances for doubtful accounts receivable are based on the Company’s assessment of the collectibility of specific customer balances, which is based upon a review of the customer’s credit worthiness, past collection history and the underlying asset value of the equipment, where applicable. Interest on overdue accounts receivable is recognized as income as the amounts are collected.

The Company monitors the performance of the theaters to which it has leased or sold theater systems which are subject to ongoing payments. When facts and circumstances indicate that there is a potential impairment in the accounts receivable, net investment in lease or a financing receivable, the Company will evaluate the potential outcome of either renegotiations involving changes in the terms of the receivable or defaults on the existing lease or financed sale agreements. The Company will record a provision if it is

 

49


Table of Contents

considered probable that the Company will be unable to collect all amounts due under the contractual terms of the arrangement or a renegotiated lease amount will cause a reclassification of the sales-type lease to an operating lease.

When the net investment in lease or the financing receivable is impaired, the Company will recognize a provision for the difference between the carrying value in the investment and the present value of expected future cash flows discounted using the effective interest rate for the net investment in the lease or the financing receivable. If the Company expects to recover the theater system, the provision is equal to the excess of the carrying value of the investment over the fair value of the equipment.

When the minimum lease payments are renegotiated and the lease continues to be classified as a sales-type lease, the reduction in payments is applied to reduce unearned finance income.

These provisions are adjusted when there is a significant change in the amount or timing of the expected future cash flows or when actual cash flows differ from cash flow previously expected.

Once a net investment in lease or financing receivable is considered impaired, the Company does not recognize interest income until the collectibility issues are resolved. When finance income is not recognized, any payments received are applied against outstanding gross minimum lease amounts receivable or gross receivables from financed sales.

Inventories

Inventories are carried at the lower of cost, determined on an average cost basis, and net realizable value except for raw materials, which are carried out at the lower of cost and replacement cost. Finished goods and work-in-process include the cost of raw materials, direct labor, theater design costs, and an applicable share of manufacturing overhead costs.

The costs related to theater systems under sales and sales-type lease arrangements are relieved from inventory to costs and expenses applicable to revenues-equipment and product sales when revenue recognition criteria are met. The costs related to theater systems under operating lease arrangements and joint revenue sharing arrangements are transferred from inventory to assets under construction in property, plant and equipment when allocated to a signed joint revenue sharing arrangement or when the arrangement is first classified as an operating lease.

The Company records provisions for excess and obsolete inventory based upon current estimates of future events and conditions, including the anticipated installation dates for the current backlog of theater system contracts, technological developments, signings in negotiation, growth prospects within the customers’ ultimate marketplace and anticipated market acceptance of the Company’s current and pending theater systems.

Finished goods inventories can contain theater systems for which title has passed to the Company’s customer, under the contract, but the revenue recognition criteria as discussed above have not been met.

Asset Impairments

The Company performs a qualitative, and when necessary quantitative, impairment test on its goodwill on an annual basis, coincident with the year-end, as well as in quarters where events or changes in circumstances suggest that the carrying amount may not be recoverable.

Goodwill impairment is assessed at the reporting unit level by comparing the unit’s carrying value, including goodwill, to the fair value of the unit. Significant estimates and judgment are involved in the impairment test. The carrying values of each unit are subject to allocations of certain assets and liabilities that the Company has applied in a systematic and rational manner. The fair value of the Company’s units is assessed using a discounted cash flow model. The model is constructed using the Company’s budget and long-range plan as a base.

Long-lived asset impairment testing is performed at the lowest level of an asset group at which identifiable cash flows are largely independent. In performing its review for recoverability, the Company estimates the future cash flows expected to result from the use of the asset or asset group and its eventual disposition. If the sum of the expected future cash flows is less than the carrying amount of the asset or asset group, an impairment loss is recognized in the consolidated statement of operations. Measurement of the impairment loss is based on the excess of the carrying amount of the asset or asset group over the fair value calculated using discounted expected future cash flows.

 

50


Table of Contents

The Company’s estimates of future cash flows involve anticipating future revenue streams, which contain many assumptions that are subject to variability, as well as estimates for future cash outlays, the amounts of which, and the timing of which are both uncertain. Actual results that differ from the Company’s budget and long-range plan could result in a significantly different result to an impairment test, which could impact earnings.

Foreign Currency Translation

Monetary assets and liabilities of the Company’s operations which are denominated in currencies other than the functional currency are translated into the functional currency at the exchange rates prevailing at the end of the period. Non-monetary items are translated at historical exchange rates. Revenue and expense transactions are translated at exchange rates prevalent at the transaction date. Such exchange gains and losses are included in the determination of earnings in the period in which they arise. The Company has determined that the functional currency of all its wholly-owned subsidiaries is the United States dollar.

Foreign currency derivatives are recognized and measured in the balance sheet at fair value. Changes in the fair value (gains or losses) are recognized in the consolidated statement of operations except for derivatives designated and qualifying as foreign currency hedging instruments. For foreign currency hedging instruments, the effective portion of the gain or loss in a hedge of a forecasted transaction is reported in other comprehensive income (“OCI”) and reclassified to the consolidated statement of operations when the forecasted transaction occurs. Any ineffective portion is recognized immediately in the consolidated statement of operations.

Pension Plan and Postretirement Benefit Obligations Assumptions

The Company’s pension plan and postretirement benefit obligations and related costs are calculated using actuarial concepts, within the framework of the Compensation – Retirement Benefits Topic of the FASB ASC. A critical assumption to this accounting is the discount rate. The Company evaluates this critical assumption annually or when otherwise required to by accounting standards. Other assumptions include factors such as expected retirement date, mortality rate, rate of compensation increase, and estimates of inflation.

The discount rate enables the Company to state expected future cash payments for benefits as a present value on the measurement date. The guideline for setting this rate is a high-quality long-term corporate bond rate. A lower discount rate increases the present value of benefit obligations and increases pension expense. The Company’s discount rate was determined by considering the average of pension yield curves constructed from a large population of high-quality corporate bonds. The resulting discount rate reflects the matching of plan liability cash flows to the yield curves.

The discount rate used is a key assumption in the determination of the pension benefit obligation and expense. At December 31, 2012, a 1.0% change in the discount rate used could result in a $2.3 million — $2.7 million increase or decrease in the pension benefit obligation with a corresponding benefit or charge recognized in other comprehensive income in the year. A one year delay in Mr. Gelfond’s retirement date would increase the discount rate by 0.3% and would result in a $0.4 million reduction in the pension benefit obligation as at December 31, 2012.

Deferred Tax Asset Valuation

As at December 31, 2012, the Company had net deferred income tax assets of $36.5 million. The Company’s management assesses realization of its deferred tax assets based on all available evidence in order to conclude whether it is more likely than not that the deferred tax assets will be realized. Available evidence considered by the Company includes, but is not limited to, the Company’s historic operating results, projected future operating results, reversing temporary differences, contracted sales backlog at December 31, 2012, changing business circumstances, and the ability to realize certain deferred tax assets through loss and tax credit carry-back and carry-forward strategies.

When there is a change in circumstances that causes a change in judgment about the realizability of the deferred tax assets, the Company would adjust the applicable valuation allowance in the period when such change occurs.

Tax Exposures

The Company is subject to ongoing tax exposures, examinations and assessments in various jurisdictions. Accordingly, the Company may incur additional tax expense based upon the outcomes of such matters. In addition, when applicable, the Company adjusts tax expense to reflect the Company’s ongoing assessments of such matters which require judgment and can materially increase or decrease its effective rate as well as impact operating results. The Company provides for such exposures in accordance with Income Taxes Topic of the FASB ASC.

 

51


Table of Contents

Stock-Based Compensation

The Company utilizes a lattice-binomial option-pricing model (the “Binomial Model”) to determine the fair value of stock-based payment awards. The fair value determined by the Binomial Model is affected by the Company’s stock price as well as assumptions regarding a number of highly complex and subjective variables. These variables include, but are not limited to, the Company’s expected stock price volatility over the term of the awards, and actual and projected employee stock option exercise behaviors. The Binomial Model also considers the expected exercise multiple which is the multiple of exercise price to grant price at which exercises are expected to occur on average. Option-pricing models were developed for use in estimating the value of traded options that have no vesting or hedging restrictions and are fully transferable. Because the Company’s employee stock options and stock appreciation rights (“SARs”) have certain characteristics that are significantly different from traded options, and because changes in the subjective assumptions can materially affect the estimated value, in management’s opinion, the Binomial Model best provides an accurate measure of the fair value of the Company’s employee stock options and SARs. Although the fair value of employee stock options and SARs are determined in accordance with the Equity topic of the FASB ASC using an option-pricing model, that value may not be indicative of the fair value observed in a willing buyer/willing seller market transaction.

Impact of Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements

See note 3 to the audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of the Company’s 2012 Form 10-K for information regarding the Company’s recent changes in accounting policies and the impact of recently issued accounting pronouncements impacting the Company.

ASSET IMPAIRMENTS AND OTHER CHARGES (RECOVERIES)

The following table identifies the Company’s charges (recoveries) relating to the impairment of assets:

 

      Years Ended December 31,  
(in thousands of U.S. dollars)    2012     2011      2010  

Asset impairments

       

Property, plant and equipment

   $ —       $ 28      $ 45  

Other charges (recoveries):

       

Inventories

     898       —          999  

Accounts receivable

     606       333        499  

Financing receivables

     (82     1,237        944  

Impairment of available-for-sale investment

     150       —          —    

Property, plant and equipment

     18       356        —    

Other intangible assets

     11       —          64  

Other assets

     6       —          —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total asset impairments and other charges

   $ 1,607     $ 1,954      $ 2,551  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Asset Impairments

The Company records asset impairment charges for property, plant and equipment after an assessment of the carrying value of certain asset groups in light of their future expected cash flows. No such charges were recognized in 2012. During 2011 and 2010, the Company recorded total asset impairment charges of less than $0.1 million and less than $0.1 million, respectively, as the Company recognized that the carrying values for the assets exceeded the expected undiscounted future cash flows.

Other Charges (Recoveries)

The Company recorded a $0.9 million provision (2011 — $nil; 2010 — $1.0 million) in costs and expenses applicable to revenues due to a reduction in the net realizable value of its inventories. These charges primarily resulted from a reduction in the net realizable value of its film-based projector inventories and certain service part inventories due to a further market shift away from film-based projector systems.

The Company recorded a net provision of $0.6 million in 2012 (2011 — $0.3 million; 2010 — $0.5 million) in accounts receivable based on the Company’s assessment of the collectability of specific customer balances.

 

52


Table of Contents

In 2012, the Company also recorded a net recovery of $0.1 million in financing receivables (2011 — $1.2 million provision; 2010 — $0.9 million provision). Provisions of the Company’s financing receivables is recorded when the collectibility associated with certain financing receivables is uncertain. These provisions are adjusted when there is a significant change in the amount or timing of the expected future cash flows or when actual cash flows differ from cash flows previously expected.

In 2012, the Company recognized a $0.2 million other-than-temporary impairment of its available-for-sale investment as the value is not expected to recover based on the length of time and extent to which the market value has been less than cost.

In 2012, the Company recorded a less than $0.1 million charge (2011 — $0.4 million) reflecting assets that no longer meet capitalization requirements as the assets were no longer in use. No such charges were recorded in 2010.

Non-GAAP Financial Measures

In this report, the Company presents adjusted net income and adjusted net income per diluted share as supplemental measures of performance of the Company, which are not recognized under U.S. GAAP. The Company presents adjusted net income and adjusted net income per diluted share because it believes that they are important supplemental measures of its comparable controllable operating performance and it wants to ensure that its investors fully understand the impact of its stock-based compensation, provision for arbitration award and deferred income tax valuation allowance (net of any related tax impact) on its net income. Effective the third quarter of 2012, the Company revised its definition of adjusted net income and adjusted earnings per diluted share. Comparative numbers have been adjusted to conform to the current year presentation. The Company presents gross margin from its joint revenue sharing arrangements segment excluding initial launch costs because it believes that it is an important supplemental measure used by management to evaluate ongoing joint revenue sharing arrangement theater performance. Management uses these measures to review operating performance on a comparable basis from period to period. However, these non-GAAP measures may not be comparable to similarly titled amounts reported by other companies. Adjusted net income and adjusted net income per diluted share should be considered in addition to, and not as a substitute for, net income and other measures of financial performance reported in accordance with U.S. GAAP.

 

53


Table of Contents

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

As identified in note 20 to the audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of the Company’s 2012 Form 10-K, the Company has seven reportable segments identified by category of product sold or service provided: IMAX systems; theater system maintenance; joint revenue sharing arrangements; film production and IMAX DMR; film distribution; film post-production; and other.

 

   

The IMAX systems segment, which is comprised of the design, manufacture, sale or lease of IMAX theater projection system equipment.

 

   

The theater system maintenance segment, which consists of the maintenance of IMAX theater projection system equipment in the IMAX theater network.

 

   

The joint revenue sharing arrangements segment, which is comprised of the provision of IMAX theater projection system equipment to an exhibitor in exchange for a certain percentage of box-office receipts, and in some cases, concession revenue and a small upfront or initial payment.

 

   

The film production and IMAX DMR segment, which is comprised of the production of films and performance of film re-mastering services.

 

   

The film distribution segment, which includes the distribution of films for which the Company has distribution rights.

 

   

The film post-production segment, which includes the provision of film post-production and film print services.

 

   

The other segment, which includes certain IMAX theaters that the Company owns and operates, camera rentals and other miscellaneous items.

The accounting policies of the segments are the same as those described in note 2 to the audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of the Company’s 2012 Form 10-K.

The Company’s Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations have been discussed with respect to the above stated segments. Management feels that a discussion and analysis based on its segments is significantly more relevant as the Company’s consolidated statements of operations captions combine results from several segments.

The following table sets forth the breakdown of revenue and gross margin by segment:

 

     Revenue      Gross Margin  
(In thousands of U.S. dollars)    Years Ended December 31,      Years Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011      2010      2012      2011     2010  

Theater Systems

                

IMAX Systems

                

Sales and sales-type leases(1)

   $ 69,988      $ 81,310      $ 63,023      $ 36,974      $ 45,251     $ 31,452  

Ongoing rent, fees, and finance income(2)

     13,417        11,890        12,981        13,271        11,678       12,531  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     83,405        93,200        76,004        50,245        56,929       43,983  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Theater System Maintenance

     28,629        24,840        21,444        10,970        9,437       10,084  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Joint Revenue Sharing Arrangements

     57,526        30,764        41,757        37,308        17,605       31,703  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Film

                

Production and IMAX DMR

     78,050        50,592        63,462        49,355        23,574       41,159  

Distribution

     14,222        16,074        17,937        2,356        3,025       5,205  

Post-production

     7,904        8,235        7,702        1,954        2,985       2,891  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     100,176        74,901        89,101        53,665        29,584       49,255  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other

     14,554        12,851        20,308        545        (337     2,627  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 284,290      $ 236,556      $ 248,614      $ 152,733      $ 113,218     $ 137,652  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Includes initial payments and the present value of fixed minimum payments from equipment, sales and sales-type lease transactions.

 

(2) Includes rental income from operating leases, contingent rents from operating and sales-type leases, contingent fees from sales arrangements and finance income.

 

54


Table of Contents

Year Ended December 31, 2012 versus Year Ended December 31, 2011

The Company reported net income of $41.3 million or $0.63 per basic share and $0.61 per diluted share for the year ended December 31, 2012 as compared to net income of $15.3 million or $0.24 per basic share and $0.22 per diluted share for the year ended December 31, 2011. Net income for the year ended December 31, 2012 includes a $13.1 million charge or $0.19 per diluted share (2011 — $11.7 million or $0.17 per diluted share) for stock-based compensation. Net income for December 31, 2011 also includes a one-time $2.1 million pre-tax charge ($0.03 per diluted share) due to an arbitration award arising from an arbitration proceeding brought against the Company in connection with a discontinued subsidiary. Adjusted net income, which consists of net income excluding the impact of stock-based compensation, the charge for arbitration award and the related tax impact, was $54.3 million or $0.80 per diluted share for the year ended December 31, 2012 as compared to adjusted net income of $28.0 million or $0.41 per diluted share for the year ended December 31, 2011. A reconciliation of net income, the most directly comparable U.S. GAAP measure, to adjusted net income and adjusted net income per diluted share is presented in the table below:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011 As Revised  
     Net Income     Diluted EPS      Net Income     Diluted EPS  

Reported net income

   $ 41,337     $ 0.61      $ 15,260     $ 0.22  

Adjustments:

         

Stock-based compensation

     13,113       0.19        11,681       0.17  

Provision for arbitration award

     —         —          2,055       0.03  

Tax impact on items listed above

     (160     —          (973     (0.01
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted net income

   $ 54,290     $ 0.80      $ 28,023     $ 0.41  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average diluted shares outstanding

       67,933          67,859  
    

 

 

      

 

 

 

Revenues and Gross Margin

The Company’s revenues for the year ended December 31, 2012 increased 20.2% to $284.3 million from $236.6 million in 2011 due in large part to increases in revenue from the Company’s film and joint revenue sharing arrangement segments, partially offset by lower revenue from the IMAX systems segment. The gross margin across all segments in 2012 was $152.7 million, or 53.7% of total revenue, compared to $113.2 million, or 47.9% of total revenue in 2011. The increase in gross margin is attributable to improved operating leverage and continued theater network growth.

IMAX Systems

IMAX systems revenue decreased 10.5% to $83.4 million in 2012 as compared to $93.2 million in 2011.

Revenue from sales and sales-type leases decreased 13.9% to $70.0 million in 2012 from $81.3 million in 2011, resulting primarily from the installation of fewer digital upgrades and slightly fewer systems under sales and sales-type leases as compared to the prior year. The Company recognized revenue on 12 digital upgrades and one 3D GT upgrade (from a 2D GT system) in 2012, with a total value of $5.4 million, as compared to 25 digital upgrades in 2011 with a total value of $11.6 million. Digital upgrades have lower sales prices and gross margin than a full theater installation. The Company has decided to offer digital upgrades at lower selling prices for strategic reasons since the Company believes that digital systems increase flexibility and profitability for the Company’s existing exhibition customers. The Company recognized revenue on 47 full, new theater systems which qualified as either sales or sales-type leases in 2012, with a total value of $60.7 million, as compared to 50 in 2011 with a total value of $63.4 million. There were no used systems installed in 2012, as compared to one used system with a total value of $1.2 million in 2011.

Average revenue per full, new sales and sales-type lease system was $1.3 million in 2012, which is consistent with the $1.3 million experienced in 2011. Average revenue per digital upgrade was $0.4 million in 2012, as compared to $0.5 million in 2011.

The breakdown in mix of sales and sales-type lease and joint revenue sharing arrangement installations by theater system configuration for 2012 and 2011 is outlined in the table below:

 

55


Table of Contents
     2012      2011  

Sales and Sales-type lease systems—installed and recognized

     

IMAX 3D GT

     1        1 (1) 

IMAX 3D SR

     1        —    

IMAX digital

     45        50  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total new theater systems

     47        51  

Upgrades of IMAX theater systems

     13        25  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     60        76  

IMAX digital upgrades—installed and deferred

     3        8  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total sales and sales-type leases—installed

     63        84  

Joint revenue sharing arrangements—installed and operating

     

New IMAX digital theater systems

     60        86  

Upgrades of IMAX theater systems

     2        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     125        170  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) Includes one used IMAX 3D GT system

As noted in the table above, 3 and 8 theater systems under a digital upgrade sales arrangement were installed in 2012 and 2011, respectively, but revenue recognition was deferred. The arrangement contained provisions providing the customer with standard digital upgrades, which were installed, and a number of as-of-yet undeveloped upgrades. The Company’s policy is such that once the fair value for the undeveloped upgrade is established, the Company allocates total contract consideration, including any upgrade revenues, between the delivered and undelivered elements on a relative fair value basis and recognizes the revenue allocated to the delivered elements with their associated costs. If the arrangement is materially modified in the future such that contract consideration becomes fixed, the arrangement in its entirety would be subject to the provisions of the amended ASC 605-25 and the Company would be required to develop, absent an established selling price or third party evidence of the selling price for the undeveloped specified upgrade, a best estimated selling price for the undeveloped specified upgrade, allocate the arrangement’s consideration on a relative selling price allocation basis, and recognize revenue on the delivered elements based on that allocation.

Revenues from sales and sales-type leases include settlement revenue of $0.7 million in 2012 as compared to $3.8 million in 2011. The amount recognized in 2012 is a result of agreements entered into with customers to terminate their existing obligations pertaining to a theater in the IMAX network, whereas settlement revenue recognized in 2011 primarily relates to a consensual buyout for one uninstalled theater system.

In 2012, one of the Company’s customers acquired 3 IMAX theaters from another existing customer that had been operating under a joint revenue sharing arrangement. These theaters were purchased from IMAX under a sales arrangement. As a result of this sale transaction, the Company recorded revenue and margin of $3.0 million and $2.1 million, respectively. These above-referenced theaters were included in the Company’s 2012 signings total. In addition, during the period the Company recognized the digital upgrade of two theaters under a joint revenue sharing arrangement, which theaters were previously operated under sales/sales-type lease arrangements.

Gross margin from IMAX sales and sales-type lease systems (including new, upgrades and settlements) was $37.0 million, or 52.8% in 2012 compared to $45.3 million, or 55.7% in 2011. Gross margin from full, new sales and sales-type leases, excluding the impact of settlements and upgrades decreased to 62.4% in 2012 from 66.0% in 2011. The gross margin on digital upgrades was $1.4 million in 2012 in comparison with $2.6 million in 2011, which is a reflection of the number of systems upgraded, the particular systems upgraded and the costs associated with such upgrades in their respective periods. There were no used systems installed during 2012, compared to one used system with a gross margin of $0.1 million installed and recognized in 2011. In addition, in 2012, the Company incurred a charge of $1.7 million for equipment to enable certain theaters to elect to exhibit films such as The Dark Knight Rises in either digital or analog format. Furthermore, in 2012, the Company recorded a write-down of certain film-based projector inventories of $0.8 million. No such costs were experienced in 2011.

Ongoing rent revenue and finance income increased to $13.4 million in 2012 from $11.9 million in 2011. Gross margin for ongoing rent and finance income increased to $13.3 million in 2012 from $11.7 million in 2011. Contingent fees included in this caption amounted to $3.0 million and $2.7 million in 2012 and 2011, respectively.

 

56


Table of Contents

Theater System Maintenance

Theater system maintenance revenue increased 15.3% to $28.6 million in 2012 as compared to $24.8 million in 2011. Theater system maintenance gross margin increased to $11.0 million in 2012 from $9.4 million in 2011. The increase in revenue and gross margin, respectively, was primarily due to the larger theater network. Maintenance revenue continues to grow as the number of theaters in the IMAX network expands. Maintenance margins vary depending on the mix of theater system configurations in the theater network and the timing and the date(s) of installation and/or service. In 2012, the Company recorded a write-down of $0.1 million for certain service parts inventories as compared to $nil in 2011.

Joint Revenue Sharing Arrangements

Revenue from joint revenue sharing arrangements increased 87.0% to $57.5 million in 2012 compared to $30.8 million in 2011. The Company ended the year with 316 theaters operating under joint revenue sharing arrangements as compared to 257 theaters at the end of 2011, an increase of 23.0%. The increase in revenues from joint revenue sharing arrangements was primarily due to the higher per-screen gross box office realized from the films released to joint revenue sharing theaters and the increase in the number of theaters in the IMAX theater network from the prior year. During 2012, the Company installed 60 full, new theaters under joint revenue sharing arrangements, as compared to 86 full new theaters during 2011.

The gross margin from joint revenue sharing arrangements in 2012 increased 111.9% to $37.3 million compared to $17.6 million in 2011. The increase was primarily due to higher revenues experienced in 2012 compared to 2011, as well as lower advertising, marketing and selling expenses. Included in the calculation of the 2012 gross margin were certain advertising, marketing, and selling expenses primarily associated with new theater launches of $3.4 million, as compared to $5.4 million for such expenses in 2011. Adjusted gross margin from joint revenue sharing arrangements, which excludes these expenses from both periods, was $40.7 million in 2012, compared to $23.0 million in 2011. A reconciliation of gross margin from the joint revenue sharing arrangement segment, the most directly comparable U.S. GAAP measure, to adjusted gross margin is presented in the table below:

 

(In thousands of U.S. Dollars)    2012      2011  

Gross margin from joint revenue sharing arrangements

   $ 37,308      $ 17,605  

Add:

     

Advertising, marketing and selling expenses

     3,382        5,432  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Adjusted gross margin from joint revenue sharing arrangements

   $ 40,690      $ 23,037  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Film

The Company’s total revenues from its three film segments increased 33.7% to $100.2 million in 2012 from $74.9 million in 2011 and the related gross margin increased 81.4% in 2012 to $53.7 million from $29.6 million in 2011.

Film production and IMAX DMR revenues increased 54.3% to $78.1 million in 2012 from $50.6 million in 2011. The increase in film production and IMAX DMR revenues was primarily due to an increase in the number of theaters in the IMAX theater network as well as higher gross box office from the films released during the period. Global gross box office generated by IMAX DMR films increased 48.8% to $620.6 million in 2012 versus $417.2 million in 2011. IMAX DMR gross box office per screen for 2012 averaged $1,153,200 globally, in comparison to $1,069,300 in 2011.

Film production and IMAX DMR gross margins more than doubled to $49.4 million, or 63.2% of revenues, from $23.6 million, or 46.6% of revenues in 2011 largely due to an increase in IMAX DMR revenue coupled with a relatively consistent level of DMR costs as compared to the prior year.

In 2012, gross-box office was generated primarily from the exhibition of 39 films listed below (35 new and 4 carryovers), as compared to 26 (25 new and 1 carryover) films exhibited in 2011:

 

2012 Films Exhibited

  

2011 Films Exhibited

Happy Feet Two: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

TRON: Legacy: An IMAX 3D Experience

Mission: Impossible – Ghost Protocol: The IMAX Experience

  

The Green Hornet: An IMAX 3D Experience

The Adventures of Tintin: The Secret of the Unicorn: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

Tangled: An IMAX 3D Experience

Sanctum: An IMAX 3D Experience

 

57


Table of Contents

Flying Swords of Dragon Gate: An IMAX 3D Experience

   I Am Number Four: The IMAX Experience

Underworld: Awakening: An IMAX 3D Experience

   Mars Needs Moms: An IMAX 3D Experience

Journey 2: The Mysterious Island: An IMAX 3D Experience

   Sucker Punch: The IMAX Experience

The Lorax: An IMAX 3D Experience

   Fast Five: The IMAX Experience

John Carter: An IMAX 3D Experience

   Thor: An IMAX 3D Experience

The Hunger Games: An IMAX 3D Experience

Wrath of the Titans: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

Pirates of the Caribbean: On Stranger Tides: An IMAX 3D Experience

Titanic: An IMAX 3D Experience

   The Founding of a Party: The IMAX Experience

Houba! On the Trail of the Marsupilami: The IMAX Experience

  

Kung Fu Panda 2: An IMAX 3D Experience

Battleship: The IMAX Experience

  

Super 8: The IMAX Experience

The Avengers: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

Cars 2: An IMAX 3D Experience

Dark Shadows: The IMAX Experience

  

Transformers: Dark of the Moon: An IMAX 3D Experience

Men In Black III: An IMAX 3D Experience

Prometheus: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

Harry Potter and the Deathly Hallows Part II: An IMAX 3D Experience

Madagascar 3: Europe’s Most Wanted: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

Final Destination 5: An IMAX 3D Experience

Rock of Ages: The IMAX Experience

   Cowboys & Aliens : The IMAX Experience

The Amazing Spiderman: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

Sector 7: An IMAX 3D Experience

The Dark Knight Rises: The IMAX Experience

  

Contagion: The IMAX Experience

Total Recall: The IMAX Experience

  

Real Steel: The IMAX Experience

The Bourne Legacy: The IMAX Experience

  

Puss in Boots: An IMAX 3D Experience

Indiana Jones and the Raiders of the Lost Ark: The IMAX Experience

  

Happy Feet Two: An IMAX 3D Experience

Flying Swords of Dragon Gate: An IMAX 3D Experience

Resident Evil: Retribution: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

Mission: Impossible – Ghost Protocol: The IMAX Experience

Tai Chi 0: An IMAX 3D Experience

Frankenweenie: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

The Adventures of Tintin: The Secret of the Unicorn: An IMAX 3D Experience

Paranormal Activity 4:The IMAX Experience

  

Tai Chi Hero: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

Cloud Atlas: The IMAX Experience

  

Skyfall: The IMAX Experience

  

Cirque du Soleil: Worlds Away: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

The Twilight Saga: Breaking Dawn – Part 2: The IMAX Experience

  

Back to 1942: The IMAX Experience

  

Rise of the Guardians: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

Life of Pi: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

CZ12: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

The Hobbit: An Unexpected Journey: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

Les Misérables: The IMAX Experience

  
  
  
  

Film distribution revenues decreased 11.5% to $14.2 million in 2012 from $16.1 million in 2011, primarily due to lower box-office performance. In 2012, the Company released an original title, To the Arctic 3D; during 2011, the Company released the original film Born To Be Wild 3D. Film post-production revenues decreased 4.0% to $7.9 million in 2012 from $8.2 million in 2011 primarily due to a decrease in third party business.

 

58


Table of Contents

The film distribution margin of $2.4 million in 2012 was lower than the $3.0 million experienced in 2011, primarily due to the decrease in film distribution revenues. Film post-production gross margin decreased by $1.0 million due to a decrease in third party business as compared to the prior year.

Other

Other revenue increased to $14.6 million in 2012 compared to $12.9 million in 2011. Other revenue primarily includes revenue generated from the Company’s owned and operated theaters, camera rentals and after – market sales of projection system parts and 3D glasses.

The gross margin on other revenue was $0.9 million higher in 2012 as compared to 2011.

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses

Selling, general and administrative expenses increased to $81.6 million in 2012, as compared to $73.2 million in 2011. The $8.4 million increase experienced from the prior year comparative period was largely the result of the following:

 

   

a $8.6 million increase in staff-related costs and compensation costs, including increased staffing (resulting in part from increased staffing costs of $3.5 million from the Company’s wholly-owned subsidiary in China) and normal merit increases;

 

   

a $3.8 million increase from brand-related advertising and promotion in 2012 as compared to the prior year; and

 

   

a $1.4 million increase in the Company’s stock-based compensation.

These increases were offset by:

 

   

a $2.5 million decrease due to a change in foreign exchange rates. During the year ended December 31, 2012, the Company recorded a foreign exchange gain of $1.2 million for net foreign exchange gains/losses related to the translation of foreign currency denominated monetary assets and liabilities and unhedged foreign currency forward contracts as compared to a loss of $1.3 million recorded in 2011. See note 16(b) of the audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of the Company’s 2012 Form 10-K for more information; and

 

   

a $2.9 million decrease in legal, professional and other general corporate expenditures.

Provision for Arbitration Award

During 2011, the Company recorded a provision of $2.1 million regarding an award issued in connection with an arbitration proceeding brought against the Company. The arbitration related to agreements entered into in 1994 and 1995 by the Company’s former Ridefilm subsidiary, whose business the Company discontinued through a sale to a third party in March 2001. The award was vacated as the parties entered into a confidential settlement agreement in which the parties agreed to dismiss any outstanding disputes among them. See note 14(c) of the audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of the Company’s 2012 Form-10K for more information.

Research and Development

Research and development expenses increased to $11.4 million in 2012 compared to $7.8 million in 2011 and are primarily attributable to the development of the Company’s new laser-based digital projection system. The Company is developing its next-generation laser projectors, which is expected to provide greater brightness and clarity, a wider colour gamut and deeper blacks, while consuming less power and lasting longer than existing digital technology, to ensure that the Company continues to provide the highest quality, premier movie-going experience available to consumers. In 2011, the Company announced the completion of a deal in which it secured certain exclusive license rights to a portfolio of intellectual property in the digital cinema field owned by Kodak, which supports the Company’s efforts to develop a next-generation laser digital projection system.

A high level of research and development is expected to continue in 2013 as the Company continues its efforts to develop its next-generation laser-based projection system. In addition, the Company plans to continue to fund research and development activity in other areas considered important to the Company’s continued commercial success, including further improving the reliability of its projectors, developing and manufacturing more IMAX cameras, enhancing the Company’s 2D and 3D image quality, expanding the

 

59


Table of Contents

applicability of the Company’s digital technology, developing IMAX theater systems’ capabilities in both home and live entertainment and further enhancing the IMAX theater and sound system design through the addition of more channels, improvements to the Company’s proprietary tuning system and mastering processes.

Receivable Provisions, Net of Recoveries

Receivable provisions, net of recoveries for accounts receivable and financing receivables, amounted to a net provision of $0.5 million in 2012, as compared to $1.6 million in 2011.

The Company’s accounts receivables and financing receivables are subject to credit risk. These receivables are concentrated with the leading theater exhibitors and studios in the film entertainment industry. To minimize the Company’s credit risk, the Company retains title to underlying theater systems leased, performs initial and ongoing credit evaluations of its customers and makes ongoing provisions for its estimate of potentially uncollectible amounts. Accordingly, the Company believes it has adequately protected itself against exposures relating to receivables and contractual commitments.

Asset Impairments and Other Charges

The Company recorded an asset impairment charge of $nil, compared to less than $0.1 million in the prior year, against property, plant and equipment after the Company assessed the carrying value of certain assets in its theater operations segment in light of their future expected cash flows. The Company recognized that the carrying values for the assets exceeded the expected undiscounted future cash flows.

In 2012, the Company recognized a $0.2 million other-than-temporary impairment of its available-for-sale investment as the value is not expected to recover based on the length of time and extent to which the market value has been less than cost.

In 2012, the Company recorded a less than $0.1 million charge as compared to a $0.4 million charge in the prior year comparative period reflecting assets that no longer meet capitalization requirements as the assets were no longer in use.

Interest Income and Expense

Interest income was $0.1 million in 2012, as compared to less than $0.1 million in 2011.

Interest expense decreased to $0.7 million in 2012, as compared to $1.8 million in 2011. Consistent with its historical financial reporting, the Company has elected to classify interest and penalties related to income tax liabilities, when applicable, as part of the interest expense in its consolidated statements of operations rather than income tax expense. The Company recovered approximately $0.8 million and expensed $0.1 million in potential interest and penalties associated with unrecognized tax benefits for the years ended December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011, respectively. Also included in interest expense is the amortization of deferred finance costs in the amount of $0.2 million and $0.4 million in 2012 and 2011, respectively. The Company’s policy is to defer and amortize all the costs relating to debt financing which are paid directly to the debt provider, over the life of the debt instrument.

Income Taxes

The Company’s effective tax rate differs from the statutory tax rate and varies from year to year primarily as a result of numerous permanent differences, investment and other tax credits, the provision for income taxes at different rates in foreign and other provincial jurisdictions, enacted statutory tax rate increases or reductions in the year, changes due to foreign exchange, changes in the Company’s valuation allowance based on the Company’s recoverability assessments of deferred tax assets, and favorable or unfavorable resolution of various tax examinations.

Due to a change in enacted tax rates, the Company recorded an increase to deferred tax assets and a decrease to the deferred tax provision of $0.5 million in the year ended December 31, 2012. In 2012, there was a $0.1 million decrease in the Company’s estimates of the recoverability of its deferred tax assets based on an analysis of both positive and negative evidence including projected future earnings, as compared to a $1.9 million decrease in the valuation allowance resulting from the utilization of loss carryforwards and deductible temporary differences against income in the prior year comparative period. The Company recorded an income tax provision of $15.1 million for 2012, of which $0.8 million is related to a decrease in unrecognized tax benefits. For 2011, the Company recorded an income tax provision of $9.3 million, of which $0.1 million was related to a decrease in unrecognized tax benefits.

 

60


Table of Contents

During the year ended December 31, 2012, after considering all available evidence, both positive (including recent profits, projected future profitability, backlog, carryforward periods for utilization of net operating loss carryovers and tax credits, discretionary deductions and other factors) and negative (including cumulative losses in past years and other factors), it was concluded that the valuation allowance against the Company’s deferred tax assets should be increased by approximately $0.1 million. The remaining $6.1 million balance in the valuation allowance as at December 31, 2012 is primarily attributable to certain U.S. federal and state net operating loss carryovers and federal tax credits that likely will expire without being utilized.

The Company anticipates utilizing the majority of its currently-available tax attributes over the next two years.

Equity-Accounted Investments

The Company accounts for investments in new business ventures using the guidance of the FASB ASC 323. December 31, 2012, the equity method of accounting is being utilized for an investment with a carrying value of $3.1 million (December 31, 2011—$4.1 million). For the year ended December 31, 2012, gross revenues, cost of revenue and net loss for the investment were $9.0 million, $12.7 million and $13.4 million, respectively (2011—$2.3 million, $9.8 million and $17.7 million, respectively). The Company recorded its proportionate share of the net loss which amounted to $1.4 million for 2012 compared to $1.8 million in 2011.

Pension Plan

The Company has an unfunded defined benefit pension plan, the Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (the “SERP”), covering Messrs. Gelfond and Bradley J. Wechsler, the Company’s former Co-CEO and current Chairman of its Board of Directors. As at December 31, 2012, the Company had an unfunded and accrued projected benefit obligation of approximately $20.4 million (December 31, 2011 — $19.0 million) in respect of the SERP.

The net periodic benefit cost was $0.6 million and $0.5 million in 2012 and 2011, respectively. The components of net periodic benefit cost were as follows:

 

     Years ended December 31  
     2012      2011  

Interest cost

   $ 272      $ 279  

Amortization of actuarial loss

     365        214  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Pension expense

   $ 637      $ 493  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The plan experienced an actuarial loss of $1.1 million and $0.6 million during 2012 and 2011, respectively, resulting primarily from the continuing decrease in the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation (“PBGC”) published annuity interest rates year-over-year used to determine the lump sum payment under the plan.

Under the terms of the SERP, if Mr. Gelfond’s employment is terminated other than for cause, he is entitled to receive SERP benefits in the form of a lump sum payment. SERP benefit payments to Mr. Gelfond are subject to a deferral for six months after the termination of his employment, at which time Mr. Gelfond will be entitled to receive interest on the deferred amount credited at the applicable federal rate for short-term obligations. The term of Mr. Gelfond’s current employment agreement has been extended through December 31, 2013, although Mr. Gelfond has not informed the Company that he intends to retire at that time. Under the terms of the extension, Mr. Gelfond also agreed that any compensation earned during 2011, 2012 and 2013 would not be included in calculating this entitlement under the SERP.

The Company has a postretirement plan to provide health and welfare benefits to Canadian employees meeting certain eligibility requirements. As at December 31, 2012, the Company had an unfunded benefit obligation of $4.6 million (December 31, 2011 — $4.1 million). See note 4 to the audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of the Company’s 2012 Form 10-K for additional details. In February 2013, the Company amended the Canadian postretirement plan to reduce future benefits provided under the plan. As a result of this change, the Company anticipates the postretirement liability to be reduced by $2.7 million, resulting in a pre-tax curtailment gain in the first quarter of 2013 of approximately $2.4 million.

In July 2000, the Company agreed to maintain health benefits for Messrs. Gelfond and Wechsler upon retirement. As at December 31, 2012, the Company had an unfunded benefit obligation recorded of $0.5 million (December 31, 2011 — $0.5 million).

 

61


Table of Contents

Stock-Based Compensation

The Company utilizes the Binomial Model to determine the fair value of stock-based payment awards. The fair value determined by the Binomial Model is affected by the Company’s stock price as well as assumptions regarding a number of highly complex and subjective variables. These variables include, but are not limited to, the Company’s expected stock price volatility over the term of the awards, and actual and projected employee stock option exercise behaviors. The Binomial Model also considers the expected exercise multiple which is the multiple of exercise price to grant price at which exercises are expected to occur on average. Option-pricing models were developed for use in estimating the value of traded options that have no vesting or hedging restrictions and are fully transferable. Because the Company’s employee stock options and SARs have certain characteristics that are significantly different from traded options, and because changes in the subjective assumptions can materially affect the estimated value, in management’s opinion, the Binomial Model best provides an accurate measure of the fair value of the Company’s employee stock options and SARs. Although the fair value of employee stock options and SARs are determined in accordance with the Equity topic of the FASB ASC using an option-pricing model, that value may not be indicative of the fair value observed in a willing buyer/willing seller market transaction.

Stock-based compensation expense recognized under FASB ASC 718, “Compensation – Stock Compensation” (“ASC 718”) for 2012 and 2011 was $13.1 million and $11.9 million, respectively.

 

62


Table of Contents

Years Ended December 31, 2011 versus Years Ended December 31, 2010

The Company reported net income of $15.3 million or $0.24 per basic share and $0.22 per diluted share for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared to net income of $101.2 million or $1.59 per basic share and $1.52 per diluted share for the year ended December 31, 2010. The year ended December 31, 2010 included the record-breaking performance of the film Avatar: An IMAX 3D Experience. Net income for the year ended December 31, 2011 includes a $11.7 million charge, or $0.17 per diluted share (2010 — $26.0 million or $0.39 per diluted share) for stock-based compensation and a one-time $2.1 million pre-tax charge ($0.03 per diluted share), due to an arbitration award arising from an arbitration proceeding brought against the Company in connection with a discontinued subsidiary. Net income for the year ended December 31, 2010 also includes a one-time deferred income tax valuation allowance of $55.5 million or $0.83 per diluted share. Adjusted net income, which consists of net income excluding the impact of the stock-based compensation expense, the charge for arbitration award, deferred income tax valuation allowance and the related tax impact, was $28.0 million or $0.41 per diluted share for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared to adjusted net income of $66.0 million or $0.99 per diluted share for the year ended December 31, 2010. A reconciliation of net income, the most directly comparable U.S. GAAP measure, to adjusted net income and adjusted net income per diluted share is presented in the table below:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011 As Revised     2010 As Revised  
     Net Income     Diluted EPS     Net Income     Diluted EPS  

Reported net income

   $ 15,260     $ 0.22     $ 101,240     $ 1.52  

Adjustments:

        

Stock-based compensation

     11,681       0.17       26,028       0.39  

Provision for arbitration award

     2,055       0.03       —         —    

Deferred income tax valuation allowance

     —         —         (55,512     (0.83

Tax impact on items listed above

     (973     (0.01     (5,792     (0.09
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted net income

   $ 28,023     $ 0.41     $ 65,964     $ 0.99  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average diluted shares outstanding

       67,859         66,684  
    

 

 

     

 

 

 

Revenues and Gross Margin

The Company’s revenues for the year ended December 31, 2011 decreased by 4.8% to $236.6 million from $248.6 million in 2010 due to decreases in revenue from the Company’s film and joint revenue sharing arrangement segments partially offset by higher revenue from the IMAX systems segment. The year ended December 31, 2010, included the record breaking performance of Avatar: An IMAX 3D Experience. The gross margin across all segments in 2011 was $113.2 million, or 47.9% of total revenue, compared to $137.7 million, or 55.4% of total revenue in 2010.

IMAX Systems

IMAX systems revenue increased 22.6% to $93.2 million in 2011 as compared to $76.0 million in 2010, resulting primarily from the installation of 15 more new, full systems (excluding digital upgrades) under sales and sales-type leases as compared to the prior year.

Revenue from sales and sales-type leases increased 29.0% to $81.3 million in 2011 from $63.0 million in 2010. The Company recognized revenue on 50 full, new theater systems which qualified as either sales or sales-type leases in 2011, with a total value of $63.4 million, as compared to 35 in 2010 with a total value of $48.0 million. Additionally, the Company recognized revenue on 25 digital upgrades in 2011, with a total value of $11.6 million, as compared to 30 in 2010 with a total value of $12.7 million. Digital upgrades have lower sales prices and gross margin than a full theater installation. The Company has decided to offer digital upgrades at lower selling prices for strategic reasons since the Company believes that digital systems increase flexibility and profitability for the Company’s existing exhibition customers. There was one used system installed and recognized in 2011 with a total value of $1.2 million, as compared to 2 used systems with a total value of $1.5 million in 2010.

Average revenue per full, new sales and sales-type lease system was $1.3 million in 2011, which is slightly lower than the $1.4 million experienced in 2010. Average revenue per digital upgrade was $0.5 million in 2011, as compared to $0.4 million for 2010.

 

 

63


Table of Contents

The breakdown in mix of sales and sales-type lease, operating lease and joint revenue sharing arrangement installations by theater system configuration in 2011 and 2010 is outlined in the table below:

 

      2011     2010  

Sales and Sales-type lease systems—installed and recognized

    

2D SR Dome

     —             

IMAX 3D GT

              

IMAX 3D SR

     —             

IMAX digital

     75 (1)      63 (3) 
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     76         67    

IMAX digital – installed and deferred

     (2)      —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     84         67    

Joint revenue sharing arrangements—installed and operating

    

IMAX digital

     86         56 (3) 
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     170         123    
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Includes the digital upgrade of 25 systems from film-based to digital.
(2) Includes the digital upgrade of 8 systems (all sales arrangements) from film-based to digital.
(3) Includes the digital upgrade of 32 systems (30 sales arrangements and 2 systems under joint revenue sharing arrangements) from film-based to digital.

As noted in the table above, 8 theater systems under a digital upgrade sales arrangement were installed in 2011 but revenue recognition was deferred. The arrangement contained provisions providing the customer with standard digital upgrades, which were installed, and a number of as-of-yet undeveloped upgrades. The Company’s policy is such that once the fair value for the undeveloped upgrade is established, the Company allocates total contract consideration, including any upgrade revenues, between the delivered and undelivered elements on a relative fair value basis and recognizes the revenue allocated to the delivered elements with their associated costs. If the arrangement is materially modified in the future such that contract consideration becomes fixed, the arrangement in its entirety would be subject to the provisions of the amended ASC 605-25 and the Company would be required to develop, absent an established selling price or third party evidence of the selling price for the undeveloped specified upgrade, a best-estimate selling price for the undeveloped specified upgrade, allocate the arrangement’s consideration on a relative selling price allocation basis, and recognize revenue on the delivered elements based on that allocation. In 2010, the Company did not defer any recognitions.

Settlement revenue was $3.8 million in 2011 as compared to $0.4 million in 2010.

IMAX theater systems gross margin from full, new sales and sales-type leases, excluding the impact of settlements and asset impairment charges, increased to 66.0% in 2011 from 65.0% in 2010. The gross margin on digital upgrades was $2.6 million in 2011 in comparison with $2.6 million in 2010. The gross margin on used systems was $0.1 million in 2011 in comparison with $0.3 million in 2010.

Ongoing rent revenue and finance income decreased to $11.9 million in 2011 from $13.0 million in 2010. Gross margin from ongoing rent and finance income decreased to $11.7 million in 2011 from $12.5 million in 2010. The change in revenue and gross margin is primarily due to additional contingent fees resulting from a stronger film slate in 2010, including the record-breaking performance of Avatar: An IMAX 3D Experience and the weaker performance of films in 2011, particularly animated films, offset slightly by a finance income on new systems under sales arrangements that began operations in 2011. Contingent fees included in this caption amounted to $2.7 million and $4.3 million in 2011 and 2010, respectively.

Theater System Maintenance

Theater system maintenance revenue increased 15.8% to $24.8 million in 2011 as compared to $21.4 million in 2010. Theater system maintenance gross margin decreased to $9.4 million in 2011 from $10.1 million in 2010 due to an increase in general service costs resulting from a larger theater network and preventative maintenance efforts expanded during the year. In 2010, the Company recorded a write-down of its film-based service parts inventories of $0.2 million due to the accelerated installation of the MPX system upgrades to digital based systems. Maintenance revenue continues to grow as the number of theaters in the IMAX network grows. Maintenance margins vary depending on the mix of theater system configurations in the theater network and the timing and nature of service visits in the period.

 

 

64


Table of Contents

Joint Revenue Sharing Arrangements

Revenue from joint revenue sharing arrangements decreased 26.3% to $30.8 million in 2011 compared to $41.8 million in 2010. The Company ended the year with 257 theaters operating under joint revenue sharing arrangements as compared to 171 theaters at the end of 2010, an increase of 50.3%. The decrease in revenues from joint revenue sharing arrangements was primarily due to the lower per-screen gross box office realized from the films released to joint revenue sharing theaters during 2011, as compared to 2010, which included the record-breaking performance of Avatar: An IMAX 3D Experience, which contributed approximately $13.7 million in revenue from joint revenue sharing arrangements, offset slightly by the greater number of theaters operating. During 2011, the Company installed 86 full, new theaters under joint revenue sharing arrangements, as compared to 54 new theaters during 2010.

The gross margin from joint revenue sharing arrangements in 2011 decreased to $17.6 million compared to $31.7 million in 2010. The decrease was largely due to lower revenues and higher advertising, marketing and selling expenses experienced in the current year as compared to the prior year. Included in the 2011 gross margin were certain advertising, marketing, and selling expenses of $5.4 million, as compared to $4.2 million for such expenses in 2010. Adjusted gross margin from joint revenue sharing arrangements, which excludes these expenses from both periods, was $23.0 million in 2011, compared to $35.9 million in 2010. A reconciliation of gross margin from the joint revenue sharing arrangement segment, the most directly comparable U.S. GAAP measure, to adjusted gross margin is presented in the table below:

 

(In thousands of U.S. Dollars)    2011      2010  

Gross margin from joint revenue sharing arrangements

   $ 17,605      $ 31,703  

Add:

     

Advertising, marketing and selling expenses

     5,432        4,236  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Adjusted gross margin from joint revenue sharing arrangements

   $ 23,037      $ 35,939  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Film

The Company’s revenues from its film segments decreased 15.9% to $74.9 million in 2011 from $89.1 million in 2010.

Film production and IMAX DMR revenues decreased 20.3% to $50.6 million in 2011 from $63.5 million in 2010. The decrease in film production and IMAX DMR revenues was due primarily to a stronger film slate in 2010 as compared to 2011. 2011 featured fewer event type films released during the period, compared with the record breaking performance of Avatar: An IMAX 3D Experience during 2010, which contributed $187.9 million in IMAX gross box office and $18.6 million in DMR Revenue. In 2010, there were 10 films that recorded gross domestic box office of over $200.0 million, 9 of which were released to the IMAX network. By contrast, 6 films in 2011 recorded gross domestic box office of over $200.0 million, of which 4 were released to the IMAX network. IMAX DMR films released to IMAX theaters during the period, however, continued to significantly outperform lower-cost formats on a per screen basis. Gross box office generated by IMAX DMR films decreased 23.6% to $417.2 million in 2011 versus $545.9 million in 2010. Gross box office per screen for 2011 averaged $1,069,300, in comparison to $1,821,900 in 2010. In 2011, gross-box office was generated primarily from the exhibition of 26 films listed below, as compared to 16 films exhibited in 2010:

 

2011 Films Exhibited

  

2010 Films Exhibited

TRON: Legacy: An IMAX 3D Experience

   Avatar: An IMAX 3D Experience

The Green Hornet: An IMAX 3D Experience

   Alice in Wonderland: An IMAX 3D Experience

Tangled: An IMAX 3D Experience

   How To Train Your Dragon: An IMAX 3D Experience

Sanctum: An IMAX 3D Experience

   Iron Man 2: The IMAX Experience

I Am Number Four: The IMAX Experience

   Shrek Forever After: An IMAX 3D Experience

Mars Needs Moms: An IMAX 3D Experience

   Prince of Persia: The Sands of Time: The IMAX Experience

Sucker Punch: The IMAX Experience

   Toy Story 3: An IMAX 3D Experience

Fast Five: The IMAX Experience

   The Twilight Saga: Eclipse: The IMAX Experience

Thor: An IMAX 3D Experience

   Inception: The IMAX Experience

Pirates of the Caribbean: On Stranger Tides: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

Aftershock: The IMAX Experience

Resident Evil: Afterlife: An IMAX 3D Experience

The Founding of a Party: The IMAX Experience

   Legends of the Guardian: The Owls of Ga’Hoole: An IMAX     3D Experience

 

65


Table of Contents

Kung Fu Panda 2: An IMAX 3D Experience

Super 8: The IMAX Experience

Cars 2: An IMAX 3D Experience

Transformers: Dark of the Moon: An IMAX 3D Experience

Harry Potter and the Deathly Hallows Part II: An IMAX 3D Experience

Final Destination 5: An IMAX 3D Experience

Cowboys & Aliens : The IMAX Experience

Sector 7: An IMAX 3D Experience

Contagion: The IMAX Experience

Real Steel: The IMAX Experience

Puss in Boots: An IMAX 3D Experience

Happy Feet Two: An IMAX 3D Experience

Flying Swords of Dragon Gate: An IMAX 3D Experience

Mission: Impossible – Ghost Protocol: The IMAX Experience

The Adventures of Tintin: The Secret of the Unicorn: An IMAX 3D Experience

  

Paranormal Activity 2: The IMAX Experience

Megamind: An IMAX 3D Experience

Harry Potter and the Deathly Hallows Part I: The IMAX Experience

Tron Legacy: An IMAX 3D Experience

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  

Film distribution revenues decreased 10.4% to $16.1 million in 2011 from $17.9 million in 2010 primarily due to lower revenues from the distribution of library films in ancillary markets. Film post-production revenues increased 6.9% to $8.2 million in 2011 from $7.7 million in 2010 primarily due to an increase in third party business.

The Company’s gross margin from its film segments decreased 39.9% in 2011 to $29.6 million from $49.3 million in 2010. Film production and IMAX DMR gross margins decreased to $23.6 million from $41.2 million in 2010 largely due to a decrease in IMAX DMR revenue resulting from the films exhibited in the current year as compared to the prior year. The film distribution margin of $3.0 million in 2011 was lower than the $5.2 million experienced in 2010, primarily due to the decrease in film distribution revenues. Film post-production gross margin increased by $0.1 million due to an increase in third party business as compared to the prior year.

Other

Other revenue decreased to $12.9 million in 2011 compared to $20.3 million in 2010. Other revenue primarily includes revenue generated from the Company’s owned and operated theaters, camera rentals and after-market sales of projection system parts and 3D glasses. The decrease in other revenue was largely due to a decrease in revenue from theater operations attributable to a decrease in average ticket prices and attendance as result of comparatively weaker film performance in 2011 as compared to 2010.

The gross margin on other revenue was $3.0 million lower in 2011 as compared to 2010. In particular, the theater operations margin decreased $2.8 million from 2010 primarily due to a decrease in theater operations revenue.

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses

Selling, general and administrative expenses decreased to $73.2 million in 2011, as compared to $78.8 million in 2010. The $5.6 million decrease experienced from the prior year comparative period was largely the result of the following:

 

   

a $14.3 million decrease in the Company’s stock-based compensation (including a decrease of $20.3 million for variable share-based awards).

This decrease was offset by:

 

   

a $5.0 million increase in staff-related costs and compensation costs, including an increase in salaries and benefits of $3.8 million as a result of higher average Canadian dollar denominated salary expense, increased staffing and normal merit increase, partially offset by lower pension plan costs;

 

66


Table of Contents
   

a $2.8 million increase due to foreign exchange. During the year ended December 31, 2011, the Company recorded a foreign exchange loss of $1.3 million due to the impact of a decrease in exchange rates on foreign currency denominated working capital balances and unmatured and un-hedged foreign currency forward contracts, as compared to a gain of $1.5 million recorded in 2010. See note 16(b) of the audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of the Company’s 2011 Form 10-K for more information; and

 

   

a $0.9 million increase in legal, professional and other general corporate expenditures.

Provision for Arbitration Award

During 2011, the Company recorded a provision of $2.1 million regarding an award issued in connection with an arbitration proceeding brought against the Company, relating to agreements entered into in 1994 and 1995 by its former Ridefilm subsidiary, whose business the Company discontinued through a sale to a third party in March 2001. On January 12, 2012, the Company, Ridefilm and Robots of Mars, Inc. (“Robots”) entered into a confidential settlement agreement, pursuant to which the parties fully and finally resolved and settled all claims between them relating to this dispute. See note 14(c) of the audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of the Company’s 2011 Form-10K for more information.

Research and Development

Research and development expenses increased to $7.8 million in 2011 compared to $6.2 million in 2010. The increased research and development expenses for 2011 compared to 2010 are primarily attributable to ongoing enhancements to the Company’s digital projection technology to ensure that the Company continues to provide the highest-quality, premier movie going experience available to consumers. In the fourth quarter of 2011, the Company announced the completion of a deal in which it secured certain exclusive license rights to a portfolio of intellectual property in the digital cinema field owned by Kodak, which the Company believes will support its efforts to deliver the highest quality digital content available to the largest IMAX film-based screens.

Receivable Provisions, Net of Recoveries

Receivable provisions, net of recoveries for accounts receivable and financing receivables, amounted to a net provision of $1.6 million in 2011, as compared to $1.4 million in 2010.

The Company’s accounts receivables and financing receivables are subject to credit risk. These receivables are concentrated with the leading theater exhibitors and studios in the film entertainment industry. To minimize the Company’s credit risk, the Company retains title to underlying theater systems that are leased, performs initial and ongoing credit evaluations of its customers and makes ongoing provisions for its estimate of potentially uncollectible amounts. Accordingly, the Company believes it has adequately protected itself against exposures relating to receivables and contractual commitments.

Asset Impairments and Other Significant Charges

The Company recorded an asset impairment charge of less than $0.1 million, which is consistent with the prior year, against property, plant and equipment after the Company assessed the carrying value of certain assets in its theater operations segment in light of their future expected cash flows. The Company recognized that the carrying values for the assets exceeded the expected undiscounted future cash flows.

In 2010, the charge relating to inventory primarily resulted from a reduction in the net realizable value of its GT and SR film-based projector inventories and associated parts due to a further market shift away from the film-based projector systems. No such charges were recognized in 2011.

In 2011, the Company recorded a $0.4 million charge reflecting assets that no longer meet capitalization requirements as the assets were no longer in use. No such charges were recorded in 2010.

Interest Income and Expenses

Interest income decreased to less than $0.1 million in 2011, as compared to $0.4 million in 2010. The decrease was largely due to interest recorded during 2010 related to tax refunds.

 

67


Table of Contents

Interest expense was consistent at $1.8 million in 2011 and 2010. Included in interest expense is the amortization of deferred finance costs in the amount of $0.4 million and $0.3 million in 2011 and 2010, respectively. The Company’s policy is to defer and amortize all the costs relating to a debt financing which are paid directly to the debt provider, over the life of the debt instrument.

Income Taxes

The Company’s effective tax rate differs from the statutory tax rate and varies from year to year primarily as a result of numerous permanent differences, investment and other tax credits, the provision for income taxes at different rates in foreign and other provincial jurisdictions, enacted statutory tax rate increases or reductions in the year, changes due to foreign exchange, changes in the Company’s valuation allowance based on the Company’s recoverability assessments of deferred tax assets, and favorable or unfavorable resolution of various tax examinations.

There was a $1.9 million decrease in the valuation allowance resulting from utilization of loss carryforwards and deductible temporary differences against current period income and the Company’s estimates of the recoverability of its deferred tax assets based on an analysis of both positive and negative evidence including projected future earnings. The Company recorded an income tax provision of $9.3 million for 2011, of which $0.1 million is related to a decrease in unrecognized tax benefits. For 2010, the Company recorded an income tax recovery of $52.6 million, of which $0.1 million was related to an increase in unrecognized tax benefits.

During the year ended December 31, 2011, after considering all available evidence, both positive (including recent profits, projected future profitability, backlog, carryforward periods for utilization of net operating loss carryovers and tax credits, discretionary deductions and other factors) and negative (including cumulative losses in past years and other factors), it was concluded that the valuation allowance against the Company’s deferred tax assets should be further reduced by approximately $1.9 million. The remaining $6.1 million balance in the valuation allowance as at December 31, 2011 is primarily attributable to certain U.S. federal and state net operating loss carryovers and federal tax credits that likely will expire without being utilized. As at December 31, 2010, the Company had determined that based on the improvement of the Company’s operating results in 2009 and 2010 and the Company’s assessment of projected future results of operations, realization of a deferred income tax benefit is now more likely than not. As a result, the judgment about the need for a full valuation allowance against deferred tax assets changed, and a reduction in the valuation allowance was recorded as a benefit within the recovery for income taxes from continuing operations. The recovery for income taxes in the year ended December 31, 2010 includes a net non-cash income tax benefit of $55.5 million in continuing operations related to a decrease in the valuation allowance for the Company’s deferred tax assets and other tax adjustments. The net income tax benefit during the year ended December 31, 2010 is primarily attributable to the estimated realization of deferred tax assets resulting from the utilization of deductible temporary differences and certain net operating loss carryforwards and tax credits against future years’ taxable income.

The Company anticipates utilizing the majority of its currently available tax attributes over the next three years.

Equity-Accounted Investments

The Company accounts for investments in new business ventures using the guidance of the FASB ASC 323 Investments – Equity Method and Joint Ventures (“ASC 323”). At December 31, 2011, the equity method of accounting is being utilized for an investment with a carrying value of $4.1 million (December 31, 2010—$1.6 million). For the year ended December 31, 2011, gross revenues, cost of revenue and net loss for the investment were $2.3 million, $9.8 million and $17.7 million, respectively (2010—$nil, $0.2 million and $4.3 million, respectively). The Company recorded its proportionate share of the net loss which amounted to $1.8 million for 2011 compared to $0.5 million in 2010.

Pension Plan

The Company has an unfunded defined benefit pension plan, the Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (the “SERP”), covering Messrs. Gelfond and Bradley J. Wechsler, the Company’s former Co-CEO and current Chairman of its Board of Directors. As at December 31, 2011, the Company had an unfunded and accrued projected benefit obligation of approximately $19.0 million (December 31, 2010 — $18.1 million) in respect of the SERP. At the time the Company established the SERP, it also took out life insurance policies on Messrs. Gelfond and Wechsler with coverage amounts of $21.5 million in aggregate. During 2010, the Company obtained $7.8 million representing the cash surrender value of the policies. These amounts were used to pay down the term loan under the Prior Credit Facility (as defined on page 70, “Liquidity and Capital Resources – Prior Credit Facility”) and fund part of the $14.7 million lump sum payment made to Mr. Wechsler on August 1, 2010 under the SERP which settled in full Mr. Wechsler’s entitlement under the SERP.

 

68


Table of Contents

The net periodic benefit cost was $0.5 million and $0.4 million in 2011 and 2010, respectively. The components of net periodic benefit cost were as follows:

 

     Years ended December 31  
           2011                  2010        

Service cost

   $ —        $ 448  

Interest cost

     279        351  

Amortization of actuarial loss

     214        —    

Realized actuarial gain on settlement of pension liability

     —          (385
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Pension expense

   $ 493      $ 414  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The plan experienced an actuarial loss of $0.6 million during 2011, resulting primarily from a decrease in the PBGC published annuity interest rates used to determine the lump sum payment under the plan.

Under the terms of the SERP, monthly annuity payments payable to Mr. Wechsler, whose employment as Co-CEO terminated effective April 1, 2009, were deferred for six months and were paid in the form of a lump sum plus interest on the deferred amount on October 1, 2009. These monthly annuity payments continued through to August 1, 2010. On August 1, 2010, the Company made a lump sum payment of $14.7 million to Mr. Wechsler in accordance with the terms of the plan, representing a settlement in full of Mr. Wechsler’s entitlement under the SERP.

The Company has a postretirement plan to provide health and welfare benefits to Canadian employees meeting certain eligibility requirements. As at December 31, 2011, the Company had an unfunded benefit obligation of $4.1 million (December 31, 2011 — $3.4 million). See note 4 to the audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of the Company’s 2012 Form 10-K for additional details. In February 2013, the Company amended the Canadian postretirement plan to reduce future benefits provided under the plan. As a result of this change, the Company anticipates the postretirement liability to be reduced by $2.7 million, resulting in a pre-tax curtailment gain in the first quarter of 2013 of approximately $2.4 million.

In July 2000, the Company agreed to maintain health benefits for Messrs. Gelfond and Wechsler upon retirement. As at December 31, 2011, the Company had an unfunded benefit obligation recorded of $0.5 million (December 31, 2010—$0.5 million).

Stock-Based Compensation

The Company utilizes the Binomial Model to determine the fair value of stock-based payment awards. The fair value determined by the Binomial Model is affected by the Company’s stock price as well as assumptions regarding a number of highly complex and subjective variables. These variables include, but are not limited to, the Company’s expected stock price volatility over the term of the awards, and actual and projected employee stock option exercise behaviors. The Binomial Model also considers the expected exercise multiple which is the multiple of exercise price to grant price at which exercises are expected to occur on average. Option-pricing models were developed for use in estimating the value of traded options that have no vesting or hedging restrictions and are fully transferable. Because the Company’s employee stock options and SARs have certain characteristics that are significantly different from traded options, and because changes in the subjective assumptions can materially affect the estimated value, in management’s opinion, the Binomial Model best provides an accurate measure of the fair value of the Company’s employee stock options and SARs. Although the fair value of employee stock options and SARs are determined in accordance with the Equity topic of the FASB ASC using an option-pricing model, that value may not be indicative of the fair value observed in a willing buyer/willing seller market transaction.

Stock-based compensation expense recognized under FASB ASC 718, “Compensation – Stock Compensation” (“ASC 718”) for 2011 and 2010 was $11.9 million and $27.7 million, respectively.

 

69


Table of Contents

LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

Prior Credit Facility

On June 2, 2011, the Company amended and restated the terms of its senior secured credit facility. The Company’s amended and restated senior secured credit facility (the “Prior Credit Facility”), with a scheduled maturity of October 31, 2015, had a maximum borrowing capacity of $110.0 million, consisting of revolving asset-based loans of up to $50.0 million, subject to a borrowing base calculation (as described below) and including a sublimit of $20.0 million for letters of credit, and a revolving term loan of up to $60.0 million. Certain of the Company’s subsidiaries served as guarantors (the “Guarantors”) of the Company’s obligations under the Prior Credit Facility. The Prior Credit Facility was collateralized by a first priority security interest in substantially all of the present and future assets of the Company and the Guarantors.

The Company’s indebtedness under the Prior Credit Facility includes the following:

 

     December 31,      December 31,  
     2012      2011  

Revolving Term Loan

   $ 11,000      $ 55,083  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

As at December 31, 2012, the Company’s current borrowing capacity under the revolving asset-based portion of the Prior Credit Facility was $50.0 million after deduction for letters of credit of $nil, and the minimum Excess Availability reserve of $5.0 million (December 31, 2011 – $47.1 million) and borrowing capacity under the revolving term portion of the Prior Credit Facility was $49.0 million (December 31, 2011 – $4.9 million).

The terms of the Prior Credit Facility was set forth in the Second Amended and Restated Prior Credit Agreement (the “Prior Credit Agreement”), dated June 2, 2011, among the Company, Wells Fargo Capital Finance Corporation (Canada), as agent, lender, sole lead arranger and sole bookrunner, (“Wells Fargo Canada”) and Export Development Canada, as lender (“EDC”, together with Wells Fargo Canada, the “Prior Lenders”) and in various collateral and security documents entered into by the Company and the Guarantors. Each of the Guarantors had also entered into a guarantee in respect of the Company’s obligations under the Prior Credit Facility.

The revolving asset-based portion of the Prior Credit Facility permitted maximum aggregate borrowings equal to the lesser of:

(i) $50.0 million, and

(ii) a collateral calculation based on the percentages of the book values of certain of the Company’s net investment in sales-type leases, financing receivables, certain trade accounts receivable, finished goods inventory allocated to backlog contracts and the appraised values of the expected future cash flows related to operating leases and the Company’s owned real property, reduced by certain accruals and accounts payable and subject to other conditions, limitations and reserve right requirements.

The revolving asset-based portion and the revolving term loan portion of the Prior Credit Facility bore interest, at the Company’s option, at (i) LIBOR plus a margin of 2.00% per annum, or (ii) Wells Fargo Canada’s prime rate plus a margin of 0.50% per annum. Under the Prior Credit Facility, the effective interest rate for the year ended December 31, 2012 for the revolving term loan portion was 2.42% (2011 – 2.50%). There was no amount drawn on the revolving asset-based portion of the Prior Credit Facility.

The Prior Credit Facility provides that the Company will be required to maintain a ratio of funded debt (as defined in the Prior Credit Agreement) to EBITDA (as defined in the Prior Credit Agreement) of not more than 2:1. The Company will also be required to maintain a Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio (as defined in the Prior Credit Agreement) of not less than 1.1:1.0. At all times under the terms of the Prior Credit Facility, the Company was required to maintain minimum Excess Availability of not less than $5.0 million and minimum Cash and Excess Availability of not less than $15.0 million. The ratio of funded debt to EBITDA was 0.10:1 as at December 31, 2012, where Funded Debt (as defined in the Prior Credit Agreement) is the sum of all obligations evidenced by notes, bonds, debentures or similar instruments and was $11.0 million. EBITDA was calculated as follows:

 

70


Table of Contents

EBITDA per Credit Facility:

 

(In thousands of U.S. Dollars)       

Net income

   $ 41,337  

Add:

  

Loss from equity accounted investments

     1,362  

Provision for income taxes

     15,079  

Interest expense net of interest income

     604  

Depreciation and amortization including film asset amortization(1)

     32,618  

Write-downs net of recoveries including asset impairments and receivable provisions(1)

     1,607  

Stock and other non-cash compensation

     14,220  
  

 

 

 
   $ 106,827  
  

 

 

 

 

(1) See note 19 to the audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of the Company’s 2012 Form 10-K.

The Prior Credit Facility contained typical affirmative and negative covenants, including covenants that limit or restrict the ability of the Company and the Guarantors to: incur certain additional indebtedness; make certain loans, investments or guarantees; pay dividends; make certain asset sales; incur certain liens or other encumbrances; conduct certain transactions with affiliates and enter into certain corporate transactions.

The Prior Credit Facility also contained customary events of default, including upon an acquisition or change of control or upon a change in the business and assets of the Company or a Guarantor that in each case is reasonably expected to have a material adverse effect on the Company or Guarantor. If an event of default occurs and is continuing under the Prior Credit Facility, the Prior Lenders may, among other things, terminate their commitments and require immediate repayment of all amounts owed by the Company.

New Credit Facility

On February 7, 2013, the Company amended and restated the terms of its Prior Credit Facility. The amended and restated facility (the “New Credit Facility”), with a scheduled maturity of February 7, 2018, has a maximum borrowing capacity of $200.0 million. The Prior Credit Facility had a maximum borrowing capacity of $110.0 million. Certain of the Company’s subsidiaries will serve as guarantors (the “Guarantors”) of the Company’s obligations under the New Credit Facility. The New Credit Facility is collateralized by a first priority security interest in substantially all of the present and future assets of the Company and the Guarantors.

The terms of the New Credit Facility are set forth in the Third Amended and Restated Credit Agreement (the “Credit Agreement”), dated February 7, 2013, among the Company, the Guarantors, the lenders named therein, Wells Fargo Bank, National Association (“Wells Fargo”), as agent and issuing lender (Wells Fargo, together with the lenders named therein, the “Lenders”) and Wells Fargo Securities, LLC, as Sole Lead Arranger and Sole Bookrunner and in various collateral and security documents entered into by the Company and the Guarantors. Each of the Guarantors has also entered into a guarantee in respect of the Company’s obligations under the New Credit Facility.

The New Credit Facility permits the Company to undertake up to $150.0 million in stock buybacks and dividends, provided certain covenants in the Credit Agreement are maintained. In the event that the Company undertakes stock buybacks or makes dividend payments, any amounts outstanding under the revolving portion of the New Credit Facility up to the first $75.0 million of any such stock buybacks and dividend payments will be converted to a term loan.

At closing, the Company borrowed $18.0 million from the New Credit Facility to repay outstanding indebtedness under the Prior Credit Facility and to pay fees and closing costs related to entry into the New Credit Facility.

The amounts outstanding under the New Credit Facility bear interest, at the Company’s option, at (i) LIBOR plus a margin of (a) 1.50%, 1.75% or 2.00% depending on the Company’s Total Leverage Ratio (as defined in the Credit Agreement) per annum, or (ii) Wells Fargo’s prime rate plus a margin of 0.50% per annum. Term loans, if any, under the New Credit Facility must be repaid under a 5-year straight line amortization, with a balloon payment due at maturity. The Company is required to provide an interest rate hedge for 50% of any term loans outstanding.

The New Credit Facility provides that the Company will be required to maintain a Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio (as defined in the Credit Agreement) of not less than 1.1:1.0. The Company will also be required to maintain minimum EBITDA (as defined in the Credit Agreement) of $70.0 million between closing and December 30, 2013, which requirement increases to $80.0 million on

 

71


Table of Contents

December 31, 2013, $90.0 million on December 31, 2014, and $100.0 million on December 31, 2015. The Company must also maintain a Maximum Total Leverage Ratio (as defined in the Credit Agreement) of 2.5:1.0 between closing and December 30, 2013, which requirement decreases to (i) 2.25:1.0 on December 31, 2013; (ii) 2.00:1:0 on December 31, 2014; and (iii) 1.75:1.0 on December 31, 2015.

The New Credit Facility contains typical affirmative and negative covenants, including covenants that limit or restrict the ability of the Company and the Guarantors to: incur certain additional indebtedness; make certain loans, investments or guarantees; pay dividends; make certain asset sales; incur certain liens or other encumbrances; conduct certain transactions with affiliates and enter into certain corporate transactions.

The New Credit Facility also contains customary events of default, including upon an acquisition or change of control or upon a change in the business and assets of the Company or a Guarantor that in each case is reasonably expected to have a material adverse effect on the Company or a guarantor. If an event of default occurs and is continuing under the New Credit Facility, the Lenders may, among other things, terminate their commitments and require immediate repayment of all amounts owed by the Company.

Letters of Credit and Other Commitments

As at December 31, 2012, the Company did not have any letters of credit and advance payment guarantees outstanding (December 31, 2011 — $3.0 million), under the Prior Credit Facility.

The Company also has a $10.0 million facility for advance payment guarantees and letters of credit through the Bank of Montreal for use solely in conjunction with guarantees fully insured by EDC (the “Bank of Montreal Facility”). The Bank of Montreal Facility is unsecured and includes typical affirmative and negative covenants, including delivery of annual consolidated financial statements within 120 days of the end of the fiscal year. The Bank of Montreal Facility is subject to periodic annual reviews. As at December 31, 2012, the Company had letters of credit and advance payment guarantees outstanding of $0.9 million under the Bank of Montreal facility as compared to $0.8 million as at December 31, 2011.

Cash and Cash Equivalents

As at December 31, 2012, the Company’s principal sources of liquidity included cash and cash equivalents of $21.3 million, the Prior Credit Facility, anticipated collection from trade accounts receivable of $42.0 million including receivables from theaters under joint revenue sharing arrangements and DMR agreements with studios, anticipated collection from financing receivables due in the next 12 months of $13.6 million and payments expected in the next 12 months on existing backlog deals. As at December 31, 2012, the Company had drawn down $11.0 million on the revolving term loan portions of the Prior Credit Facility (with remaining availability of $49.0 million) and had drawn down $nil on the revolving asset-based portion of the Prior Credit Facility (with remaining availability of $50.0 million). There were $nil letters of credit and advance payment guarantees outstanding under the Prior Credit Facility and $0.9 million under the Bank of Montreal Facility.

During the year ended December 31, 2012, the Company’s operations provided cash of $73.6 million and the Company used cash of $35.5 million to fund capital expenditures, principally to build equipment for use in joint revenue sharing arrangements, to purchase other intangible assets, including costs to develop the Company’s new ERP system, and to purchase property, plant and equipment. Based on management’s current operating plan for 2013, the Company expects to continue to use cash to deploy additional theater systems under joint revenue sharing arrangements, to fund DMR agreements with studios and invest in research and development activities. Cash flows from joint revenue sharing arrangements are derived from the theater box-office receipts, and in some cases, concession revenue and a small upfront or initial payment and the Company invested directly in the roll out of 60 new theater systems under joint revenue sharing arrangements in 2012.

The Company believes that cash flow from operations together with existing cash and borrowing available under the New Credit Facility will be sufficient to fund the Company’s business operations, including its strategic initiatives relating to existing joint revenue sharing arrangements for the next 12 months.

The Company’s operating cash flow will be adversely affected if management’s projections of future signings for theater systems and film performance, theater installations and film productions are not realized. The Company forecasts its short-term liquidity requirements on a quarterly and annual basis. Since the Company’s future cash flows are based on estimates and there may be factors that are outside of the Company’s control (see “Risk Factors” in Item 1A in the Company’s 2012 Form 10-K), there is no guarantee that the Company will continue to be able to fund its operations through cash flows from operations. Under the terms of the Company’s typical sale and sales-type lease agreement, the Company receives substantial cash payments before the Company

 

72


Table of Contents

completes the performance of its obligations. Similarly, the Company receives cash payments for some of its film productions in advance of related cash expenditures.

Operating Activities

The Company’s net cash provided by operating activities is affected by a number of factors, including the proceeds associated with new signings of theater system lease and sale agreements in the year, costs associated with contributing systems under joint revenue sharing arrangements, the box office performance of films distributed by the Company and/or released to IMAX theaters, increases or decreases in the Company’s operating expenses, including research and development, and the level of cash collections received from its customers.

Cash provided by operating activities amounted to $73.6 million in 2012. Changes in other non-cash operating assets as compared to 2011 include: an increase of $7.3 million in financing receivables; a decrease of $4.1 million in accounts receivable; an increase of $0.4 million in inventories; an increase of $0.7 million in prepaid expenses; $0.1 million increase in other assets which includes a $0.4 million decrease in insurance recoveries receivable, a $0.3 million decrease in commissions and other deferred selling expenses and a $0.8 million increase in other assets. Changes in other operating liabilities as compared to December 31, 2011 include: a decrease in deferred revenue of $0.5 million related to backlog payments received in the current year, offset by amounts relieved from deferred revenue related to theater system installations; a decrease in accounts payable of $8.1 million and a decrease of $2.3 million in accrued liabilities.

Included in accrued liabilities at December 31, 2012, was $20.4 million of accrued pension obligations.

Investing Activities

Net cash used in investing activities amounted to $35.5 million in 2012 compared to $63.5 million in 2011, which includes an investment in joint revenue sharing equipment of $23.3 million, purchases of $6.1 million in property, plant and equipment, an additional investment in business ventures of $0.4 million and an increase in other intangible assets of $5.8 million. Net cash used in investing activities in 2011 included the license of certain intellectual property rights related to the Company’s development of a laser projection system.

Financing Activities

Net cash used in financing activities in 2012, amounted to $34.8 million, primarily due to the net repayment of bank indebtedness of $44.0 million, as compared to cash provided by financing activities of $45.1 million in 2011.

Capital Expenditures

Capital expenditures, including the Company’s investment in joint revenue sharing equipment, purchase of property, plant and equipment, net of sales proceeds, other intangible assets and investments in film assets were $52.0 million in 2012 as compared to $73.3 million in 2011. In 2013 the Company anticipates continued capital expenditures due in large part to the roll-out of theaters pursuant to joint revenue sharing arrangements.

Prior Year Cash Flow Activities

Net cash provided by operating activities amounted to $6.2 million in the year ended December 31, 2011. Changes in other non-cash operating assets as compared to 2010 include: an increase of $14.6 million in financing receivables; an increase of $7.5 million in accounts receivable; an increase of $1.3 million in inventories; an increase of $0.3 million in prepaid expenses; $1.0 million increase in other assets which includes a $0.4 million decrease in commissions and other deferred selling expenses and a $1.0 million decrease in insurance recoveries receivable and an increase in other assets of $2.4 million. Changes in other non-cash operating liabilities as compared to December 31, 2010 include: an increase in deferred revenue of $0.7 million related to amounts added to deferred revenue for backlog payments received in the current year, offset by amounts relieved from deferred revenue related to theater system installations; an increase in accounts payable of $5.6 million and a decrease of $31.1 million in accrued liabilities including payments of $23.7 million for stock-based compensation. Net cash used in investing activities in the year ended December 31, 2011 amounted to $63.5 million, which includes an investment in joint revenue sharing equipment of $33.3 million, purchases of $5.5 million in property, plant and equipment, an additional investment in business ventures of $2.5 million and an increase in other intangible assets of $22.2 million. Net cash provided by financing activities in 2011 amounted to $45.1 million due to an increase in net bank indebtedness of $37.5 million and proceeds from the issuance of common shares from stock option exercises of $7.9 million, offset by a $0.3 million in payment of fees relating to the Prior Credit Facility amendment.

 

73


Table of Contents

Capital expenditures including the Company’s investment in joint revenue sharing equipment, purchase of property, plant and equipment net of sales proceeds and investments in film assets were $73.3 million in the year ended December 31, 2011.

CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS

Payments to be made by the Company under contractual obligations are as follows:

 

     Payments Due by Period  
(In thousands of U.S. Dollars)    Total
Obligations
     2013      2014      2015      2016      2017      Thereafter  

Pension obligations(1)

   $ 21,058      $ —        $ 21,058      $ —        $ —        $ —        $ —    

Prior Credit Facility(2)

     11,000        —          —          11,000        —          —          —    

Operating lease obligations(3)

     15,085        6,931        5,142        1,177        511        511        813  

Purchase obligations(4)

     12,053        11,553        500        —          —          —          —    

Postretirement benefits obligations(5)

     5,130        83        79        88        128        128        4,624  

Capital lease obligations(6)

     20        20        —          —          —          —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 64,346      $ 18,587      $ 26,779      $ 12,265      $ 639      $ 639      $ 5,437  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) The SERP assumptions are that Mr. Gelfond will receive a lump sum payment six months after retirement at the end of the current term of his employment agreement (December 31, 2013), although Mr. Gelfond has not informed the Company that he intends to retire at that time.
(2) Interest on the Prior Credit Facility was payable monthly in arrears based on the applicable variable rate and is not included above. On February 7, 2013, the Company amended and restated the terms of its credit facility. The Comapany’s borrowing capacity under the New Credit Facility is up to $200.0 million. On the closing date, the Company borrowed $18.0 million under the New Credit Facility to repay outstanding indebtedness under the Prior Credit Facility and to pay fees and closing costs related to entry into the New Credit Facility.
(3) The Company’s total minimum annual rental payments to be made under operating leases, mostly consisting of rent at the Company’s properties in New York and Santa Monica, and at the various owned and operated theaters.
(4) The Company’s total payments to be made under binding commitments with suppliers and outstanding payments to be made for supplies ordered but yet to be invoiced.
(5) In February 2013, the Company amended the Canadian postretirement plan to reduce future benefits provided under the plan. As a result of this change, the Company anticipates the postretirement liability to be reduced by $2.7 million, resulting in a pre-tax curtailment gain in the first quarter of 2013 of approximately $2.4 million.
(6) The Company’s total minimum annual payments to be made under capital leases, mostly consisting of payments for IT hardware and various other fixed assets.

Pension and Postretirement Obligations

The Company has an unfunded defined benefit pension plan, the SERP, covering Messrs. Gelfond and Wechsler. As at December 31, 2012, the Company had an unfunded and accrued projected benefit obligation of approximately $20.4 million (December 31, 2011 — $19.0 million) in respect of the SERP.

On August 1, 2010, the Company made a lump sum payment to Mr. Wechsler in accordance with the terms of the plan, representing a settlement of Mr. Wechsler’s entitlement under the SERP. Under the terms of the SERP, if Mr. Gelfond’s employment is terminated other than for cause, he is entitled to receive SERP benefits in the form of a lump sum payment. SERP benefit payments to Mr. Gelfond are subject to a deferral for six months after the termination of his employment, at which time Mr. Gelfond will be entitled to receive interest on the deferred amount credited at the applicable federal rate for short-term obligations. The term of Mr. Gelfond’s current employment agreement has been extended through December 31, 2013, although Mr. Gelfond has not informed the Company that he intends to retire at that time. Under the terms of the extension, Mr. Gelfond also agreed that any compensation earned during 2011, 2012 and 2013 would not be included in calculating his entitlement under the SERP.

The Company has a postretirement plan to provide health and welfare benefits to Canadian employees meeting certain eligibility requirements. As at December 31, 2012, the Company had an unfunded benefit obligation of $4.6 million (December 31, 2011 — $4.1 million). See note 4 to the audited consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of the Company’s 2012 Form 10-K for additional details. In February 2013, the Company amended the Canadian postretirement plan to reduce future benefits provided under the plan. As a result of this change, the Company anticipates the postretirement liability to be reduced by $2.7 million, resulting in a pre-tax curtailment gain in the first quarter of 2013 of approximately $2.4 million.

 

74


Table of Contents

In July 2000, the Company agreed to maintain health benefits for Messrs. Gelfond and Wechsler upon retirement. As at December 31, 2012, the Company had an unfunded benefit obligation of $0.5 million (December 31, 2011 — $0.5 million).

OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS

There are currently no off-balance sheet arrangements that have or are reasonably likely to have a current or future material effect on the Company’s financial condition.

 

Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

The Company is exposed to market risk from foreign currency exchange rates and interest rates, which could affect operating results, financial position and cash flows. Market risk is the potential change in an instrument’s value caused by, for example, fluctuations in interest and currency exchange rates. The Company’s primary market risk exposure is the risk of unfavorable movements in exchange rates between the U.S. dollar, the Canadian dollar and the Chinese Yuan Renminbi. The Company does not use financial instruments for trading or other speculative purposes.

Foreign Exchange Rate Risk

A majority of the Company’s revenue is denominated in U.S. dollars while a significant portion of its costs and expenses is denominated in Canadian dollars. A portion of the Company’s net U.S. dollar cash flows is converted to Canadian dollars to fund Canadian dollar expenses through the spot market. The Company has incoming cash flows from its revenue generating theaters and ongoing operating expenses in China through its wholly-owned subsidiary IMAX Shanghai Multimedia Technology Co. Ltd. In Japan, the Company has ongoing Yen-denominated operating expenses related to its Japanese operations. Net Renminbi and Japanese Yen cash flows are converted to U.S. dollars through the spot market. The Company also has cash receipts under leases denominated in Japanese Yen, Euros and Canadian dollars.

The Company manages its exposure to foreign exchange rate risks through the Company’s regular operating and financing activities and, when appropriate, through the use of derivative financial instruments. These derivative financial instruments are utilized to hedge economic exposures as well as reduce earnings and cash flow volatility resulting from shifts in market rates.

For the year ended December 31, 2012, the Company recorded a foreign exchange gain of $1.2 million as compared with a foreign exchange loss of $1.3 million in 2011, associated with the translation of foreign currency denominated monetary assets and liabilities and unhedged foreign exchange contracts.

The Company entered into a series of foreign currency forward contracts to manage the Company’s risks associated with the volatility of foreign currencies with settlement dates throughout 2013. In addition, at December 31, 2012, the Company held foreign currency forward contracts to manage foreign currency risk on future anticipated Canadian dollar expenditures that were not considered foreign currency hedges by the Company. Foreign currency derivatives are recognized and measured in the balance sheet at fair value. Changes in the fair value (gains or losses) are recognized in the consolidated statement of operations except for derivatives designated and qualifying as foreign currency hedging instruments. For foreign currency hedging instruments, the effective portion of the gain or loss in a hedge of a forecasted transaction is reported in other comprehensive income and reclassified to the consolidated statement of operations when the forecasted transaction occurs. Any ineffective portion is recognized immediately in the consolidated statement of operations. The notional value of foreign currency hedging instruments at December 31, 2012 was $8.1 million (December 31, 2011 — $20.6 million). A gain of $0.7 million was recorded to other comprehensive income with respect to the depreciation/appreciation in the value of these contracts in 2012 (2011 — loss of $0.2 million). A gain of $0.2 million was reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income to selling, general and administrative expenses in 2012 (2011 — gain of $0.7 million). Appreciation or depreciation on forward contracts not meeting the requirements for hedge accounting in the Derivatives and Hedging Topic of the FASB ASC are recorded to selling, general and administrative expenses. The notional value of forward contracts that do not qualify for hedge accounting at December 31, 2012 was $nil (December 31, 2011 — $67.3 million).

 

75


Table of Contents

For all derivative instruments, the Company is subject to counterparty credit risk to the extent that the counterparty may not meet its obligations to the Company. To manage this risk, the Company enters into derivative transactions only with major financial institutions.

At December 31, 2012, the Company’s net investment in leases and working capital items denominated in Canadian dollars, Renminbi, Yen and Euros was $7.9 million. Assuming a 10% appreciation or depreciation in foreign currency exchange rates from the quoted foreign currency exchange rates at December 31, 2012, the potential change in the fair value of foreign currency-denominated net investment in leases and working capital items would be $0.7 million. A significant portion of the Company’s selling, general, and administrative expenses are denominated in Canadian dollars. Assuming a 1% change appreciation or depreciation in foreign currency exchange rates at December 31, 2012, the potential change in the amount of selling, general, and administrative expenses would be $0.1 million for every $10.0 million in Canadian denominated expenditures.

Interest Rate Risk Management

The Company’s earnings are also affected by changes in interest rates due to the impact those changes have on its interest income from cash, and its interest expense from variable-rate borrowings under the New Credit Facility.

As at December 31, 2012, the Company’s borrowings under the Prior Credit Facility were $11.0 million (December 31, 2011 — $55.1 million).

The Company’s largest exposure with respect to variable rate debt comes from changes in the LIBOR. The Company had variable rate debt instruments representing approximately 6.5% and 25.3% of its total liabilities at December 31, 2012 and 2011, respectively. If the interest rates available to the Company increased by 10%, the Company’s interest expense would increase by approximately less than $0.1 million and interest income from cash would increase by approximately less than $0.1 million. These amounts are determined by considering the impact of the hypothetical interest rates on the Company’s variable rate debt and cash balances at December 31, 2012.

 

76


Table of Contents
Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

     Page  

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     78   

Consolidated Balance Sheets as at December 31, 2012 and 2011

     79   

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010

     80   

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the years ended December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010

     81   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010

     82   

Consolidated Statements of Shareholders’ Equity for the years ended December  31, 2012, 2011 and 2010

     83   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

     84   

************

 

77


Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Shareholders of IMAX Corporation:

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of IMAX Corporation and its subsidiaries as of December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011 and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income, cash flows and shareholders’ equity for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2012. In addition, we have audited the financial statements schedule listed in the accompanying index under Item 15(a)(2). We also have audited IMAX Corporation’s and its subsidiaries’ internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2012, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). Management is responsible for these consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedule, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting under Item 9A of its 2012 Annual Report on Form 10-K. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements, the financial statements schedule and the company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our integrated audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements and the financial statement schedule are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audits of the consolidated financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall consolidated financial statement presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that: (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements. Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of IMAX Corporation and its subsidiaries as of December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011 and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2012 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. In addition, in our opinion, the financial statements schedule listed in the index under Item 15(a)(2) presents fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein when read in conjunction with the related consolidated financial statements. Also, in our opinion, IMAX Corporation maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2012, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by COSO.

 

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
Chartered Accountants, Licensed Public Accountants
Toronto, Ontario
February 21, 2013

 

78


Table of Contents

IMAX CORPORATION

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

In accordance with United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles

(In thousands of U.S. dollars)

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012     2011  
           As Revised
(note 4)
 

Assets

    

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 21,336     $ 18,138  

Accounts receivable, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $1,564 (December 31, 2011 — $1,840)

     42,007       46,659  

Financing receivables (notes 5 and 21(c))

     94,193       86,714  

Inventories (note 6)

     15,794       19,747  

Prepaid expenses

     3,833       3,126  

Film assets (note 7)

     3,737       2,388  

Property, plant and equipment (note 8)

     113,610       101,253  

Other assets (notes 9, 21(d) and 21(e))

     23,963       14,238  

Deferred income taxes (note 10)

     36,461       51,046  

Goodwill

     39,027       39,027  

Other intangible assets (note 11)

     27,911       24,913  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets (note 12)

   $ 421,872     $ 407,249  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities

    

Bank indebtedness (note 12)

   $ 11,000     $ 55,083  

Accounts payable

     15,144       28,985  

Accrued and other liabilities (notes 7, 13(a), 13(c), 14, 15(c), 21(a), 21(d), 22 and 23)

     68,695       58,855  

Deferred revenue

     73,954       74,458  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     168,793       217,381  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies (notes 13 and 14)

    

Shareholders’ equity

    

Capital stock (note 15) common shares — no par value. Authorized — unlimited number.

    

Issued and outstanding — 66,482,425 (December 31, 2011 — 65,052,740)

     313,744       303,395  

Other equity

     28,892       17,510  

Deficit

     (87,166     (128,503

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

     (2,391     (2,534
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total shareholders’ equity

     253,079       189,868  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity

   $ 421,872     $ 407,249  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

(the accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements)

 

79


Table of Contents

IMAX CORPORATION

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

In accordance with United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles

(In thousands of U.S. dollars, except per share amounts)

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012     2011     2010  
           As Revised
(note 4)
    As Revised
(note 4)
 

Revenues

      

Equipment and product sales

   $ 78,161     $ 85,016     $ 72,578  

Services (note 16(c))

     136,606       106,720       123,911  

Rentals (note 16(c))

     61,268       34,810       46,936  

Finance income

     7,523       6,162       4,789  

Other (note 16(a))

     732       3,848       400  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     284,290       236,556       248,614  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Costs and expenses applicable to revenues (note 2(m))

      

Equipment and product sales

     37,538       38,742       36,394  

Services (note 16(c))

     72,617       69,277       63,425  

Rentals

     21,402       14,301       11,111  

Other

     —         1,018       32  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     131,557       123,338       110,962  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross margin

     152,733       113,218       137,652  

Selling, general and administrative expenses (note 16(b))

     81,560       73,157       78,757  

(including share-based compensation expense of $13.1 million, $11.7 million and $26.0 million for 2012, 2011, 2010, respectively)

      

Provision for arbitration award (note 14(c))

     —         2,055       —    

Research and development

     11,411       7,829       6,249  

Amortization of intangibles

     706       465       513  

Receivable provisions, net of recoveries (note 17)

     524       1,570       1,443  

Asset impairments (note 18)

     —         28       45  

Impairment of available-for-sale investment

     150       —         —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from operations

     58,382       28,114       50,645  

Interest income

     85       57       399  

Interest expense (note 10(g))

     (689     (1,827     (1,885
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from operations before income taxes

     57,778       26,344       49,159  

(Provision for) recovery of income taxes

     (15,079     (9,293     52,574  

Loss from equity-accounted investments

     (1,362     (1,791     (493
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

   $ 41,337     $ 15,260     $ 101,240  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income per share—basic and diluted: (note 15(d))

      

Net income per share—basic:

   $ 0.63     $ 0.24     $ 1.59  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income per share—diluted:

   $ 0.61     $ 0.22     $ 1.52  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(the accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements)

 

80


Table of Contents

IMAX CORPORATION

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME

In accordance with United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles

(In thousands of U.S. dollars)

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012     2011     2010  
           As Revised
(note 4)
    As Revised
(note 4)
 

Net income

   $  41,337     $  15,260     $  101,240  

Unrealized defined benefit plan actuarial loss (note 22(a))

     (1,104     (603     (2,646

Realized actuarial gain on settlement of pension liability (note 22(a))

     —         —         (385

Amortization of defined benefit plan actuarial loss (note 22(a))

     365       214       —    

Unrealized postretirement benefit plan actuarial loss (note 22(d))

     (129     (234     (237

Unrealized net gain (loss) from cash flow hedging instruments
(note 21(d))

     716       (162     797  

Realization of cash flow hedging net gains upon settlement
(note 21(d))

     (236     (684     (665

Change in market value of available-for-sale investment (note 21(b))

     338       (488     —    

Other-than-temporary impairment of available-for-sale investment
(note 21(b))

     150       —         —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss), before tax:

     100       (1,957     (3,136

Income tax recovery allocated to other comprehensive income (loss)
(note 10(h))

     43       446       1,067  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income

   $ 41,480     $ 13,749     $ 99,171  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(the accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements)

 

81


Table of Contents

IMAX CORPORATION

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

In accordance with United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles

(In thousands of U.S. dollars)

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012     2011     2010  
           As Revised
(note 4)
    As Revised
(note 4)
 

Cash provided by (used in):

      

Operating Activities

      

Net income

   $ 41,337     $ 15,260     $ 101,240  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to cash from operations:

      

Depreciation and amortization (notes 19(c) and 20(a))

     32,788       25,163       20,536  

Write-downs, net of recoveries (notes 19(d) and 20(a))

     1,607       1,954       2,551  

Change in deferred income taxes

     14,724       7,994       (55,065

Stock and other non-cash compensation

     14,220       12,814       28,524  

Provision for arbitration award (note 14(c))

     —         2,055       —    

Unrealized foreign currency exchange (gain) loss

     (329     1,255       (865

Loss from equity-accounted investments

     1,362       1,791       493  

Gain on non-cash contribution to equity-accounted investees

     —         (404     —    

Change in cash surrender value of life insurance

     —         —         (107

Investment in film assets

     (16,817     (12,256     (10,139

Changes in other non-cash operating assets and liabilities (note 19(a))

     (15,262     (49,379     (28,682
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

     73,630       6,247       58,486  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investing Activities

      

Purchase of property, plant and equipment

     (6,055     (5,528     (5,338

Investment in joint revenue sharing equipment

     (23,257     (33,290     (21,275

Investment in new business ventures

     (381     (2,483     (3,636

Cash surrender value of life insurance

     —         —         7,797  

Acquisition of other assets

     —         —         (691

Acquisition of other intangible assets

     (5,826     (22,206     (681
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

     (35,519     (63,507     (23,824
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing Activities

      

Increase in bank indebtedness (note 12)

     9,917       75,083       —    

Repayment of bank indebtedness (note 12)

     (54,000     (37,500     (32,500

Common shares issued—stock options exercised (note 15(b))

     8,920       7,864       8,276  

Proceeds from disgorgement of stock sale profits

     314       —         —    

Credit facility amendment fees paid

     —         (306     —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities

     (34,849     45,141       (24,224
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effects of exchange rate changes on cash

     (64     (133     (129
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents during year

     3,198       (12,252     10,309  

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year

     18,138       30,390       20,081  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of year

   $ 21,336     $ 18,138     $ 30,390  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(the accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements)

 

82


Table of Contents

IMAX CORPORATION

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

In accordance with United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles

(In thousands of U.S. dollars)

 

    Common
Shares Issued
and
Outstanding
    Capital
Stock
    Other
Equity
    Deficit     Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss)
    Total
Shareholders’
Equity
 
                      As Revised
(note 4)
    As Revised
(note 4)
    As Revised
(note 4)
 

Balance as at December 31, 2009

    62,831,974     $  280,048     $ 6,044     $ (245,003   $  1,046     $ 42,135  

Net income

    —         —         —         101,240       —         101,240  

Paid-in capital for non-employee stock options granted (note 15(c))

    —         —         383       —         —         383  

Employee stock options exercised

    1,090,782       8,063       (1,696     —         —         6,367  

Non-employee stock options exercised

    222,817       3,016       (1,102     —         —         1,914  

Paid-in capital for employee stock options granted (note 15(c))

    —         —         4,058       —         —         4,058  

Unrecognized defined benefit plan actuarial loss, net (note 22)

    —         —         —         —         (1,985     (1,985

Unrealized postretirement benefit plan actuarial loss, net (note 22(d))

    —         —         —         —         (166     (166

Unrealized net gain on cash flow hedging instruments, net (note 21)

    —         —         —         —         (50     (50

Tax recovery related to share issuance expenses

    —         1,850       —         —         —         1,850  

Realized actuarial gain on settlement of defined pension plan liability, net (note 22)

    —         —         —         —         132       132  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as at December 31, 2010

    64,145,573     $ 292,977     $ 7,687     $ (143,763   $ (1,023   $ 155,878  

Net income

    —         —         —         15,260       —         15,260  

Paid-in capital for non-employee stock options granted (note 15(c))

    —         —         2,375       —         —         2,375  

Employee stock options exercised

    763,056       5,173       (731     —         —         4,442  

Non-employee stock options exercised

    144,111       5,245       (1,823     —         —         3,422  

Paid-in capital for employee stock options granted (note 15(c))

    —         —         9,391       —         —         9,391  

Utilization of windfall tax benefits from employee stock options (note 10(f))

    —         —         611       —         —         611  

Unrecognized defined benefit plan actuarial loss, net (note 22)

    —         —         —         —         (458     (458

Amortization of defined benefit plan actuarial loss, net (note 22)

    —         —         —         —         161       161  

Unrealized postretirement benefit plan actuarial loss, net (note 22(d))

    —         —         —         —         (176     (176

Unrealized net gain on cash flow hedging instruments, net (note 21)

    —         —         —         —         (117     (117

Realization of cash flow hedging gains upon settlement, net (note 21)

    —         —         —         —         (494     (494

Unrealized change in market value of available-for-sale investment, net (note 21)

    —         —         —         —         (427     (427
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as at December 31, 2011

    65,052,740     $ 303,395     $ 17,510     $ (128,503   $ (2,534   $ 189,868  

Net income

    —         —         —         41,337       —         41,337  

Paid-in capital for non-employee stock options granted (note 15(c))

    —         —         115       —         —         115  

Employee stock options exercised

    1,414,685       9,946       (1,279     —         —         8,667  

Non-employee stock options exercised

    15,000       403       (150     —         —         253  

Paid-in capital for employee stock options granted (note 15(c))

    —         —         12,359       —         —         12,359  

Disgorgement of profit

    —         —         314       —         —         314  

Utilization of windfall tax benefits from employee stock options (note 10(f))

    —         —         23       —         —         23  

Unrealized defined benefit plan actuarial loss, net (note 22)

    —         —         —         —         (819     (819

Amortization of defined benefit plan actuarial loss, net (note 22)

    —         —         —         —         274       274  

Unrealized postretirement benefit plan actuarial loss, net (note 22(d))

    —         —         —         —         (96     (96

Unrealized change in cash flow hedging instruments, net (note 21)

    —         —         —         —         531       531  

Realization of cash flow hedging gains upon settlement, net (note 21)

    —         —         —         —         (174     (174

Change in market value of available-for-sale investment, net (note 21)

    —         —         —         —         296       296  

Other-than-temporary impairment of available-for-sale investment, net (note 21)

    —         —         —         —         131       131  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as at December 31, 2012

    66,482,425     $ 313,744     $ 28,892     $ (87,166   $ (2,391   $ 253,079  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements)

 

83


Table of Contents

IMAX CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

In accordance with United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles

(Tabular amounts in thousands of U.S. dollars, unless otherwise stated)

1. Description of the Business

IMAX Corporation together with its consolidated wholly-owned subsidiaries (the “Company”) is an entertainment technology company specializing in digital and film-based motion picture technologies, whose principal activities are the:

 

   

design, manufacture, sale and lease of proprietary theater systems for IMAX theaters principally owned and operated by commercial and institutional customers located in 53 countries as at December 31, 2012;

 

   

production, digital re-mastering, post-production and/or distribution of certain films shown throughout the IMAX theater network;

 

   

provision of other services to the IMAX theater network, including ongoing maintenance and extended warranty services for IMAX theater systems;

 

   

operation of certain theaters primarily in the United States; and

 

   

other activities, which includes short-term rental of cameras and aftermarket sales of projector system components.

The Company refers to all theaters using the IMAX theater system as “IMAX theaters.”

The Company’s revenues from equipment and product sales include the sale and sales-type leasing of its theater systems and sales of their associated parts and accessories, contingent rentals on sales-type leases and contingent additional payments on sales transactions.

The Company’s revenues from services include the provision of maintenance and extended warranty services, digital re-mastering services, film production and film post-production services, film distribution, and the operation of certain theaters.

The Company’s rentals include revenues from the leasing of its theater systems that are operating leases, contingent rentals on operating leases, joint revenue sharing arrangements and the rental of the Company’s cameras and camera equipment.

The Company’s finance income represents interest income arising from the sales-type leases and financed sales of the Company’s theater systems.

The Company’s other revenues include the settlement of contractual obligations with customers.

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Significant accounting policies are summarized as follows:

The Company prepares its consolidated financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP.

(a) Basis of Consolidation

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company together with its wholly-owned subsidiaries, except for subsidiaries which the Company has identified as variable interest entities (“VIEs”) where the Company is not the primary beneficiary.

The Company has evaluated its various variable interests to determine whether they are VIEs as required by the Consolidation Topic of the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC” or “Codification”). The Company has 9 film production companies that are VIEs. For 2 of the Company’s film production companies, the Company has determined that it is the primary beneficiary of these entities as the Company has the power to direct the activities of the respective VIE that most significantly impact the respective VIE’s economic performance and has the obligation to absorb losses of the VIE that

 

84


Table of Contents

could potentially be significant to the respective VIE or the right to receive benefits from the respective VIE that could potentially be significant to the respective VIE. The Company continues to consolidate these entities, with no material impact on the operating results or financial condition of the Company, as these production companies have total assets of $nil (December 31, 2011 — $nil) and total liabilities of $nil as at December 31, 2012 (December 31, 2011 — $nil). For the other 7 film production companies which are VIEs, the Company did not consolidate these film entities since it does not have the power to direct activities and does not absorb the majority of the expected losses or expected residual returns. The Company equity accounts for these entities. As at December 31, 2012, these 7 VIEs have total assets and total liabilities of $15.9 million (December 31, 2011 — $12.7 million). Earnings of the investees included in the Company’s consolidated statement of operations amounted to $nil in 2012 (2011 — $nil). The carrying value of these investments in VIEs that are not consolidated is $nil at December 31, 2012 (December 31, 2011 — $nil). A loss in value of an investment other than a temporary decline is recognized as a charge to the consolidated statement of operations. The Company’s exposure, which is determined based on the level of funding contributed by the Company and the development stage of the respective film, is $0.9 million at December 31, 2012 (2011 — $nil).

The Company accounts for investments in new business ventures using the guidance of the FASB ASC 323 “Investments – Equity Method and Joint Ventures” (“ASC 323”) and ASC 320 “Investments in Debt and Equity Securities” (“ASC 320”), as appropriate. At December 31, 2012, the equity method of accounting is being utilized for an investment with a carrying value of $3.1 million (December 31, 2011 — $4.1 million). The Company has determined it is not the primary beneficiary of this VIE, and therefore it has not been consolidated. In addition, the Company has an investment in preferred stock of another business venture of $1.5 million which meets the criteria for classification as a debt security under ASC 320 and is recorded at its fair value of $1.3 million at December 31, 2012 (December 31, 2011 — $1.0 million). This investment is classified as an available-for-sale investment. The total carrying value of investments in new business ventures at December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011 is $4.4 million and $5.1 million, respectively, and is recorded in Other Assets.

All significant intercompany accounts and transactions, including all unrealized intercompany profits on transactions with equity-accounted investees, have been eliminated.

(b) Use of Estimates

The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and judgments that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could be materially different from these estimates. Significant estimates made by management include, but are not limited to: selling prices associated with the individual elements in multiple element arrangements; residual values of leased theater systems; economic lives of leased assets; allowances for potential uncollectibility of accounts receivable, financing receivables and net investment in leases; provisions for inventory obsolescence; ultimate revenues for film assets; impairment provisions for film assets, long-lived assets and goodwill; depreciable lives of property, plant and equipment; useful lives of intangible assets; pension plan assumptions; accruals for contingencies including tax contingencies; valuation allowances for deferred income tax assets; and, estimates of the fair value of stock-based payment awards.

(c) Cash and Cash Equivalents

The Company considers all highly liquid investments convertible to a known amount of cash and with an original maturity of three months or less to be cash equivalents.

 

85


Table of Contents

(d) Accounts Receivable and Financing Receivables

Allowances for doubtful accounts receivable are based on the Company’s assessment of the collectibility of specific customer balances, which is based upon a review of the customer’s credit worthiness, past collection history and the underlying asset value of the equipment, where applicable. Interest on overdue accounts receivable is recognized as income as the amounts are collected.

For trade accounts receivable that have characteristics of both a contractual maturity of one year or less, and arose from the sale of other goods or services, the Company charges off the balance against the allowance for doubtful accounts when it is known that a provided amount will not be collected.

The Company monitors the performance of the theaters to which it has leased or sold theater systems which are subject to ongoing payments. When facts and circumstances indicate that there is a potential impairment in the net investment in lease or a financing receivable, the Company will evaluate the potential outcome of either renegotiations involving changes in the terms of the receivable or defaults on the existing lease or financed sale agreements. The Company will record a provision if it is considered probable that the Company will be unable to collect all amounts due under the contractual terms of the arrangement or a renegotiated lease amount will cause a reclassification of the sales-type lease to an operating lease.

When the net investment in lease or the financing receivable is impaired, the Company will recognize a provision for the difference between the carrying value in the investment and the present value of expected future cash flows discounted using the effective interest rate for the net investment in the lease or the financing receivable. If the Company expects to recover the theater system, the provision is equal to the excess of the carrying value of the investment over the fair value of the equipment.

When the minimum lease payments are renegotiated and the lease continues to be classified as a sales-type lease, the reduction in payments is applied to reduce unearned finance income.

These provisions are adjusted when there is a significant change in the amount or timing of the expected future cash flows or when actual cash flows differ from cash flow previously expected.

Once a net investment in lease or financing receivable is considered impaired, the Company does not recognize interest income until the collectibility issues are resolved. When finance income is not recognized, any payments received are applied against outstanding gross minimum lease amounts receivable or gross receivables from financed sales. Once the collectability issues are resolved, the Company will once again commence the recognition of interest income.

(e) Inventories

Inventories are carried at the lower of cost, determined on an average cost basis, and net realizable value except for raw materials, which are carried at the lower of cost and replacement cost. Finished goods and work-in-process include the cost of raw materials, direct labor, theater design costs, and an applicable share of manufacturing overhead costs.

The costs related to theater systems under sales and sales-type lease arrangements are relieved from inventory to costs and expenses applicable to revenues-equipment and product sales when revenue recognition criteria are met. The costs related to theater systems under operating lease arrangements and joint revenue sharing arrangements are transferred from inventory to assets under construction in property, plant and equipment when allocated to a signed joint revenue sharing arrangement or when the arrangement is first classified as an operating lease.

The Company records provisions for excess and obsolete inventory based upon current estimates of future events and conditions, including the anticipated installation dates for the current backlog of theater system contracts, technological developments, signings in negotiation, growth prospects within the customers’ ultimate marketplace and anticipated market acceptance of the Company’s current and pending theater systems.

Finished goods inventories can contain theater systems for which title has passed to the Company’s customer (as the theater system has been delivered to the customer) but the revenue recognition criteria as discussed in note 2(m) have not been met.

(f) Film Assets

Costs of producing films, including labor, allocated overhead, capitalized interest, and costs of acquiring film rights are recorded as film assets and accounted for in accordance with Entertainment-Films Topic of the FASB ASC. Production financing provided by third parties that acquire substantive rights in the film is recorded as a reduction of the cost of the production. Film assets are amortized and participation costs are accrued using the individual-film-forecast method in the same ratio that current gross revenues

 

86


Table of Contents

bear to current and anticipated future ultimate revenues. Estimates of ultimate revenues are prepared on a title-by-title basis and reviewed regularly by management and revised where necessary to reflect the most current information. Ultimate revenues for films include estimates of revenue over a period not to exceed ten years following the date of initial release.

Film exploitation costs, including advertising costs, are expensed as incurred.

Costs, including labor and allocated overhead, of digitally re-mastering films where the copyright is owned by a third party and the Company shares in the revenue of the third party are included in film assets. These costs are amortized using the individual-film-forecast method in the same ratio that current gross revenues bear to current and anticipated future ultimate revenues from the re-mastered film.

The recoverability of film assets is dependent upon commercial acceptance of the films. If events or circumstances indicate that the recoverable amount of a film asset is less than the unamortized film costs, the film asset is written down to its fair value. The Company determines the fair value of its film assets using a discounted cash flow model.

(g) Property, Plant and Equipment

Property, plant and equipment are recorded at cost and are depreciated on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives as follows:

 

Theater system components(1)      over the equipment’s anticipated useful life (7 to 20 years)
Camera equipment      5 to 10 years
Buildings      20 to 25 years
Office and production equipment      3 to 5 years
Leasehold improvements      over the shorter of the initial term of the underlying leases plus any reasonably assured renewal terms, and the useful life of the asset

 

(1) includes equipment under joint revenue sharing arrangements.

Equipment and components allocated to be used in future operating leases and joint revenue sharing arrangements, as well as direct labor costs and an allocation of direct production costs, are included in assets under construction until such equipment is installed and in working condition, at which time the equipment is depreciated on a straight-line basis over the lesser of the term of the joint revenue sharing arrangement and the equipment’s anticipated useful life.

The Company reviews the carrying values of its property, plant and equipment for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset or asset group might not be recoverable. Assets are grouped at the lowest level for which identifiable cash flows are largely independent when testing for, and measuring for, impairment. In performing its review of recoverability, the Company estimates the future cash flows expected to result from the use of the asset or asset group and its eventual disposition. If the sum of the expected undiscounted future cash flows is less than the carrying amount of the asset or asset group, an impairment loss is recognized in the consolidated statements of operations. Measurement of the impairment loss is based on the excess of the carrying amount of the asset or asset group over the fair value calculated using discounted expected future cash flows.

A liability for the fair value of an asset retirement obligation associated with the retirement of tangible long-lived assets and the associated asset retirement costs are recognized in the period in which the liability and costs are incurred if a reasonable estimate of fair value can be made using a discounted cash flow model. The associated asset retirement costs are capitalized as part of the carrying amount of the long-lived asset and subsequently amortized over the asset’s useful life. The liability is accreted over the period to expected cash outflows.

 

87


Table of Contents

(h) Other Assets

Other assets include insurance recoverable, deferred charges on debt financing, deferred selling costs that are direct and incremental to the acquisition of sales contracts, foreign currency derivative gains, lease incentives and investments in new business ventures.

Costs of debt financing are deferred and amortized over the term of the debt using the effective interest method.

Selling costs related to an arrangement incurred prior to recognition of the related revenue are deferred and expensed to costs and expenses applicable to revenues upon (i) recognition of the contract’s theater system revenue or (ii) abandonment of the sale arrangement.

Foreign currency derivative gains are accounted for at fair value using quoted prices in closed exchanges (Level 2 input in accordance with the Fair Value Measurements Topic of the FASB ASC hierarchy).

The Company may provide lease incentives to certain exhibitors which are essential to entering into the respective lease arrangement. Lease incentives include payments made to or on behalf of the exhibitor. These lease incentives are recognized as a reduction in rental revenue on a straight-line basis over the term of the lease.

Investments in new business ventures are accounted for using ASC 323 as described in note 2(a). The Company currently accounts for its 10.1% investment in 3net, a 3D television channel operated by a limited liability corporation owned by the Company, using the equity method of accounting. The Company accounts for in-kind contributions to its equity investment in accordance with ASC 845 “Non-Monetary Transactions” (“ASC 845”) whereby if the fair value of the asset or assets contributed is greater than the carrying value a partial gain shall be recognized.

The Company’s investment in debt securities is classified as an available-for-sale investment in accordance with ASC 320. Unrealized holding gains and losses for this investment is excluded from earnings and reported in other comprehensive income until realized. Realization occurs upon sale of a portion of or the entire investment. The investment is impaired if the fair value is less than cost, which is assessed in each reporting period. When the Company intends to sell a specifically identified beneficial interest, a write-down for other-than-temporary impairment shall be recognized in earnings.

(i) Goodwill

Goodwill represents the excess of purchase price over the fair value of net identifiable assets acquired in a purchase business combination. Goodwill is not subject to amortization and is tested for impairment annually, or more frequently if events or circumstances indicate that the asset might be impaired. The Company first assesses certain qualitative factors to determine whether the existence of events or circumstances leads to determination that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount. If, after assessing the totality of events or circumstances, the Company determines it is not more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carry amount, then performing the two-step impairment test is unnecessary. When necessary, impairment of goodwill is tested at the reporting unit level by comparing the reporting unit’s carrying amount, including goodwill, to the fair value of the reporting unit. The fair value of the reporting unit is estimated using a discounted cash flow approach. If the carrying amount of the reporting unit exceeds its fair value, then a second step is performed to measure the amount of impairment loss, if any, by comparing the fair value of each identifiable asset and liability in the reporting unit to the total fair value of the reporting unit. Any impairment loss is expensed in the consolidated statement of operations and is not reversed if the fair value subsequently increases.

(j) Other Intangible Assets

Patents, trademarks and other intangibles are recorded at cost and are amortized on a straight-line basis over estimated useful lives ranging from 4 to 10 years except for intangible assets that have an identifiable pattern of consumption of the economic benefit of the asset, which are amortized over the consumption pattern.

The Company reviews the carrying values of its other intangible assets for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset or asset group might not be recoverable. Assets are grouped at the lowest level for which identifiable cash flows are largely independent when testing for, and measuring for, impairment. In performing its review for recoverability, the Company estimates the future cash flows expected to result from the use of the asset or asset group and its eventual disposition. If the sum of the expected undiscounted future cash flows is less than the carrying amount of the asset or asset group, an impairment loss is recognized in the consolidated statement of operations. Measurement of the impairment loss is based on

 

88


Table of Contents

the excess of the carrying amount of the asset or asset group over the fair value calculated using discounted expected future cash flows.

(k) Deferred Revenue

Deferred revenue represents cash received prior to revenue recognition criteria being met for theater system sales or leases, film contracts, maintenance and extended warranty services, film related services and film distribution.

(l) Income Taxes

Income taxes are accounted for under the liability method whereby deferred income tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the expected future tax consequences of temporary differences between the accounting and tax bases of assets and liabilities. Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. The effect on deferred income tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates or laws is recognized in the consolidated statement of operations in the period in which the change is enacted. Investment tax credits are recognized as a reduction of income tax expense.

The Company assesses realization of deferred income tax assets and, based on all available evidence, concludes whether it is more likely than not that the net deferred income tax assets will be realized. A valuation allowance is provided for the amount of deferred income tax assets not considered to be realizable.

The Company is subject to ongoing tax exposures, examinations and assessments in various jurisdictions. Accordingly, the Company may incur additional tax expense based upon the outcomes of such matters. In addition, when applicable, the Company adjusts tax expense to reflect the Company’s ongoing assessments of such matters which require judgment and can materially increase or decrease its effective rate as well as impact operating results. The Company provides for such exposures in accordance with the Income Taxes Topic of the FASB ASC.

(m) Revenue Recognition

Multiple Element Arrangements

The Company’s revenue arrangements with certain customers may involve multiple elements consisting of a theater system (projector, sound system, screen system and, if applicable, 3D glasses cleaning machine); services associated with the theater system including theater design support, supervision of installation, and projectionist training; a license to use of the IMAX brand; 3D glasses; maintenance and extended warranty services; and licensing of films. The Company evaluates all elements in an arrangement to determine what are considered deliverables for accounting purposes and which of the deliverables represent separate units of accounting based on the applicable accounting guidance in the Leases Topic of the FASB ASC; the Guarantees Topic of the FASB ASC; the Entertainment – Films Topic of FASB ASC; and the Revenue Recognition Topic of the FASB. If separate units of accounting are either required under the relevant accounting standards or determined to be applicable under the Revenue Recognition Topic, the total consideration received or receivable in the arrangement is allocated based on the applicable guidance in the above noted standards.

Theater Systems

The Company has identified the projection system, sound system, screen system and, if applicable, 3D glasses cleaning machine, theater design support, supervision of installation, projectionist training and the use of the IMAX brand to be a single deliverable and a single unit of accounting (the “System Deliverable”). When an arrangement does not include all the elements of a System Deliverable, the elements of the System Deliverable included in the arrangement are considered by the Company to be a single deliverable and a single unit of accounting. The Company is not responsible for the physical installation of the equipment in the customer’s facility; however, the Company supervises the installation by the customer. The customer has the right to use the IMAX brand from the date the Company and the customer enter into an arrangement.

The Company’s System Deliverable arrangements involve either a lease or a sale of the theater system. Consideration in the Company’s arrangements, that are not joint revenue sharing arrangements, consist of upfront or initial payments made before and after the final installation of the theater system equipment and ongoing payments throughout the term of the lease or over a period of time, as specified in the arrangement. The ongoing payments are the greater of an annual fixed minimum amount or a certain percentage of the theater box-office. Amounts received in excess of the annual fixed minimum amounts are considered contingent payments. The

 

89


Table of Contents

Company’s arrangements are non-cancellable, unless the Company fails to perform its obligations. In the absence of a material default by the Company, there is no right to any remedy for the customer under the Company’s arrangements. If a material default by the Company exists, the customer has the right to terminate the arrangement and seek a refund only if the customer provides notice to the Company of a material default and only if the Company does not cure the default within a specified period.

Sales Arrangements

For arrangements qualifying as sales, the revenue allocated to the System Deliverable is recognized in accordance with the Revenue Recognition Topic of the FASB ASC, when all of the following conditions have been met: (i) the projector, sound system and screen system have been installed and are in full working condition, (ii) the 3D glasses cleaning machine, if applicable, has been delivered, (iii) projectionist training has been completed and (iv) the earlier of (a) receipt of written customer acceptance certifying the completion of installation and run-in testing of the equipment and the completion of projectionist training or (b) public opening of the theater, provided there is persuasive evidence of an arrangement, the price is fixed or determinable and collectibility is reasonably assured.

The initial revenue recognized consists of the initial payments received and the present value of any future initial payments and fixed minimum ongoing payments that have been attributed to this unit of accounting. Contingent payments in excess of the fixed minimum ongoing payments are recognized when reported by theater operators, provided collectibility is reasonably assured.

The Company has also agreed, on occasion, to sell equipment under lease or at the end of a lease term. Consideration agreed to for these lease buyouts is included in revenues from equipment and product sales, when persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, the fees are fixed or determinable, collectibility is reasonably assured and title to the theater system passes from the Company to the customer.

In a certain sales arrangement not subject to the provisions of the amended FASB ASC 605-25, “Revenue Recognition: Multiple-Element Arrangements” (“ASC 605-25”), as the arrangement was entered into before January 1, 2011 and not materially modified subsequently, the Company provided a customer with digital upgrades on several systems, including several specified upgrades to an as-of-yet undeveloped product. At the current-period-end, the Company has not yet established the fair value of this product, and as a result, the Company cannot determine the arrangement’s consideration nor its allocation of consideration between delivered and undelivered items. Consequently, revenue recognition has been deferred for all delivered items in the arrangement. Once the Company determines an objective and reliable fair value of the undeveloped specified upgrade, the Company will be able to calculate total arrangement consideration and consequently, the Company will be able to recognize revenue on the delivered elements of the arrangement. If the arrangement is materially modified in the future such that contract consideration becomes fixed, the arrangement in its entirety would be subject to the provisions of the amended FASB ASC 605-25 and the Company would be required to develop, absent an established selling price for the undeveloped specified upgrade, a best estimated selling price for the undeveloped specified upgrade, allocate the arrangement’s consideration on a relative selling price allocation basis, and recognize revenue on the delivered elements based on that allocation.

Lease Arrangements

The Company uses the Leases Topic of FASB ASC to evaluate whether an arrangement is a lease within the scope of the accounting standard. Arrangements not within the scope of the accounting standard are accounted for either as a sales or services arrangement, as applicable.

For lease arrangements, the Company determines the classification of the lease in accordance with the Lease Topic of FASB ASC. A lease arrangement that transfers substantially all of the benefits and risks incident to ownership of the equipment is classified as a sales-type lease based on the criteria established by the accounting standard; otherwise the lease is classified as an operating lease. Prior to commencement of the lease term for the equipment, the Company may modify certain payment terms or make concessions. If these circumstances occur, the Company reassesses the classification of the lease based on the modified terms and conditions.

For sales-type leases, the revenue allocated to the System Deliverable is recognized when the lease term commences, which the Company deems to be when all of the following conditions have been met: (i) the projector, sound system and screen system have been installed and are in full working condition, (ii) the 3D glasses cleaning machine, if applicable, has been delivered, (iii) projectionist training has been completed and (iv) the earlier of (a) receipt of the written customer acceptance certifying the completion of installation and run-in testing of the equipment and the completion of projectionist training or (b) public opening of the theater, provided collectibility is reasonably assured.

 

90


Table of Contents

The initial revenue recognized for sales-type leases consists of the initial payments received and the present value of future initial payments and fixed minimum ongoing payments computed at the interest rate implicit in the lease. Contingent payments in excess of the fixed minimum payments are recognized when reported by theater operators, provided collectibility is reasonably assured.

For operating leases, initial payments and fixed minimum ongoing payments are recognized as revenue on a straight-line basis over the lease term. For operating leases, the lease term is considered to commence when all of the following conditions have been met: (i) the projector, sound system and screen system have been installed and in full working condition, (ii) the 3D glasses cleaning machine, if applicable, has been delivered, (iii) projectionist training has been completed and (iv) the earlier of (a) receipt of written customer acceptance certifying the completion of installation and run-in testing of the equipment and the completion of projectionist training or (b) public opening of the theater. Contingent payments in excess of fixed minimum ongoing payments are recognized as revenue when reported by theater operators, provided collectibility is reasonably assured.

Revenue from joint revenue sharing arrangements with upfront payments that qualify for classification as sales-type leases is recognized in accordance with the sales-type lease criteria discussed above. Contingent revenues from joint revenue sharing arrangements is recognized as box office results and concessions revenues are reported by the theater operator, provided collectibility is reasonably assured.

Finance Income

Finance income is recognized over the term of the sales-type lease or financed sales receivable, provided collectibility is reasonably assured. Finance income recognition ceases when the Company determines that the associated receivable is not collectible.

Finance income is suspended when the Company identifies a theater that is delinquent, non-responsive or not negotiating in good faith with the Company. Once the collectability issues are resolved the Company will resume recognition of finance income.

Improvements and Modifications

Improvements and modifications to the theater system after installation are treated as separate revenue transactions, if and when the Company is requested to perform these services. Revenue is recognized for these services when the performance of the services has been completed, provided there is persuasive evidence of an arrangement, the fee is fixed or determinable and collectibility is reasonably assured.

Cost of Equipment and Product Sales

Theater systems and other equipment subject to sales-type leases and sales arrangements includes the cost of the equipment and costs related to project management, design, delivery and installation supervision services as applicable. The costs related to theater systems under sales and sales-type lease arrangements are relieved from inventory to costs and expenses applicable to revenues-equipment and product sales when revenue recognition criteria are met. In addition, the Company defers direct selling costs such as sales commissions and other amounts related to these contracts until the related revenue is recognized. These costs included in costs and expenses applicable to revenues-equipment and product sales, totaled $2.7 million in 2012 (2011 – $2.4 million, 2010 – $1.9 million). The cost of equipment and product sales prior to direct selling costs was $34.8 million in 2012 (2011 – $36.3 million, 2010 – $34.5 million). The Company may have warranty obligations at or after the time revenue is recognized which require replacement of certain parts that do not affect the functionality of the theater system or services. The costs for warranty obligations for known issues are accrued as charges to costs and expenses applicable to revenues-equipment and product sales at the time revenue is recognized based on the Company’s past historical experience and cost estimates.

Cost of Rentals

For theater systems and other equipment subject to an operating lease or placed in a theater operators’ venue under a joint revenue sharing arrangement, the cost of equipment and those costs that result directly from and are essential to the arrangement, is included within property, plant and equipment. Depreciation and impairment losses, if any, are included in cost of rentals based on the accounting policy set out in note 2(g). Commissions are recognized as costs and expenses applicable to revenues-rentals in the month they are earned, which is typically the month of installation. These costs totaled $1.5 million in 2012 (2011 — $2.3 million, 2010 — $2.1 million). Direct advertising and marketing costs for each theater are charged to costs and expenses applicable to revenues-rentals as incurred. These costs totaled $1.9 million in 2012 (2011 — $3.2 million, 2010 — $2.1 million).

 

91


Table of Contents

Terminations, Consensual Buyouts and Concessions

The Company enters into theater system arrangements with customers that contain customer payment obligations prior to the scheduled installation of the theater system. During the period of time between signing and the installation of the theater system, which may extend several years, certain customers may be unable to, or elect not to, proceed with the theater system installation for a number of reasons including business considerations, or the inability to obtain certain consents, approvals or financing. Once the determination is made that the customer will not proceed with installation, the arrangement may be terminated under the default provisions of the arrangement or by mutual agreement between the Company and the customer (a “consensual buyout”). Terminations by default are situations when a customer does not meet the payment obligations under an arrangement and the Company retains the amounts paid by the customer. Under a consensual buyout, the Company and the customer agree, in writing, to a settlement and to release each other of any further obligations under the arrangement or an arbitrated settlement is reached. Any initial payments retained or additional payments received by the Company are recognized as revenue when the settlement arrangements are executed and the cash is received, respectively. These termination and consensual buyout amounts are recognized in Other revenues.

In addition, the Company could agree with customers to convert their obligations for other theater system configurations that have not yet been installed to arrangements to acquire or lease the IMAX digital theater system. The Company considers these situations to be a termination of the previous arrangement and origination of a new arrangement for the IMAX digital theater system. For all arrangements entered into or modified prior to the date of adoption of the amended FASB ASC 605-25, the Company continues to defer an amount of any initial fees received from the customer such that the aggregate of the fees deferred and the net present value of the future fixed initial and ongoing payments to be received from the customer equals the selling price of the IMAX digital theater system to be leased or acquired by the customer. Any residual portion of the initial fees received from the customer for the terminated theater system is recorded in other revenues at the time when the obligation for the original theater system is terminated and the new theater system arrangement is signed. Under the amended FASB ASC 605-25, for all arrangements entered into or materially modified after the date of adoption, the total arrangement consideration to be received is allocated on a relative selling price basis to the digital upgrade and the termination of the previous theater system. The arrangement consideration allocated to the termination of the existing arrangement is recorded in Other revenues at the time when the obligation for the original theater system is terminated and the new theater system arrangement is signed.

The Company may offer certain incentives to customers to complete theater system transactions including payment concessions or free services and products such as film licenses or 3D glasses. Reductions in, and deferral of, payments are taken into account in determining the sales price either by a direct reduction in the sales price or a reduction of payments to be discounted in accordance with the Leases or Interests Topic of the FASB ASC. Free products and services are accounted for as separate units of accounting. Other consideration given by the Company to customers are accounted for in accordance with the Revenue Recognition Topic of the FASB ASC.

Maintenance and Extended Warranty Services

Maintenance and extended warranty services may be provided under a multiple element arrangement or as a separately priced contract. Revenues related to these services are deferred and recognized on a straight-line basis over the contract period and are recognized in Services revenues. Maintenance and extended warranty services includes maintenance of the customer’s equipment and replacement parts. Under certain maintenance arrangements, maintenance services may include additional training services to the customer’s technicians. All costs associated with this maintenance and extended warranty program are expensed as incurred. A loss on maintenance and extended warranty services is recognized if the expected cost of providing the services under the contracts exceeds the related deferred revenue.

Film Production and IMAX DMR Services

In certain film arrangements, the Company produces a film financed by third parties whereby the third party retains the copyright and the Company obtains exclusive distribution rights. Under these arrangements, the Company is entitled to receive a fixed fee or to retain as a fee the excess of funding over cost of production (the “production fee”). The third parties receive a portion of the revenues received by the Company from distributing the film, which is charged to costs and expenses applicable to revenues-services. The production fees are deferred, and recognized as a reduction in the cost of the film based on the ratio of the Company’s distribution revenues recognized in the current period to the ultimate distribution revenues expected from the film. Film exploitation costs, including advertising and marketing totaled $3.3 million in 2012 (2011 — $3.8 million, 2010 — $2.1 million) and are recorded in costs and expenses applicable to revenues-services as incurred.

 

92


Table of Contents

Revenue from film production services where the Company does not hold the associated distribution rights are recognized in Services revenues when performance of the contractual service is complete, provided there is persuasive evidence of an agreement, the fee is fixed or determinable and collectibility is reasonably assured.

Revenues from digitally re-mastering (IMAX DMR) films where third parties own or hold the copyrights and the rights to distribute the film are derived in the form of processing fees and recoupments calculated as a percentage of box-office receipts generated from the re-mastered films. Processing fees are recognized as Services revenues when the performance of the related re-mastering service is completed provided there is persuasive evidence of an arrangement, the fee is fixed or determinable and collectibility is reasonably assured. Recoupments, calculated as a percentage of box-office receipts, are recognized as Services revenue when box-office receipts are reported by the third party that owns or holds the related film rights, provided collectibility is reasonably assured.

Losses on film production and IMAX DMR services are recognized as costs and expenses applicable to revenues-services in the period when it is determined that the Company’s estimate of total revenues to be realized by the Company will not exceed estimated total production costs to be expended on the film production and the cost of IMAX DMR services.

Film Distribution

Revenue from the licensing of films is recognized in Services revenues when persuasive evidence of a licensing arrangement exists, the film has been completed and delivered, the license period has begun, the fee is fixed or determinable and collectibility is reasonably assured. When license fees are based on a percentage of box-office receipts, revenue is recognized when box-office receipts are reported by exhibitors, provided collectibility is reasonably assured. Film exploitation costs, including advertising and marketing, totaled $1.5 million in 2012 (2011 — $1.9 million, 2010 — $0.7 million) and are recorded in costs and expenses applicable to revenues-services as incurred.

Film Post-Production Services

Revenues from post-production film services are recognized in Services revenues when performance of the contracted services is complete provided there is persuasive evidence of an arrangement, the fee is fixed or determinable and collectibility is reasonably assured.

Other

The Company recognizes revenue in Services revenues from its owned and operated theaters resulting from box-office ticket and concession sales as tickets are sold, films are shown and upon the sale of various concessions. The sales are cash or credit card transactions with theatergoers based on fixed prices per seat or per concession item.

In addition, the Company enters into commercial arrangements with third party theater owners resulting in the sharing of profits and losses which are recognized in Services revenues when reported by such theaters. The Company also provides management services to certain theaters and recognizes revenue over the term of such services.

Revenues on camera rentals are recognized in Rental revenues over the rental period.

Revenue from the sale of 3D glasses is recognized in Equipment and product sales revenue when the 3D glasses have been delivered to the customer.

Other service revenues are recognized in Service revenues when the performance of contracted services is complete.

(n) Research and Development

Research and development costs are expensed as incurred and primarily include projector and sound parts, labor, consulting fees, allocation of overheads and other related materials which pertain to the Company’s development of ongoing product and services. Research and development costs pertaining to fixed and intangible assets that have alternative future uses are capitalized and amortized under their related policies.

 

93


Table of Contents

(o) Foreign Currency Translation

Monetary assets and liabilities of the Company’s operations which are denominated in currencies other than the functional currency are translated into the functional currency at the exchange rates prevailing at the end of the period. Non-monetary items are translated at historical exchange rates. Revenue and expense transactions are translated at exchange rates prevalent at the transaction date. Such exchange gains and losses are included in the determination of earnings in the period in which they arise. The Company has determined that the functional currency of all its wholly-owned subsidiaries is the United States dollar.

Foreign currency derivatives are recognized and measured in the balance sheet at fair value. Changes in the fair value (gains or losses) are recognized in the consolidated statement of operations except for derivatives designated and qualifying as foreign currency hedging instruments. For foreign currency hedging instruments, the effective portion of the gain or loss in a hedge of a forecasted transaction is reported in other comprehensive income and reclassified to the consolidated statement of operations when the forecasted transaction occurs. Any ineffective portion is recognized immediately in the consolidated statement of operations.

(p) Stock-Based Compensation

The Company’s stock-based compensation is recognized in accordance with the FASB ASC Topic 505, “Equity” and Topic 718, “Compensation-Stock Compensation.”

The Company estimates the fair value of employee stock-based payment awards on the date of grant using fair value measurement techniques such as an option-pricing model. The value of the portion of the employee award that is ultimately expected to vest is recognized as expense over the requisite service periods in the Company’s consolidated statement of operations.

The Company utilizes a lattice-binomial option-pricing model (“Binomial Model”) to determine the fair value of stock-based payment awards. The fair value determined by the Binomial Model is affected by the Company’s stock price as well as assumptions regarding a number of highly complex and subjective variables. These variables include, but are not limited to, the Company’s expected stock price volatility over the term of the awards, and actual and projected employee stock option exercise behaviors. The Binomial Model also considers the expected exercise multiple which is the multiple of exercise price to grant price at which exercises are expected to occur on average. Option-pricing models were developed for use in estimating the value of traded options that have no vesting or hedging restrictions and are fully transferable. Because the Company’s employee stock options have certain characteristics that are significantly different from traded options, and because changes in the subjective assumptions can materially affect the estimated value, in management’s opinion, the Binomial Model best provides a fair measure of the fair value of the Company’s employee stock options. See note 15(c) for the assumptions used to determine the fair value of stock-based payment awards.

Stock-based compensation expense includes compensation cost for employee stock-based payment awards granted and all modified, repurchased or cancelled employee awards. In addition, compensation expense includes the compensation cost, based on the grant-date fair value calculated for pro forma disclosures under ASC 718-10-55, for the portion of awards for which required service had not been rendered that were outstanding. Compensation expense for these employee awards is recognized using the straight-line single-option method. As stock-based compensation expense recognized is based on awards ultimately expected to vest, it has been adjusted for estimated forfeitures. The Codification requires forfeitures to be estimated at the time of grant and revised, if subsequent information indicates that the actual forfeitures are likely to be different from previous estimates. The Company utilizes the market yield on U.S. treasury securities (also known as nominal rate) over the contractual term of the instrument being issued.

Stock Option Plan

As the Company stratifies its employees into homogeneous groups in order to calculate fair value under the Binomial Model, ranges of assumptions used are presented for expected option life and annual termination probability. The Company uses historical data to estimate option exercise and employee termination within the valuation model; various groups of employees that have similar historical exercise behavior are considered separately for valuation purposes. The expected volatility rate is estimated based on a blended volatility method which takes into consideration the Company’s historical share price volatility, the Company’s implied volatility which is implied by the observed current market prices of the Company’s traded options and the Company’s peer group volatility. The Company utilizes an expected term method to determine expected option life based on such data as vesting periods of awards, historical data that includes past exercise and post-vesting cancellations and stock price history.

The Company’s policy is to issue new shares from treasury to satisfy stock options which are exercised.

 

94


Table of Contents

Restricted Common Shares and Stock Appreciation Rights

The Company’s restricted common shares and SARs have been classified as liabilities in accordance with Topic 505. The Company utilizes the Binomial Model to determine the value of these instruments settleable in cash.

Awards to Non-Employees

Stock-based awards for services provided by non-employees are accounted for based on the fair value of the services received or the stock-based award, whichever is more reliably determinable. If the fair value of the stock-based award is used, the fair value is measured at the date of the award and remeasured until the earlier of the date that the Company has a performance commitment from the non-employees, the date performance is completed, or the date the awards vest.

(q) Pension Plans and Postretirement Benefits

The Company has a defined benefit pension plan, the Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (the “SERP”). As the Company’s SERP is unfunded, as at December 31, 2012, a liability is recognized for the projected benefit obligation.

Assumptions used in computing the defined benefit obligations are reviewed annually by management in consultation with its actuaries and adjusted for current conditions. Actuarial gains or losses and prior service costs or credits that arise during the period but are not recognized as components of net periodic benefits cost are recognized as a component of other comprehensive income. Amounts recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income including unrecognized actuarial gains or losses and prior service costs are adjusted as they are subsequently recognized in the consolidated statement of operations as components of net periodic benefit cost. Prior service costs resulting from the pension plan inception or amendments are amortized over the expected future service life of the employees, cumulative actuarial gains and losses in excess of 10% of the projected benefit obligation are amortized over the expected average remaining service life of the employees, and current service costs are expensed when earned. The remaining weighted average future service life of the employee used in computing the defined benefit obligation for the year ended December 31, 2012 was 2.0 years.

For defined contribution pension plans, required contributions by the Company are recorded as an expense.

A liability is recognized for the unfunded accumulated benefit obligation of the postretirement benefits plan. Assumptions used in computing the accumulated benefit obligation are reviewed by management in consultation with its actuaries and adjusted for current conditions. Current service cost is recognized as incurred and actuarial gains and losses are recognized as a component of other comprehensive income (loss). Amounts recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) including unrecognized actuarial gains or losses are adjusted as they are subsequently recognized in the consolidated statement of operations as components of net periodic benefit cost.

(r) Guarantees

The FASB ASC Guarantees Topic requires a guarantor to recognize, at the inception of a guarantee, a liability for the fair value of certain guarantees. Disclosures as required under the accounting guidance have been included in note 14(g).

3. New Accounting Standards and Accounting Changes

Changes in Accounting Policies

In May 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-04, “Fair Value Measurement (ASC Topic 820): Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements in U.S. GAAP and IFRSs” (“ASU 2011-04”). The standards set forth in ASU 2011-04 supersede most of the accounting guidance currently found in Topic 820 of the FASB’s ASC. The amendments will improve comparability of fair value measurements presented and disclosed in financial statements prepared with U.S. GAAP and International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”). The amendments also clarify the application of existing fair value measurement requirements. These amendments include (1) the application of the highest and best use and valuation premise concepts, (2) measuring the fair value of an instrument classified in a reporting entity’s shareholders’ equity and (3) disclosing quantitative information about the unobservable inputs used within the Level 3 hierarchy. For public entities, the amendments are effective for interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011 on a prospective basis. Early application by public entities is not permitted. On January 1, 2012, the Company adopted the disclosure requirements amendments in ASU 2011-04 relating to Level 3 fair value measurements and accordingly, has expanded disclosures as presented in note 21(b).

 

95


Table of Contents

In October 2012, The FASB issued ASU No. 2012-07, “Entertainment – Films (Topic 926): Accounting for Fair Value Information That Arises after the Measurement Date and Its Inclusion in the Impairment Analysis of Unamortized Film Costs” (“ASU 2012-07”). ASU 2012-07 eliminates the presumption that conditions leading to the write-off after the Balance Sheet date existed at the Balance Sheet date and also eliminates the requirement that changes to estimates due to consideration of a subsequent event are considered in the fair value measurements, unless the information would have been considered by the market participants. For public entities, the amendments are effective for impairment assessments performed on or after December 15, 2012 on a prospective basis. On December 31, 2012, the Company adopted the amendments in ASU 2012-07. No changes in the assessment of film costs or additional disclosures were required as a result of the adoption of ASU 2012-07.

Recently Issued FASB Accounting Standard Codification Updates

In December 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-11, “Balance Sheet—Disclosures about Offsetting Assets and Liabilities (ASC Topic 210)”. The purpose of the amendment is to provide greater clarity within disclosures between entities reporting in U.S. GAAP versus IFRS that have offsetting (netting) assets and liabilities. Entities will be required to disclose both gross information and net information about both instruments and transactions eligible for offset in the statement of financial position and instruments and transactions subject to an agreement similar to a master netting arrangement. An entity is required to apply the amendments in ASU 2011-11 for annual reporting periods beginning on or after January 1, 2013 and interim periods within those annual periods. It is to be applied retrospectively for all comparative periods presented. On January 1, 2013 the Company adopted the amended ASC 210 standard. The adoption of this standard is not expected to have a material impact however it may expand the Company’s disclosures in its condensed consolidated financial statements for the period ending March 31, 2013.

4. Revision of Previously Issued Financial Statements

During the fourth quarter review of the Company’s existing benefit packages, the Company determined that Canadian employees, upon meeting certain eligibility requirements, are entitled to postretirement health and welfare benefits for which the obligation had not been included in the prior financial statements as required under ASC Topic 715 “Compensation – Retirement Benefits”. The Company understated accrued and other liabilities and overstated shareholders’ equity as at December 31, 2011 by $4.1 million and $3.0 million, respectively. In accordance with the relevant guidance, management assessed the materiality of the error and concluded that the errors were not material to any previously issued financial statements. The Company has revised its previously issued audited consolidated financial statements, as applicable.

The following table presents the impact of the revisions on the Company’s previously issued audited consolidated balance sheet as at December 31, 2011(1):

 

(in thousands of U.S dollars, except per share amounts)    As Reported     As Revised  

Deferred income tax asset

   $ 50,033     $ 51,046  

Total assets

   $ 406,236     $ 407,249  

Accrued and other liabilities

   $ 54,803     $ 58,855  

Total liabilities

   $ 213,329     $ 217,381  

Deficit

   $ (125,666   $ (128,503

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

   $ (2,332   $ (2,534

Shareholders’ equity

   $ 192,907     $ 189,868  

 

(1) The net impact of the revision adjustments to shareholders’ equity (deficiency) as of January 1, 2010 and December 31, 2010, was a net increase of $2.9 million and $2.6 million, respectively.

The following table presents the impact of the revisions on the Company’s previously issued audited consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income for the years ended December 31:

 

96


Table of Contents
(in thousands of U.S dollars, except per share amounts)    2011     2010  
     As Reported     As Revised     As Reported     As Revised  

Selling, general and administrative expenses

   $ 72,779     $ 73,157     $ 78,428     $ 78,757  

Income from operations

   $ 28,492     $ 28,114     $ 50,974     $ 50,645  

Income from operations before income taxes

   $ 26,722     $ 26,344     $ 49,488     $ 49,159  

(Provision for) recovery of income taxes

   $ (9,388   $ (9,293   $ 51,784     $ 52,574  

Net income

   $ 15,543     $ 15,260     $ 100,779     $ 101,240  

Net income per share—basic

   $ 0.24     $ 0.24     $ 1.59     $ 1.59  

Net income per share—diluted

   $ 0.23     $ 0.22     $ 1.51     $ 1.52  

Other comprehensive loss

   $ (1,723   $ (1,957   $ (2,899   $ (3,136

Income tax recovery allocated to other comprehensive loss

   $ 388     $ 446     $ 996     $ 1,067  

Comprehensive income

   $ 14,208     $ 13,749     $ 98,876     $ 99,171  

Subsequent to year-end, the Company amended its Canadian postretirement plan, resulting in a significant curtailment of the benefit liability. See note 22(d) for further information.

5. Lease Arrangements

(a) General Terms of Lease Arrangements

A number of the Company’s leases are classified as sales-type leases. Certain arrangements that are legal sales are also classified as sales-type leases as certain clauses within the arrangements limit transfer of title or provide the Company with conditional rights to the system. The customer’s rights under the Company’s lease arrangements are described in note 2(m). The Company classifies its lease arrangements at inception of the arrangement and, if required, after a modification of the lease arrangement, to determine whether they are sales-type leases or operating leases. Under the Company’s lease arrangements, the customer has the ability and the right to operate the hardware components or direct others to operate them in a manner determined by the customer. The Company’s lease portfolio terms are typically non-cancellable for 10 to 20 years with renewal provisions from inception. Except for those sales arrangements that are classified as sales-type leases, the Company’s leases generally do not contain an automatic transfer of title at the end of the lease term. The Company’s lease arrangements do not contain a guarantee of residual value at the end of the lease term. The customer is required to pay for executory costs such as insurance and taxes and is required to pay the Company for maintenance and extended warranty generally after the first year of the lease until the end of the lease term. The customer is responsible for obtaining insurance coverage for the theater systems commencing on the date specified in the arrangement’s shipping terms and ending on the date the theater systems are delivered back to the Company.

The Company has assessed the nature of its joint revenue sharing arrangements and concluded that, based on the guidance in the Revenue Recognition Topic of the ASC, the arrangements contain a lease. Under joint revenue sharing arrangements, the customer has the ability and the right to operate the hardware components or direct others to operate them in a manner determined by the customer. The Company’s joint revenue sharing arrangements are typically non-cancellable for 7 to 10 years with renewal provisions. Title to equipment under joint revenue sharing arrangements does not transfer to the customer. The Company’s joint revenue sharing arrangements do not contain a guarantee of residual value at the end of the term. The customer is required to pay for executory costs such as insurance and taxes and is required to pay the Company for maintenance and extended warranty throughout the term. The customer is responsible for obtaining insurance coverage for the theater systems commencing on the date specified in the arrangement’s shipping terms and ending on the date the theater systems are delivered back to the Company.

 

97


Table of Contents

(b) Financing Receivables

Financing receivables, consisting of net investment in sales-type leases and receivables from financed sales of theater systems are as follows:

 

    As at December 31,  
    2012     2011  

Gross minimum lease payments receivable

  $ 18,880     $ 29,603  

Unearned finance income

    (4,705     (8,356
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Minimum lease payments receivable

    14,175       21,247  

Accumulated allowance for uncollectible amounts

    (1,130     (1,833
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net investment in leases

    13,045       19,414  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross financed sales receivables

    114,492       95,686  

Unearned finance income

    (33,278     (28,070
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financed sales receivables

    81,214       67,616  

Accumulated allowance for uncollectible amounts

    (66     (316
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net financed sales receivables

    81,148       67,300  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financing receivables

  $ 94,193     $ 86,714  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net financed sales receivables due within one year

  $ 10,482     $ 8,694  

Net financed sales receivables due after one year

  $ 70,666     $ 58,606  

In 2012, the financed sales receivables had a weighted average effective interest rate of 8.7% (2011 — 8.9%).

(c) Contingent Fees

Contingent fees that meet the Company’s revenue recognition policy, from customers under various arrangements, have been reported in revenue as follows:

 

    Years Ended December 31,  
    2012     2011     2010  

Sales

  $ 1,797     $ 976     $ 1,608  

Sales-type leases

    308       517       1,054  

Operating leases

    930       1,232       1,675  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subtotal—sales, sales-type leases and operating leases

    3,035       2,725       4,337  

Joint revenue sharing arrangements

    57,526       30,764       41,757  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  $ 60,561     $ 33,489     $ 46,094  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(d) Future Minimum Rental Payments

Future minimum rental payments receivable from operating and sales-type leases at December 31, 2012, for each of the next five years are as follows:

 

    Operating Leases     Sales-Type Leases  

2013

  $ 2,145     $ 3,087  

2014

    1,652       2,732  

2015

    1,309       2,475  

2016

    1,090       1,957  

2017

    1,031       1,550  

Thereafter

    4,698       5,460  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

  $ 11,925     $ 17,261  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total future minimum rental payments receivable from sales-type leases at December 31, 2012 exclude $1.6 million which represents amounts billed but not yet received.

 

98


Table of Contents

6. Inventories

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012      2011  

Raw materials

   $ 5,424      $ 5,803  

Work-in-process

     338        1,515  

Finished goods

     10,032        12,429  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 15,794      $ 19,747  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

At December 31, 2012, finished goods inventory for which title had passed to the customer and revenue was deferred amounted to $6.8 million (December 31, 2011 — $5.7 million).

Inventories at December 31, 2012 include provisions for excess and obsolete inventory based upon current estimates of net realizable value considering future events and conditions of $4.4 million (December 31, 2011 —$4.0 million).

7. Film Assets

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012      2011  

Completed and released films, net of accumulated amortization of $67,363 (2011 — $51,848)

   $ 2,959      $ 1,356  

Films in production

     380        639  

Films in development

     398        393  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 3,737      $ 2,388  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Company expects to amortize film costs of $3.0 million for released films within five years from December 31, 2012 (December 31, 2011 — $2.2 million), included is $2.4 million which reflects the portion of the costs of the Company’s completed films that are expected to be amortized within the next year. The amount of participation payments to third parties related to these films that the Company expects to pay during 2013 is $5.8 million (2012 — $6.4 million).

 

99


Table of Contents

8. Property, Plant and Equipment

 

     As at December 31, 2012  
     Cost      Accumulated
Depreciation
     Net Book
Value
 

Equipment leased or held for use

        

Theater system components(1)(2)

   $ 131,240      $ 39,140      $ 92,100  

Camera equipment(5)

     4,668        4,306        362  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     135,908        43,446        92,462  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Assets under construction(3)

     6,910        —          6,910  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other property, plant and equipment

        

Land

     1,593        —          1,593  

Buildings

     15,242        9,864        5,378  

Office and production equipment(4)

     25,777        19,779        5,998  

Leasehold improvements

     9,734        8,465        1,269  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     52,346        38,108        14,238  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 195,164      $ 81,554      $ 113,610  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     As at December 31, 2011  
     Cost      Accumulated
Depreciation
     Net Book
Value
 

Equipment leased or held for use

        

Theater system components(1)(2)

   $ 122,691      $ 39,773      $ 82,918  

Camera equipment(5)

     6,355        6,088        267  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     129,046        45,861        83,185  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Assets under construction(3)

     4,972        —          4,972  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other property, plant and equipment

        

Land

     1,593        —          1,593  

Buildings

     14,633        9,352        5,281  

Office and production equipment(4)

     29,220        24,772        4,448  

Leasehold improvements

     9,396        7,622        1,774  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     54,842        41,746        13,096  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 188,860      $ 87,607      $ 101,253  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) Included in theater system components are assets with costs of $8.1 million (2011 — $18.4 million) and accumulated depreciation of $7.3 million (2011 — $17.8 million) that are leased to customers under operating leases. In 2012, the Company identified and wrote off $10.6 million of theater system components that are no longer in use and fully amortized.
(2) Included in theater system components are assets with costs of $118.5 million (2011 — $100.2 million) and accumulated depreciation of $29.2 million (2011 — $19.1 million) that are used in joint revenue sharing arrangements.
(3) Included in assets under construction are components with costs of $4.1 million (2011 — $3.7 million) that will be utilized to construct assets to be used in joint revenue sharing arrangements.
(4) Fully amortized office and production equipment is still in use by the Company.
(5) Fully amortized camera equipment is still in use by the Company. In 2012, the Company identified and wrote off $1.9 million of camera equipment that is no longer in use and fully amortized.

 

100


Table of Contents

9. Other Assets

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012      2011  

Insurance recoverable (note 14(d))

   $ 11,474      $ 918  

Lease incentives provided to theaters

     4,554        4,285  

Equity-accounted investments

     3,074        4,055  

Commissions and other deferred selling expenses

     2,645        2,967  

Investment in new business ventures

     1,350        1,012  

Deferred charges on debt financing

     569        1,001  

Foreign currency derivatives

     297        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 23,963      $ 14,238  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

10. Income Taxes

(a) Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes by tax jurisdiction are comprised of the following:

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012     2011     2010  
           As Revised     As Revised  

Canada

   $ 55,477     $ 23,023     $ 47,625  

United States

     2,636       8,655       2,088  

China

     (476     (5,722     —    

Other

     141       388       (554
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 57,778     $ 26,344     $ 49,159  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(b) The (provision) recovery for income taxes related to income from continuing operations is comprised of the following:

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012     2011     2010  
           As Revised     As Revised  

Current:

      

Canada

   $ (370   $ (1,174   $ (1,026

Foreign

     15       (125     (1,465
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (355     (1,299     (2,491
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred:(1)

      

Canada

     (14,441     (8,586     50,401  

Foreign

     (283     592       4,664  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     (14,724     (7,994     55,065  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ (15,079   $ (9,293   $ 52,574  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) For the year ended December 31, 2012, the Company has increased the valuation allowance by $0.1 million (2011 — release of $1.9 million) relating to the future utilization of deductible temporary differences, tax credits, and certain net operating loss carryforwards, of which less than $0.1 million was recorded to deferred income tax expense and less than $0.1 million was recorded to share capital. Also included in the provision for income taxes is the deferred tax related to the amortization of the defined benefit plan actuarial loss and realized foreign exchange gains and losses on effectively hedged forward contracts reclassified from other comprehensive income in the year of less than $0.1 million.

 

101


Table of Contents

(c) The (provision for) recovery of income taxes from continuing operations differs from the amount that would have resulted by applying the combined Canadian federal and provincial statutory income tax rates to earnings due to the following:

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012     2011     2010  
           As Revised     As Revised  

Income tax provision at combined statutory rates

   $ (15,311   $ (7,442   $ (15,241

Adjustments resulting from:

      

Non-deductible stock based compensation

     (3,166     (2,752     (1,713

Other non-deductible/non-includable items

     12       (246     420  

(Increase) decrease in valuation allowance relating to current year temporary differences

     (93     1,264       12,708  

Decrease in valuation allowance relating to reversal of future temporary differences

     —         —         55,512  

Tax effect of pension settlement and postretirement plan reclassified from other comprehensive income

     —         —         (528

Withholding and other taxes

     (1,095     (895     (1,041

Changes to tax reserves

     833       99       13  

U.S. federal and state taxes

     45       (345     (1,465

Income tax at different rates in foreign and other provincial jurisdictions

     (56     (916     (394

Impact of changes in future enacted tax rates on current year temporary differences

     —         (521     4,444  

Carryforward of investment and other tax credits (non-refundable)

     2,463       1,526       1,642  

Effect of changes in legislation relating to enacted tax rate increases

     494       —         —    

Changes to deferred tax assets and liabilities resulting from audit and other tax return adjustments

     483       226       14  

Expiration of losses and credits carried forward

     —         —         (1,558

Tax effect of loss from equity-accounted investments

     463       642       168  

Other

     (151     67       (407
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(Provision for) recovery of income taxes, as reported

   $ (15,079   $ (9,293   $ 52,574  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(d) The net deferred income tax asset is comprised of the following:

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012     2011  
           As Revised  

Net operating loss carryforwards

   $ 15,475     $ 16,787  

Investment tax credit and other tax credit carryforwards

     6,101       5,192  

Write-downs of other assets

     690       712  

Excess tax over accounting basis in property, plant and equipment and inventories

     14,020       29,897  

Accrued pension liability

     6,615       5,813  

Other accrued reserves

     2,340       2,706  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred income tax assets

     45,241       61,107  

Income recognition on net investment in leases

     (2,667     (4,022

Other

     —         15  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     42,574       57,100  

Valuation allowance

     (6,113     (6,054
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net deferred income tax asset

   $ 36,461     $ 51,046  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

102


Table of Contents

The gross deferred tax assets include a liability of $0.4 million relating to the remaining tax effect resulting from the Company’s defined benefit pension plan, the related actuarial gains and losses, unrealized net gains on cash flow hedging instruments and the unrealized change in market value of available-for-sale investments recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income.

The Company has not provided Canadian taxes on cumulative earnings of non-Canadian affiliates and associated companies that have been reinvested indefinitely. Taxes are provided for earnings of non-Canadian affiliates and associated companies when the Company determines that such earnings are no longer indefinitely reinvested.

(e) Estimated net operating loss carryforwards and estimated tax credit carryforwards expire as follows:

 

     Investment Tax
Credits and
Other

Tax Credit
Carryforwards
     Net Operating
Loss
Carryforwards
 

2013

   $ 17      $ —    

2014

     —          11  

2015

     —          20  

2016

     —          —    

2017

     —          —    

Thereafter

     7,897        51,454  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 7,914      $ 51,485  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Estimated net operating loss carryforwards can be carried forward to reduce taxable income through to 2032. Investment tax credits and other tax credits can be carried forward to reduce income taxes payable through to 2032.

As at December 31, 2012, the Company had approximately $14.8 million of U.S. consolidated federal tax net operating loss carryforwards and certain other state tax net loss carryforwards. Realization of some or all of the benefit from these U.S. net tax operating losses is dependent on the absence of certain “ownership changes” of the Company’s common shares. An “ownership change,” as defined in the applicable federal income tax rules, would place possible limitations, on an annual basis, on the use of such net operating losses to offset any future taxable income that the Company may generate. Such limitations, in conjunction with the net operating loss expiration provisions, could significantly reduce or effectively eliminate the Company’s ability to use its U.S. net operating losses to offset any future taxable income.

(f) Valuation allowance

The provision for income taxes in the year ended December 31, 2012 includes a net income tax provision of $0.1 million (2011—$1.3 million net income tax benefit) in continuing operations related to an increase in the valuation allowance for the Company’s deferred tax assets and other tax adjustments. In 2012, the Company added an additional $0.1 million in valuation allowance relating to the current period deductible temporary differences and loss carryforwards, of which less than $0.1 million was included in the provision for income taxes and less than $0.1 million, was included directly to shareholders’ equity. During the year ended December 31, 2012, after considering all available evidence, both positive (including recent profits, projected future profitability, backlog, carryforward periods for utilization of net operating loss carryovers and tax credits, discretionary deductions and other factors) and negative (including cumulative losses in past years and other factors), it was concluded that the valuation allowance against the Company’s deferred tax assets should be increased by approximately $0.1 million (2011—$1.9 million decrease). The remaining $6.1 million (2011—$6.1 million) balance in the valuation allowance as at December 31, 2012 is primarily attributable to certain U.S. federal and state net operating loss carryovers and federal tax credits that are likely to expire unutilized. If the remaining $14.8 million in U.S. consolidated federal tax net operating loss carryforwards are realized in a future period, the related $5.1 million valuation allowance release will be recorded against Other Equity. As at December 31, 2010, the Company had determined that based on the improvement of the Company’s operating results in 2009 and 2010 and the Company’s assessment of projected future results of operations, realization of a deferred income tax benefit was more likely than not. As a result, the judgment about the need for a full valuation allowance against deferred tax assets changed, and a reduction in the valuation allowance of $55.5 million was recorded as a benefit within the recovery for income taxes from continuing operations.

 

103


Table of Contents

(g) Uncertain tax positions

In connection with the Company’s adoption of FIN 48, as of January 1, 2007, the Company recorded a net increase to its deficit of $2.1 million (including approximately $0.9 million related to accrued interest and penalties) related to the measurement of potential international withholding tax requirements and a decrease in reserves for income taxes. As at December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011, the Company had total unrecognized tax benefits (including interest and penalties) of $2.8 million and $4.4 million, respectively, for international withholding taxes. All of the unrecognized tax benefits could impact the Company’s effective tax rate if recognized. While the Company believes it has adequately provided for all tax positions, amounts asserted by taxing authorities could differ from the Company’s accrued position. Accordingly, additional provisions on federal, provincial, state and foreign tax-related matters could be recorded in the future as revised estimates are made or the underlying matters are settled or otherwise resolved.

A reconciliation of the beginning and ending amount of unrecognized tax benefits (excluding interest and penalties) for the years ended December 31, is as follows:

 

(In thousands of U.S. Dollars)   2012     2011     2010  

Balance at beginning of the year

  $ 3,119     $ 3,219     $ 3,237  

Additions based on tax positions related to the current year

    392       404       410  

Additions for tax positions of prior years

    —         16       —    

Reductions for tax positions of prior years

    (77     —         (10

Settlements

    (38     —         —    

Reductions resulting from lapse of applicable statute of limitations and administrative practices

    (1,110     (520     (418
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at the end of the year

  $ 2,286     $ 3,119     $ 3,219  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Consistent with its historical financial reporting, the Company has elected to classify interest and penalties related to income tax liabilities, when applicable, as part of the interest expense in its consolidated statements of operations rather than income tax expense. The Company recovered approximately $0.8 million in potential interest and penalties associated with unrecognized tax benefits for the years ended December 31, 2012 (2011—$0.1 million expense, 2010—$nil).

The number of years with open tax audits varies depending on the tax jurisdiction. The Company’s major taxing jurisdictions include Canada, the province of Ontario, the United States (including multiple states) and China.

The Company’s 2007 through 2012 tax years remain subject to examination by the IRS for U.S. federal tax purposes, and the 2006 through 2012 tax years remain subject to examination by the appropriate governmental agencies for Canadian federal tax purposes. There are other on-going audits in various other jurisdictions that are not material to the financial statements.

(h) Income Tax Effect on Comprehensive Income

The income tax benefit (expense) related to the following items included in other comprehensive income are:

 

     2012     2011     2010  
           As Revised     As Revised  

Amortization of actuarial loss on defined benefit plan

   $ (91   $ (53   $ —    

Unrecognized actuarial loss on defined benefit plan

     285       145       661  

Realization of actuarial gain on settlement of defined benefit pension liability

     —         —         517  

Unrecognized actuarial loss on postretirement benefit plan

     33       58       71  

Other-than-temporary impairment of available-for-sale investment

     (19     —         —    

Change in market value of available-for-sale investment

     (42     61       —    

Unrealized change in cash flow hedging instruments

     (185     45       (182

Realized change in cash flow hedging instruments upon settlement

     62       190       —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 43     $ 446     $ 1,067  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

104


Table of Contents

11. Other Intangible Assets

 

     As at December 31, 2012  
     Cost      Accumulated
Amortization
     Net Book
Value
 

Patents and trademarks

   $ 8,499      $ 5,670      $ 2,829  

Licenses and intellectual property

     19,790        1,730        18,060  

Other

     7,022        —          7,022  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 35,311      $ 7,400      $ 27,911  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     As at December 31, 2011  
     Cost      Accumulated
Amortization
     Net Book
Value
 

Patents and trademarks

   $ 8,014      $ 5,304      $ 2,710  

Licenses and intellectual property

     19,407        254        19,153  

Other

     3,050        —          3,050  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 30,471      $ 5,558      $ 24,913  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Company expects to amortize an average of $2.0 million for each of the next 5 years, respectively. Fully amortized other intangible assets are still in use by the Company.

During 2012, the Company acquired $5.0 million in other intangible assets, which is comprised mainly of the Company’s investment in a new enterprise resource planning system, which will commence being amortized upon commissioning on January 1, 2013. The net book value of these other intangible assets was $4.8 million as at December 31, 2012. The weighted average amortization period for these additions was 10 years.

During 2012, the Company incurred costs of $0.1 million to renew or extend the term of acquired patents and trademarks which were recorded in selling, general and administrative expenses (2011 — $0.1 million).

12. Credit Facility

Prior Credit Facility

On June 2, 2011, the Company amended and restated the terms of its senior secured credit facility, which had been scheduled to mature on October 31, 2013. The Company’s amended and restated facility (the “Prior Credit Facility”), with a scheduled maturity of October 31, 2015, had a maximum borrowing capacity of $110.0 million, consisting of revolving asset-based loans of up to $50.0 million subject to a borrowing base calculation (as described below) and including a sublimit of $20.0 million for letters of credit, and a revolving term loan of up to $60.0 million. Certain of the Company’s subsidiaries serve as guarantors (the “Guarantors”) of the Company’s obligations under the Prior Credit Facility. The Prior Credit Facility was collateralized by a first priority security interest in substantially all of the present and future assets of the Company and the Guarantors.

The terms of the Prior Credit Facility was set forth in the Second Amended and Restated Credit Agreement (the “Prior Credit Agreement”), dated June 2, 2011, among the Company, Wells Fargo Capital Finance Corporation (Canada), as agent, lender, sole lead arranger and sole bookrunner (“Wells Fargo Canada”), and Export Development Canada, as lender (“EDC”, together with Wells Fargo Canada, the “Prior Lenders”) and in various collateral and security documents entered into by the Company and the Guarantors. Each of the Guarantors also entered into a guarantee in respect of the Company’s obligations under the Prior Credit Facility.

The revolving asset-based portion of the Prior Credit Facility permitted maximum aggregate borrowings equal to the lesser of:

(i) $50.0 million, and

(ii) a collateral calculation based on the percentages of the book values of certain of the Company’s net investment in sales-type leases, financing receivables, certain trade accounts receivable, finished goods inventory allocated to backlog contracts and the appraised values of the expected future cash flows related to operating leases and the Company’s owned real property, reduced by certain accruals and accounts payable and subject to other conditions, limitations and reserve right requirements.

 

105


Table of Contents

The revolving asset-based portion and the revolving term portion of the Prior Credit Facility bore interest, at the Company’s option, at (i) LIBOR plus a margin of 2.00% per annum, or (ii) Wells Fargo Canada’s prime rate plus a margin of 0.50% per annum. Under the Prior Credit Facility, the effective interest rate for the year ended December 31, 2012 for the revolving term loan portion was 2.42% (2011 – 2.50%). There was no amount drawn on the revolving asset-based portion of the Prior Credit Facility.

The Prior Credit Facility provides that the Company will be required to maintain a ratio of funded debt (as defined in the Prior Credit Agreement) to EBITDA (as defined in the Prior Credit Agreement) of not more than 2:1. The Company will also be required to maintain a Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio (as defined in the Prior Credit Agreement) of not less than 1.1:1.0. At all times under the terms of the Prior Credit Facility, the Company was required to maintain minimum Excess Availability of not less than $5.0 million and minimum Cash and Excess Availability of not less than $15.0 million. These amounts were $55.0 million and $76.3 million at December 31, 2012, respectively. The Company was in compliance with all of these requirements at December 31, 2012.

The Prior Credit Facility contained typical affirmative and negative covenants, including covenants that limit or restrict the ability of the Company and the Guarantors to: incur certain additional indebtedness; make certain loans, investments or guarantees; pay dividends; make certain asset sales; incur certain liens or other encumbrances; conduct certain transactions with affiliates and enter into certain corporate transactions.

The Prior Credit Facility also contained customary events of default, including upon an acquisition or change of control or upon a change in the business and assets of the Company or a Guarantor that in each case is reasonably expected to have a material adverse effect on the Company or Guarantor. If an event of default occurs and is continuing under the Prior Credit Facility, the Prior Lenders may, among other things, terminate their commitments and require immediate repayment of all amounts owed by the Company.

Bank indebtedness includes the following:

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012      2011  

Revolving Term Loan

   $ 11,000      $ 55,083  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total amounts drawn and available under the Prior Credit Facility at December 31, 2012 were $11.0 million and $99.0 million, respectively (December 31, 2011 — $55.1 million and $52.0 million, respectively).

At December 31, 2012, the Company’s current borrowing capacity under the revolving asset-based portion of the Prior Credit Facility was $50.0 million after deduction for letters of credit of $nil and the minimum Excess Availability reserve of $5.0 million (December 31, 2011 — $47.1 million) and borrowing capacity under the revolving term portion of the Prior Credit Facility was $49.0 million (December 31, 2011 — $4.9 million).

As at December 31, 2012, the Company did not have any letters of credit and advance payment guarantees outstanding (December 31, 2011 — $3.0 million), under the Prior Credit Facility.

In accordance with the loan agreement, the Company is obligated to make payments on the principal of the term loan as follows:

 

2013

   $ —    

2014

     —    

2015

     11,000  

2016

     —    

2017

     —    

Thereafter

     —    
  

 

 

 
   $ 11,000  
  

 

 

 

New Credit Facility

On February 7, 2013, the Company amended and restated the terms of its Prior Credit Facility. The amended and restated facility (the “New Credit Facility”), with a scheduled maturity of February 7, 2018, has a maximum borrowing capacity of $200.0 million. The Prior Credit Facility had a maximum borrowing capacity of $110.0 million. Certain of the Company’s subsidiaries will serve as

 

106


Table of Contents

guarantors (the “Guarantors”) of the Company’s obligations under the New Credit Facility. The New Credit Facility is collateralized by a first priority security interest in substantially all of the present and future assets of the Company and the Guarantors.

The terms of the New Credit Facility are set forth in the Third Amended and Restated Credit Agreement (the “Credit Agreement”), dated February 7, 2013, among the Company, the Guarantors, the lenders named therein, Wells Fargo Bank, National Association (“Wells Fargo”), as agent and issuing lender (Wells Fargo, together with the lenders named therein, the “Lenders”) and Wells Fargo Securities, LLC, as Sole Lead Arranger and Sole Bookrunner and in various collateral and security documents entered into by the Company and the Guarantors. Each of the Guarantors has also entered into a guarantee in respect of the Company’s obligations under the New Credit Facility.

The New Credit Facility permits the Company to undertake up to $150.0 million in stock buybacks and dividends, provided certain covenants in the Credit Agreement are maintained. In the event that the Company undertakes stock buybacks or makes dividend payments, any amounts outstanding under the revolving portion of the New Credit Facility up to the first $75.0 million of any such stock buybacks and dividend payments will be converted to a term loan.

At closing, the Company borrowed $18.0 million from the New Credit Facility to repay outstanding indebtedness under the Prior Credit Facility and to pay fees and closing costs related to entry into the New Credit Facility.

The amounts outstanding under the New Credit Facility bear interest, at the Company’s option, at (i) LIBOR plus a margin of (a) 1.50%, 1.75% or 2.00% depending on the Company’s Total Leverage Ratio (as defined in the Credit Agreement) per annum, or (ii) Wells Fargo’s prime rate plus a margin of 0.50% per annum. Term loans, if any, under the New Credit Facility must be repaid under a 5-year straight line amortization, with a balloon payment due at maturity. The Company is required to provide an interest rate hedge for 50% of any term loans outstanding.

The New Credit Facility provides that the Company will be required to maintain a Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio (as defined in the Credit Agreement) of not less than 1.1:1.0. The Company will also be required to maintain minimum EBITDA (as defined in the Credit Agreement) of $70.0 million between closing and December 30, 2013, which requirement increases to $80.0 million on December 31, 2013, $90.0 million on December 31, 2014, and $100.0 million on December 31, 2015. The Company must also maintain a Maximum Total Leverage Ratio (as defined in the Credit Agreement) of 2.5:1.0 between closing and December 30, 2013, which requirement decreases to (i) 2.25:1.0 on December 31, 2013; (ii) 2.00:1:0 on December 31, 2014; and (iii) 1.75:1.0 on December 31, 2015.

The New Credit Facility contains typical affirmative and negative covenants, including covenants that limit or restrict the ability of the Company and the guarantors to: incur certain additional indebtedness; make certain loans, investments or guarantees; pay dividends; make certain asset sales; incur certain liens or other encumbrances; conduct certain transactions with affiliates and enter into certain corporate transactions.

The New Credit Facility also contains customary events of default, including upon an acquisition or change of control or upon a change in the business and assets of the Company or a Guarantor that in each case is reasonably expected to have a material adverse effect on the Company or a Guarantor. If an event of default occurs and is continuing under the New Credit Facility, the Lenders may, among other things, terminate their commitments and require immediate repayment of all amounts owed by the Company.

Wells Fargo Foreign Exchange Facility

Under the New Credit Facility, the Company is able to purchase foreign currency forward contracts and/or other swap arrangements. There is no settlement risk on its foreign currency forward contracts at December 31, 2012 as the fair value exceeded the notional value of the forward contracts. As at December 31, 2012, the Company has $8.1 million of such arrangements outstanding.

Bank of Montreal Facilities

As at December 31, 2012, the Company has available a $10.0 million facility (December 31, 2011 — $10.0 million) with the Bank of Montreal for use solely in conjunction with the issuance of performance guarantees and letters of credit fully insured by EDC (the “Bank of Montreal Facility”). As at December 31, 2012, the Company has letters of credit and advance payment guarantees outstanding of $0.9 million (2011 — $0.8 million) under the Bank of Montreal Facility.

 

107


Table of Contents

13. Commitments

(a) The Company’s lease commitments consist of rent and equipment under operating leases. The Company accounts for any incentives provided over the term of the lease. Total minimum annual rental payments to be made by the Company as at December 31, 2012 for each of the years ended December 31, are as follows:

 

     Operating Leases          Capital Leases      

2013

   $ 6,931      $ 20  

2014

     5,142        —    

2015

     1,177        —    

2016

     511        —    

2017

     511        —    

Thereafter

     813        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 15,085      $ 20  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Rent expense was $6.2 million for 2012 (2011 — $4.9 million, 2010 — $4.8 million) net of sublease rental of $nil (2011 — less than $0.1 million, 2010 — $0.4 million).

Recorded in the accrued liabilities balance as at December 31, 2012 is $2.4 million (December 31, 2011 — $3.5 million) related to accrued rent and lease inducements being recognized as an offset to rent expense over the term of the respective leases.

Purchase obligations under long-term supplier contracts as at December 31, 2012 were $12.1 million (December 31, 2011 — $12.9 million).

(b) As at December 31, 2012 the Company did not have any letters of credit and advance payment guarantees outstanding (December 31, 2011 — $3.0 million), under the Prior Credit Facility. As at December 31, 2012 the Company had letters of credit and advance payment guarantees outstanding of $0.9 million as compared to $0.8 million as at December 31, 2011, under the Bank of Montreal Facility.

(c) The Company compensates its sales force with both fixed and variable compensation. Commissions on the sale or lease of the Company’s theater systems are payable in graduated amounts from the time of collection of the customer’s first payment to the Company up to the collection of the customer’s last initial payment. At December 31, 2012, $1.8 million (December 31, 2011—$1.3 million) of commissions have been accrued and will be payable in future periods.

 

108


Table of Contents

14. Contingencies and Guarantees

The Company is involved in lawsuits, claims, and proceedings, including those identified below, which arise in the ordinary course of business. In accordance with the Contingencies Topic of the FASB ASC, the Company will make a provision for a liability when it is both probable that a loss has been incurred and the amount of the loss can be reasonably estimated. The Company believes it has adequate provisions for any such matters. The Company reviews these provisions in conjunction with any related provisions on assets related to the claims at least quarterly and adjusts these provisions to reflect the impacts of negotiations, settlements, rulings, advice of legal counsel and other pertinent information related to the case. Should developments in any of these matters outlined below cause a change in the Company’s determination as to an unfavorable outcome and result in the need to recognize a material provision, or, should any of these matters result in a final adverse judgment or be settled for significant amounts, they could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations, cash flows, and financial position in the period or periods in which such a change in determination, settlement or judgment occurs.

The Company expenses legal costs relating to its lawsuits, claims and proceedings as incurred.

(a) In March 2005, the Company, together with Three-Dimensional Media Group, Ltd. (“3DMG”), filed a complaint in the U.S. District Court for the Central District of California, Western Division, against In-Three, Inc. (“In-Three”) alleging patent infringement. On March 10, 2006, the Company and In-Three entered into a settlement agreement settling the dispute between the Company and In-Three. Despite the settlement reached between the Company and In-Three, co-plaintiff 3DMG refused to dismiss its claims against In-Three. Accordingly, the Company and In-Three moved jointly for a motion to dismiss the Company’s and In-Three’s claims. On August 24, 2010, the Court dismissed all of the claims pending between the Company and In-Three, thus dismissing the Company from the litigation.

On May 15, 2006, the Company initiated arbitration against 3DMG before the International Centre for Dispute Resolution in New York (the “ICDR”), alleging breaches of the license and consulting agreements between the Company and 3DMG. On June 15, 2006, 3DMG filed an answer denying any breaches and asserting counterclaims that the Company breached the parties’ license agreement. On June 21, 2007, the ICDR unanimously denied 3DMG’s Motion for Summary Judgment filed on April 11, 2007 concerning the Company’s claims and 3DMG’s counterclaims. The proceeding was suspended on May 4, 2009 due to failure of 3DMG to pay fees associated with the proceeding. The proceeding was further suspended on October 11, 2010 pending resolution of reexamination proceedings currently pending involving one of 3DMG’s patents. The Company will continue to pursue its claims vigorously and believes that all allegations made by 3DMG are without merit. The Company further believes that the amount of loss, if any, suffered in connection with the counterclaims would not have a material impact on the financial position or results of operations of the Company, although no assurance can be given with respect to the ultimate outcome of the arbitration.

(b) In January 2004, the Company and IMAX Theatre Services Ltd., a subsidiary of the Company, commenced an arbitration seeking damages before the International Court of Arbitration of the International Chambers of Commerce (the “ICC”) with respect to the breach by Electronic Media Limited (“EML”) of its December 2000 agreement with the Company. In June 2004, the Company commenced a related arbitration before the ICC against EML’s affiliate, E-City Entertainment (I) PVT Limited (“E-City”), seeking damages as a result of E-City’s breach of a September 2000 lease agreement. An arbitration hearing took place in November 2005 against E-City which considered all claims by the Company. On February 1, 2006, the ICC issued an award on liability finding unanimously in the Company’s favor on all claims. Further hearings took place in July 2006 and December 2006. On August 24, 2007, the ICC issued an award unanimously in favor of the Company in the amount of $9.4 million, consisting of past and future rents owed to the Company under its lease agreements, plus interest and costs. In the award, the ICC upheld the validity and enforceability of the Company’s theater system contract. The Company thereafter submitted its application to the arbitration panel for interest and costs. On March 27, 2008, the arbitration panel issued a final award in favor of the Company in the amount of $11.3 million, plus an additional $2,512 each day in interest from October 1, 2007 until the date the award is paid, which the Company is seeking to enforce and collect in full. In July 2008, E-City commenced a proceeding in Mumbai, India seeking an order that the ICC award may not be recognized in India. The Company has opposed that application on a number of grounds and seeks to have the ICC award recognized in India. That Mumbai proceeding is still pending. On June 24, 2011, the Company commenced an application to the Ontario Superior Court of Justice for recognition of the final award. On December 2, 2011, the Ontario court issued an order recognizing the final award and requiring E-City to pay the Company $30,000 to cover the costs of the application. On January 18, 2012, the Company filed an application in New York State Supreme Court seeking recognition of the Ontario order in New York. On April 11, 2012, the New York court issued an order granting the Company’s application leading to an entry of $15.5 million judgment in favor of the Company on May 4, 2012. On January 30, 2013, the Company filed an action in the New York Supreme Court seeking to collect the amount due under the New York judgment from certain entities and individuals affiliated with E-City.

 

109


Table of Contents

(c) In June 2003, Robots of Mars, Inc. (“Robots”) initiated an arbitration proceeding against the Company in California with the American Arbitration Association pursuant to arbitration provisions in two film production agreements entered into in 1994 and 1995 between Robots’ predecessor-in-interest and a discontinued subsidiary of the Company (“Ridefilm”), asserting claims for breach of contract, fraud, breach of fiduciary duty and intentional interference with the contract. The Company discontinued its Ridefilm business through a sale of the Ridefilm business and its assets to a third party in March 2001. Robots sought an award of over $5.0 million in damages including contingent compensation that it claims was owed under two production agreements, damages for tort claims, and punitive damages. The arbitration hearings of this matter occurred in June and October 2009. The arbitrator issued a final award on March 16, 2011, awarding Robots $0.4 million in damages and $0.3 million in pre-judgment interest to date on its claim for breach of one of the Ridefilm production agreements. The arbitrator found in the Company’s favor on Robots’ tort claims, and awarded Robots no damages on its claim for breach of the second production agreement. Despite finding in the Company’s favor on the vast majority of Robots’ claims, the arbitrator awarded Robots $1.2 million in attorneys’ fees and costs pursuant to the attorneys’ fee provision set forth in the production agreements. Robots initiated two separate proceedings in California and in Ontario, Canada, to confirm the award. On July 13, 2011, a California district court granted Robots’ petition to confirm the award, and denied the Company’s petition to vacate the award. On August 18, 2011, the Company appealed the district court’s denial of its petition to vacate to the United States Court of Appeals for the Ninth Circuit. On January 12, 2012, the Company, Ridefilm and Robots entered into a confidential settlement agreement, pursuant to which the parties fully and finally resolved and settled all claims between them relating to this dispute. The Company dismissed the Ninth Circuit appeal on January 27, 2012, and the parties filed their respective Notices of Abandonment of the Ontario proceedings with the court of February 17, 2012, resulting in a dismissal of those proceedings.

(d) The Company and certain of its officers and directors were named as defendants in eight purported class action lawsuits filed between August 11, 2006 and September 18, 2006, alleging violations of U.S. federal securities laws. These eight actions were filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York. On January 18, 2007, the Court consolidated all eight class action lawsuits and appointed Westchester Capital Management, Inc. as the lead plaintiff and Abbey Spanier Rodd & Abrams, LLP as lead plaintiff’s counsel. On October 2, 2007, plaintiffs filed a consolidated amended class action complaint. The amended complaint, brought on behalf of shareholders who purchased the Company’s common stock on the NASDAQ between February 27, 2003 and July 20, 2007 (the “U.S. Class”), alleges primarily that the defendants engaged in securities fraud by disseminating materially false and misleading statements during the class period regarding the Company’s revenue recognition of theater system installations, and failing to disclose material information concerning the Company’s revenue recognition practices. The amended complaint also added PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, the Company’s auditors, as a defendant. On April 14, 2011, the Court issued an order appointing The Merger Fund as the lead plantiff and Abbey Spanier Rodd & Abrams, LLP as lead plantiff’s counsel. On November 2, 2011, the parties entered into a memorandum of understanding containing the terms and conditions of a settlement of this action. On January 26, 2012, the parties executed and filed with the Court a formal stipulation of settlement and proposed form of notice to the class, which the Court preliminarily approved on February 1, 2012. Under the terms of the settlement, members of the U.S. Class who did not opt out of the settlement will release defendants from liability for all claims that were alleged in this action or could have been alleged in this action or any other proceeding (including the action in Canada as described in (e) of this note (the “Canadian Action”)) relating to the purchase of IMAX securities on the NASDAQ from February 27, 2003 and July 20, 2007 or the subject matter and facts relating to this action. As part of the settlement and in exchange for the release, defendants will pay $12.0 million to a settlement fund which amount will be funded by the carriers of the Company’s directors and officers insurance policy and by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP. On March 26, 2012, the parties executed and filed with the Court an amended formal stipulation of settlement and proposed form of notice to the class, which the court preliminarily approved on March 28, 2012. On June 20, 2012, the court issued an order granting final approval of the settlement. The settlement is conditioned on the Company’s receipt of an order from the court in the Canadian Action excluding from the class in the Canadian Action every member of the class in both actions who has not opted out of the U.S. settlement. The hearing on the motion for the order from the court in the Canadian Action occurred on July 30, 2012 and a decision from the court is pending.

(e) A class action lawsuit was filed on September 20, 2006 in the Ontario Superior Court of Justice against the Company and certain of its officers and directors, alleging violations of Canadian securities laws. This lawsuit was brought on behalf of shareholders who acquired the Company’s securities between February 17, 2006 and August 9, 2006. The lawsuit seeks $210.0 million in compensatory and punitive damages, as well as costs. For reasons released December 14, 2009, the Court granted leave to the Plaintiffs to amend their statement of claim to plead certain claims pursuant to the Securities Act (Ontario) against the Company and certain individuals and granted certification of the action as a class proceeding. These are procedural decisions, and do not contain any conclusions binding on a judge at trial as to the factual or legal merits of the claim. Leave to appeal those decisions was denied. The Company believes the allegations made against it in the statement of claim are meritless and will vigorously defend the matter, although no assurance can be given with respect to the ultimate outcome of such proceedings. The Company’s directors and officers insurance policy provides for reimbursement of costs and expenses incurred in connection with this lawsuit as well as potential damages awarded, if any, subject to certain policy limits, exclusions and deductibles.

 

110


Table of Contents

(f) In addition to the matters described above, the Company is currently involved in other legal proceedings which, in the opinion of the Company’s management, will not materially affect the Company’s financial position or future operating results, although no assurance can be given with respect to the ultimate outcome of any such proceedings.

(g) In the normal course of business, the Company enters into agreements that may contain features that meet the definition of a guarantee. The Guarantees Topic of the FASB ASC defines a guarantee to be a contract (including an indemnity) that contingently requires the Company to make payments (either in cash, financial instruments, other assets, shares of its stock or provision of services) to a third party based on (a) changes in an underlying interest rate, foreign exchange rate, equity or commodity instrument, index or other variable, that is related to an asset, a liability or an equity security of the counterparty, (b) failure of another party to perform under an obligating agreement or (c) failure of another third party to pay its indebtedness when due.

Financial Guarantees

The Company has provided no significant financial guarantees to third parties.

Product Warranties

The following summarizes the accrual for product warranties that was recorded as part of accrued liabilities in the consolidated balance sheets:

 

         As at December 31,      
         2012             2011      

Balance at the beginning of the year

   $ 94     $ 160  

Warranty redemptions

     (66     (152

Warranties issued

     53       146  

Revisions

     (49     (60
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at the end of the year

   $     32     $     94  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Director/Officer Indemnifications

The Company’s General By-law contains an indemnification of its directors/officers, former directors/officers and persons who have acted at its request to be a director/officer of an entity in which the Company is a shareholder or creditor, to indemnify them, to the extent permitted by the Canada Business Corporations Act, against expenses (including legal fees), judgments, fines and any amount actually and reasonably incurred by them in connection with any action, suit or proceeding in which the directors and/or officers are sued as a result of their service, if they acted honestly and in good faith with a view to the best interests of the Company. The nature of the indemnification prevents the Company from making a reasonable estimate of the maximum potential amount it could be required to pay to counterparties. The Company has purchased directors’ and officers’ liability insurance. No amount has been accrued in the consolidated balance sheet as at December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011 with respect to this indemnity.

Other Indemnification Agreements

In the normal course of the Company’s operations, the Company provides indemnifications to counterparties in transactions such as: theater system lease and sale agreements and the supervision of installation or servicing of the theater systems; film production, exhibition and distribution agreements; real property lease agreements; and employment agreements. These indemnification agreements require the Company to compensate the counterparties for costs incurred as a result of litigation claims that may be suffered by the counterparty as a consequence of the transaction or the Company’s breach or non-performance under these agreements. While the terms of these indemnification agreements vary based upon the contract, they normally extend for the life of the agreements. A small number of agreements do not provide for any limit on the maximum potential amount of indemnification; however, virtually all of the Company’s system lease and sale agreements limit such maximum potential liability to the purchase price of the system. The fact that the maximum potential amount of indemnification required by the Company is not specified in some cases prevents the Company from making a reasonable estimate of the maximum potential amount it could be required to pay to counterparties. Historically, the Company has not made any significant payments under such indemnifications and no amounts have been accrued in the condensed consolidated financial statements with respect to the contingent aspect of these indemnities.

 

111


Table of Contents

15. Capital Stock

(a) Authorized

Common Shares

The authorized capital of the Company consists of an unlimited number of common shares. The following is a summary of the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions of the common shares.

The holders of common shares are entitled to receive dividends if, as and when declared by the directors of the Company, subject to the rights of the holders of any other class of shares of the Company entitled to receive dividends in priority to the common shares.

The holders of the common shares are entitled to one vote for each common share held at all meetings of the shareholders.

(b) Changes during the Year

In 2012, the Company issued 1,429,685 (2011 — 907,167, 2010 — 1,313,599) common shares pursuant to the exercise of stock options for cash proceeds of $8.9 million (2011 — $7.9 million, 2010 — $8.3 million).

(c) Stock-Based Compensation

The Company has five stock-based compensation plans that are described below. The compensation costs recorded in the consolidated statement of operations for these plans were $13.1 million in 2012 (2011 — $11.9 million, 2010 — $27.7 million). Total stock-based compensation expense related to nonvested employee stock-based payment awards not yet recognized at December 31, 2012 and the weighted average period over which the awards are expected to be recognized is $20.6 million and 3.6 years, respectively (2011 — $19.9 million and 3.1 years, 2010 — $18.0 million and 2.7 years).

Stock Option Plan

The Company’s Stock Option Plan, which is shareholder approved, permits the grant of options to employees, directors and consultants. The Company recorded an expense of $12.4 million in 2012 (2011 — $9.4 million, 2010 — $4.1 million), related to grants issued to employees and directors in the plan. No income tax benefit is recorded in the consolidated statement of operations for these costs.

The Company’s policy is to issue new shares from treasury to satisfy stock options which are exercised.

The Company utilizes the lattice-binomial option-pricing model (“Binomial Model”) to determine the fair value of stock-based payment awards. The fair value determined by the Binomial Model is affected by the Company’s stock price as well as assumptions regarding a number of highly complex and subjective variables. These variables include, but are not limited to, the Company’s expected stock price volatility over the term of the awards, and actual and projected employee stock option exercise behaviors. The Binomial Model also considers the expected exercise multiple which is the multiple of exercise price to grant price at which exercises are expected to occur on average. Option-pricing models were developed for use in estimating the value of traded options that have no vesting or hedging restrictions and are fully transferable. Because the Company’s employee stock options have certain characteristics that are significantly different from traded options, and because changes in the subjective assumptions can materially affect the estimated value, in management’s opinion, the Binomial Model best provides a fair measure of the fair value of the Company’s employee stock options.

The weighted average fair value of all common share options, granted to employees in 2012 at the measurement date was $7.45 per share (2011 — $9.07 per share, 2010 — $8.01 per share). For the years ended December 31, the following assumptions were used:

 

112


Table of Contents
     2012   2011   2010

Average risk-free interest rate

   1.36%   2.61%   3.18%

Expected option life (in years)

   2.89 - 6.26   1.78 - 6.60   2.82 - 5.41

Expected volatility

   50%   50%   50% - 61%

Annual termination probability

   0% - 8.76%   0% - 8.76%   0% - 9.69%

Dividend yield

   0%   0%   0%

As at December 31, 2012, the Company has reserved a total of 13,296,485 (December 31, 2011— 13,010,548) common shares for future issuance under the Stock Option Plan, of which options in respect of 7,441,068 common shares are outstanding at December 31, 2012. All awards of stock options are made at fair market value of the Company’s common shares on the date of grant. The fair market value of a common share on a given date means the higher of the closing price of a common share on the grant date (or the most recent trading date if the grant date is not a trading date) on the NYSE, the TSX and such national exchange, as may be designated by the Company’s Board of Directors (the “Fair Market Value”). The options generally vest between one and 5 years and expire 10 years or less from the date granted. The Stock Option Plan provides that vesting will be accelerated if there is a change of control, as defined in the plan and upon certain conditions. At December 31, 2012, options in respect of 3,480,160 common shares were vested and exercisable.

China Long Term Incentive Plan (“CLTIP”)

A separate stock option plan was adopted by a subsidiary of the Company in October 2012. Each stock option issued under the CLTIP generally represents an opportunity to participate economically in the future growth and value creation of the subsidiary. The CLTIP options issued by the subsidiary (“China Options”) operate in tandem with the Company’s Stock Option Plan (“SOP Options”) granted to certain employees discussed above.

The China Options issued by the subsidiary vest and become exercisable only upon specific performance events, including upon the occurrence of a qualified initial public offering or a change in control on or prior to the fifth anniversary of the grant date. In the event the performance event occurs, the China Options vest over a 5 year period beginning on the date of grant and the SOP Options are forfeited. The term of the China Options is 7 years. The total stock option expense associated with the China Options if a specific performance event and vesting were to occur is $2.7 million.

The SOP Options vest in full if the specific performance event does not occur on or prior to the fifth anniversary of the grant date. Upon vesting of the SOP Options, the China Options are forfeited.

In 2012, an aggregate of 146,623 SOP Options were granted in conjunction with the China Options to certain employees to purchase the Company’s common stock with an average price of $22.39 in accordance with the CLTIP. The SOP Options have a contractual life of 7 years. As at December 31, 2012 there were 146,623 outstanding and unvested SOP Options issued under the CLTIP with a weighted average exercise price of $22.39. The weighted average fair value of these SOP Options granted in 2012 at the measurement date was $6.96 per share. The total fair value of the SOP Options granted with respect to the CLTIP is $1.6 million. The Company is recognizing this expense over a 5 year period. If a performance event occurs, the 146,623 SOP Options issued forfeit immediately and the related charge would be reversed.

The Company has included a charge of less than $0.1 million within its employee Stock Option Plan related to the SOP Options issued thereunder.

 

113


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes certain information in respect of option activity under the Stock Option Plan:

 

           Weighted Average Exercise  
     Number of Shares     Price Per Share  
     2012     2011     2010     2012      2011      2010  

Options outstanding, beginning of year

     7,200,721       6,743,272       6,173,795     $ 14.60      $ 10.79      $ 6.52  

Granted

     1,833,485       1,547,342       2,001,703       24.59        28.11        21.72  

Exercised

     (1,429,685     (907,167     (1,313,599     6.24        8.67        6.30  

Forfeited

     (154,958     (182,726     (23,825     23.03        18.00        8.35  

Expired

     —         —         (94,802     —          —          26.08  

Cancelled

     (8,495     —         —         22.07        —          —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Options outstanding, end of period

     7,441,068       7,200,721       6,743,272       18.48        14.60        10.79  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

Options exercisable, end of period

     3,480,160       3,467,242       3,090,755       14.50        9.51        5.64  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

         

In 2012, the Company cancelled 8,495 stock options from its Stock Option Plan (2011 — nil, 2010 — nil) surrendered by Company employees.

As at December 31, 2012, 6,354,481 options were fully vested or are expected to vest with a weighted average exercise price of $17.89, aggregate intrinsic value of $44.0 million and weighted average remaining contractual life of 4.8 years. As at December 31, 2012, options that are exercisable have an intrinsic value of $34.3 million and a weighted average remaining contractual life of 4.5 years. The intrinsic value of options exercised in 2012 was $23.4 million (2011 — $16.4 million, 2010 — $15.0 million).

Options to Non-Employees

During 2012, an aggregate of 12,500 (2011 — 103,944, 2010 — 135,217) common share options to purchase the Company’s common stock with an average exercise price of $22.82 (2011 — $27.64, 2010 — $15.92) were granted to certain advisors and strategic partners of the Company. These options have a maximum contractual life of 7 years and vest between one and 5 years. These options were granted under the Stock Option Plan.

As at December 31, 2012 non-employee options outstanding amounted to 120,001 options (2011 — 142,251, 2010 — 132,168) with a weighted average exercise price of $14.14 (2011 — $12.93, 2010 — $13.53). Included within the non-employee outstanding options are 15,000 unvested options which were modified in 2011 from service based employee awards to performance based non-employee awards. 35,717 options (2011 — 50,500, 2010 — 4,500) were exercisable with an average weighted exercise price of $11.57 (2011 — $11.50, 2010 — $14.60) and the vested options have an aggregate intrinsic value of $0.4 million (2011 — $0.3 million, 2010 — $0.1 million). The weighted average fair value of options granted to non-employees during 2012 at the measurement date was $11.73 per share (2011 — $13.75 per share, 2010 — $12.71 per share), utilizing a Binomial Model with the following underlying assumptions:

 

     Years Ended December 31
     2012    2011    2010

Average risk-free interest rate

   1.28%    2.38%    2.09%

Contractual option life

   7 years    6 years    1.70 - 6.25 years

Average expected volatility

   50%    50%    50% - 61%

Dividend yield

   0%    0%    0%

In 2012, the Company recorded a charge of $0.1 million, (2011 — $0.9 million 2010 — $1.8 million) to costs and expenses related to revenues – services and selling, general and administrative expenses related to the non-employee stock options. Included in accrued liabilities is an accrual of $0.1 million for non-employee stock options recorded (December 31, 2011—$0.1 million).

 

114


Table of Contents

Restricted Common Shares

Under the terms of certain employment agreements dated July 12, 2000, the Company was required to issue either 160,000 restricted common shares or pay their cash equivalent upon request by the employees at any time. The Company accounted for the obligation as a liability, which was classified within accrued liabilities. In December 2010, upon request by the employees, the Company paid $4.2 million in cash to settle the equivalent of the remaining 160,000 restricted common shares under these agreements. The Company recorded an expense of $2.0 million in 2010 related to the restricted common shares.

Stock Appreciation Rights

There has been no stock appreciation rights (“SARs”) granted since 2007. During 2007, 2,280,000 SARs with a weighted average exercise price of $6.20 per right were granted in-lieu of stock options to certain Company executives. For the year ended December 31, 2012, 15,000 SARs were cash settled for $0.3 million (2011 — 999,500 SARs were cash settled for $23.7 million). The average exercise price for the settled SARs for the year ended December 31, 2012 was $6.86 (2011 — $6.86) per SAR. As at December 31, 2012, 118,000 SARs were outstanding and exercisable. None of the SARs were forfeited, cancelled, or expired for the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2011. The SARs vesting period ranges from immediately upon granting to 5 years, with a remaining contractual life of 5.00 years as at December 31, 2012. The outstanding SARs had a weighted average fair value of $16.23 per right as at December 31, 2012 (December 31, 2011 — $12.43). The Company accounts for the obligation of these SARs as a liability (December 31, 2012 — $1.9 million, December 31, 2011 — $1.6 million), which is classified within accrued liabilities. The Company has recorded an expense of $0.6 million for 2012 (2011 — $1.6 million, 2010 — $19.8 million) to selling, general and administrative expenses related to these SARs. The following assumptions were used for measuring the fair value of the SARs:

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012     2011  

Average risk-free interest rate

     0.72     1.09

Expected option life (in years)

     2.17       3.18 to 3.46   

Expected volatility

     50     50

Annual termination probability

     8.52     8.76

Dividend yield

     0     0

(d) Income per share

Reconciliations of the numerator and denominator of the basic and diluted per-share computations are comprised of the following:

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011      2010  
            As Revised      As Revised  

Net income from continuing operations applicable to common shareholders

   $ 41,337      $ 15,260      $ 101,240  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Weighted average number of common shares (000’s):

        

Issued and outstanding, beginning of period

     65,053        64,146        62,832  

Weighted average number of shares issued during the period

     801        358        744  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Weighted average number of shares used in computing basic earnings per Share

     65,854        64,504        63,576  

Assumed exercise of stock options, net of shares assumed

     2,079        3,355        3,108  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Weighted average number of shares used in computing diluted earnings per Share

     67,933        67,859        66,684  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

115


Table of Contents

16. Consolidated Statements of Operations Supplemental Information

(a) Other Revenues

The Company enters into theater system arrangements with customers that typically contain customer payment obligations prior to the scheduled installation of the theater systems. During the period of time between signing and theater system installation, certain customers each year are unable to, or elect not to, proceed with the theater system installation for a number of reasons, including business considerations, or the inability to obtain certain consents, approvals or financing. Once the determination is made that the customer will not proceed with installation, the customer and/or the Company may terminate the arrangement by default or by entering into a consensual buyout. In these situations the parties are released from their future obligations under the arrangement, and the initial payments that the customer previously made to the Company are typically not refunded and are recognized as Other Revenues. In addition, the Company enters into agreements with customers to terminate their obligations for additional theater system configurations, which were in the Company’s backlog. Other revenues from settlement arrangements were $0.7 million, $3.8 million and $0.4 million in 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

(b) Foreign Exchange

Included in selling, general and administrative expenses for the December 31, 2012 is a $1.2 million gain, for net foreign exchange gains/losses related to the translation of foreign currency denominated monetary assets and liabilities and unhedged foreign exchange contracts compared with a loss of $1.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 and a gain of $1.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2010, respectively. See note 21(d) for additional information.

(c) Collaborative Arrangements

Joint Revenue Sharing Arrangements

In a joint revenue sharing arrangement, the Company receives a portion of a theater’s box-office and concession revenues, and in some cases a small upfront or initial payment, in exchange for placing a theater system at the theater operator’s venue. Under joint revenue sharing arrangements, the customer has the ability and the right to operate the hardware components or direct others to operate them in a manner determined by the customer. The Company’s joint revenue sharing arrangements are typically non-cancellable for 7 to 10 years with renewal provisions. Title to equipment under joint revenue sharing arrangements does not transfer to the customer. The Company’s joint revenue sharing arrangements do not contain a guarantee of residual value at the end of the term. The customer is required to pay for executory costs such as insurance and taxes and is required to pay the Company for maintenance and extended warranty throughout the term. The customer is responsible for obtaining insurance coverage for the theater systems commencing on the date specified in the arrangement’s shipping terms and ending on the date the theater systems are delivered back to the Company.

The Company has signed joint revenue sharing agreements with 29 exhibitors for a total of 453 theater systems, of which 316 theaters were operating as at December 31, 2012, the terms of which are similar in nature, rights and obligations. The accounting policy for the Company’s joint revenue sharing arrangements is disclosed in note 2(m).

Amounts attributable to transactions arising between the Company and its customers under joint revenue sharing arrangements are included in Rentals revenue and at December 31, 2012 amounted to $57.5 million (2011 — $30.8 million, 2010—$41.8 million).

IMAX DMR

In an IMAX DMR arrangement, the Company transforms conventional motion pictures into the Company’s large screen format, allowing the release of Hollywood content to the IMAX theater network. In a typical IMAX DMR film arrangement, the Company will absorb its costs for the digital re-mastering and then recoup this cost from a percentage of the gross box-office receipts of the film, which generally range from 10-15%. The Company does not typically hold distribution rights or the copyright to these films.

In 2012, the majority of IMAX DMR revenue was earned from the exhibition of 35 IMAX DMR films through the IMAX theater network. The accounting policy for the Company’s IMAX DMR arrangements is disclosed in note 2(m).

Amounts attributable to transactions arising between the Company and its customers under IMAX DMR arrangements are included in Services revenues and for December 31, 2012 amounted to $78.1 million (2011 — $50.6 million, 2010—$63.5 million).

 

116


Table of Contents

Co-Produced Film Arrangements

In certain film arrangements, the Company co-produces a film with a third party whereby the third party retains the copyright and rights to the film, except that the Company obtains exclusive theatrical distribution rights to the film. Under these arrangements, both parties contribute funding to the Company’s wholly-owned production company for the production of the film and for associated exploitation costs. Clauses in the film arrangements generally provide for the third party to take over the production of the film if the cost of the production exceeds its approved budget or if it appears as though the film will not be delivered on a timely basis.

As at December 31, 2012, the Company has 4 significant co-produced film arrangements which make up greater than 50% of the VIE total assets and liabilities balance of $15.9 million and 3 other co-produced film arrangements, the terms of which are similar. The accounting policies relating to co-produced film arrangements are disclosed in notes 2(a) and 2(n).

In 2012, amounts totaling $6.1 million (2011 —$7.5 million, 2010—$7.7 million) attributable to transactions between the Company and other parties involved in the production of the films have been included in cost and expenses applicable to revenues-services.

17. Receivable Provisions, Net of Recoveries

The following table reflects the Company’s receivable provisions net of recoveries recorded in the consolidated statements of operations:

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012     2011      2010  

Accounts receivable provisions, net of recoveries

   $ 606     $ 333      $ 499  

Financing receivable provisions, net of recoveries

     (82     1,237        944  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Receivable provisions, net of recoveries

   $ 524     $ 1,570      $ 1,443  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

18. Asset Impairments

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011      2010  

Property, plant and equipment

   $ —        $ 28      $ 45  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ —        $ 28      $ 45  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Company records asset impairment charges against property, plant and equipment after an assessment of the carrying value of certain groups in light of their future expected cash flows.

 

117


Table of Contents

19. Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows Supplemental Information

(a) Changes in other non-cash operating assets and liabilities are comprised of the following:

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012     2011     2010  

Decrease (increase) in:

      

Accounts receivable

   $ 4,110     $ (7,486   $ (2,423

Financing receivables

     (7,349     (14,623     (11,874

Inventories

     (422     (1,264     (3,828

Prepaid expenses

     (706     (294     (223

Commissions and other deferred selling expenses

     322       382       (432

Insurance recoveries

     444       978       156  

Other assets

     (752     (2,357     (25

Increase (decrease) in:

      

Accounts payable

     (8,139     5,592       100  

Accrued and other liabilities(1)

     (2,266     (31,013     (25,823

Deferred revenue

     (504     706       15,690  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ (15,262   $ (49,379   $ (28,682
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Decrease in accruals and other liabilities for 2012 includes payments of $0.3 million for stock-based compensation (2011—$23.7 million, 2010—$14.7 million payment of pension benefits and $14.5 million payments for stock-based compensation).

 

(b) Cash payments made on account of:

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011      2010  

Income taxes

   $ 1,283      $ 3,349      $ 682  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest

   $ 1,374      $ 1,260      $ 1,719  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(c) Depreciation and amortization are comprised of the following:

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011      2010  

Film assets (1)

   $ 15,515      $ 12,934      $ 10,900  

Property, plant and equipment

        

Joint revenue sharing arrangements

     10,125        7,098        5,315  

Other property, plant and equipment

     4,440        3,992        3,525  

Other intangible assets

     2,006        465        448  

Other assets

     532        286        7  

Deferred financing costs

     170        388        341  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 32,788      $ 25,163      $ 20,536  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) Included in film asset amortization is a charge of $0.1 million (2011 —$0.5 million, 2010 — less than $0.1 million) relating to changes in estimates based on the ultimate recoverability of future films.

 

118


Table of Contents
(d) Write-downs, net of recoveries, are comprised of the following:

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012     2011      2010  

Asset impairments

       

Property, plant and equipment

   $ —       $ 28      $ 45  

Other charges (recoveries)

       

Accounts receivables

     606       333        499  

Financing receivables

     (82     1,237        944  

Inventories(1)

     898       —          999  

Impairment of available-for-sale investment

     150       —          —    

Property, plant and equipment(2)

     18       356        —    

Other intangible assets

     11       —          64  

Other assets

     6       —          —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 1,607     $ 1,954      $ 2,551  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Inventory charges

       

Recorded in costs and expenses applicable to revenues—product & equipment sales

   $ 795     $ —        $ 827  

Recorded in costs and expenses applicable to revenues—services

     103       —          172  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 898     $ —        $ 999  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) In 2012, the Company recorded a charge of $0.9 million (2011 — $nil, 2010 — $1.0 million, respectively) in costs and expenses applicable to revenues, primarily for its film-based projector inventories. Specifically, IMAX systems includes an inventory charge of $0.8 million (2011 — $nil, 2010 — $0.8 million). Theater system maintenance includes inventory write-downs of $0.1 million (2011 — $nil, 2010 — $0.2 million).
(2) The Company disposed of assets that no longer meet capitalization requirements as the assets were no longer in use. No cash was received for these assets.

20. Segmented Information

The Company has seven reportable segments identified by category of product sold or service provided: IMAX systems; theater system maintenance; joint revenue sharing arrangements; film production and IMAX DMR; film distribution; film post-production; and other. The IMAX systems segment designs, manufactures, sells or leases IMAX theater projection system equipment. The theater system maintenance segment maintains IMAX theater projection system equipment in the IMAX theater network. The joint revenue sharing arrangements segment provides IMAX theater projection system equipment to an exhibitor in exchange for a share of the box-office and concession revenues. The film production and IMAX DMR segment produces films and performs film re-mastering services. The film distribution segment distributes films for which the Company has distribution rights. The film post-production segment provides film post-production and film print services. The Company refers to all theaters using the IMAX theater system as “IMAX theaters.” The other segment includes certain IMAX theaters that the Company owns and operates, camera rentals and other miscellaneous items. The accounting policies of the segments are the same as those described in note 2.

The Company’s Chief Operating Decision Maker (“CODM”), as defined in the Segment Reporting Topic of the FASB ASC, assesses segment performance based on segment revenues, gross margins and film performance. Selling, general and administrative expenses, research and development costs, amortization of intangibles, receivables provisions (recoveries), write-downs net of recoveries, interest income, interest expense and tax (provision) recovery are not allocated to the segments.

Transactions between the film production and IMAX DMR segment and the film post-production segment are valued at exchange value. Inter-segment profits are eliminated upon consolidation, as well as for the disclosures below.

Transactions between the other segments are not significant.

 

119


Table of Contents

(a) Operating Segments

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011     2010  

Revenue(1)

       

IMAX systems

   $ 83,405      $ 93,200     $ 76,004  

Theater system maintenance

     28,629        24,840       21,444  

Joint revenue sharing arrangements

     57,526        30,764       41,757  

Films

       

Production and IMAX DMR

     78,050        50,592       63,462  

Distribution

     14,222        16,074       17,937  

Post-production

     7,904        8,235       7,702  

Other

     14,554        12,851       20,308  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 284,290      $ 236,556     $ 248,614  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross margins

       

IMAX systems(2)(4)

   $ 50,245      $ 56,929     $ 43,983  

Theater system maintenance(2)

     10,970        9,437       10,084  

Joint revenue sharing arrangements(3)(4)

     37,308        17,605       31,703  

Films

       

Production and IMAX DMR(4)

     49,355        23,574       41,159  

Distribution(4)

     2,356        3,025       5,205  

Post-production

     1,954        2,985       2,891  

Other

     545        (337     2,627  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 152,733      $ 113,218     $ 137,652  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011     2010  

Depreciation and amortization

       

IMAX systems

   $ 2,946      $ 1,770     $ 2,253  

Theater systems maintenance

     212        184       —    

Joint revenue sharing arrangements

     11,836        7,939       5,322  

Films

       

Production and IMAX DMR

     14,471        12,843       10,360  

Distribution

     1,631        980       1,334  

Post-production

     608        590       588  

Other

     172        156       132  

Corporate and other non-segment specific assets

     912        701       547  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 32,788      $ 25,163     $ 20,536  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011      2010  

Asset impairments and write-downs, net of recoveries

        

IMAX systems

   $ 1,480      $ 1,915      $ 2,271  

Theater systems maintenance

     103        —          171  

Joint revenue sharing arrangements

     24        12        —    

Films

        

Production and IMAX DMR

     —          —          64  

Other

     —          27        45  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,607      $ 1,954      $ 2,551  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

120


Table of Contents
     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011      2010  

Purchase of property, plant and equipment

        

IMAX systems

   $ 2,958      $ 1,076      $ 3,441  

Theater system maintenance

     36        10        18  

Joint revenue sharing arrangements

     23,257        33,290        21,275  

Films

        

Production and IMAX DMR

     1,175        1,150        450  

Distribution

     178        49        90  

Post-production

     —          638        514  

Other

     —          719        541  

Corporate and other non-segment specific assets

     1,708        1,886        284  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 29,312      $ 38,818      $ 26,613  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012      2011  
            As Revised  

Assets

     

IMAX systems(5)

   $ 153,201      $ 154,312  

Theater systems maintenance(5)

     14,632        13,008  

Joint revenue sharing arrangements(5)

     125,602        120,483  

Films

     

Production and IMAX DMR

     17,653        16,577  

Distribution

     6,790        4,504  

Post-production

     3,694        4,185  

Other

     3,142        2,718  

Corporate and other non-segment specific assets

     97,158        91,462  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 421,872      $ 407,249  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) The Company’s two largest customers as at December 31, 2012 collectively represent 15.9% of total revenues (2011 – 17.4%, 2010 – 17.3%). In the third quarter of 2012, Dalian Wanda Group Co., Ltd., the parent company of Wanda Cinema Line Corporation (“Wanda”), acquired AMC Entertainment Holdings, Inc. (“AMC”). Prior to this transaction, AMC and Wanda were the Company’s first and third largest customers. Under common ownership, the Wanda/AMC entity is the Company’s largest customer. Revenues from this customer are included across all of the Company’s segments. Prior year figures have been restated to reflect the change in the Company’s largest customers.
(2) In 2012, the Company recorded a charge of $0.9 million (2011 – $nil, 2010 – $1.0 million, respectively) in costs and expenses applicable to revenues, primarily for its film-based projector inventories. Specifically, IMAX systems includes an inventory charge of $0.8 million (2011 – $nil, 2010 – $0.8 million). Theater system maintenance includes inventory write-downs of $0.1 million (2011 – $nil, 2010 – $0.2 million).
(3) In 2010, the Company adjusted the estimated useful life of its IMAX digital projection systems in use for those joint revenue sharing theaters, on a prospective basis, to reflect the change in term from 7 years to 10 years. This resulted in decreased depreciation expense of $1.0 million in 2010.
(4) IMAX systems include commission costs of $2.7 million, $2.4 million and $1.9 million in 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively. Joint revenue sharing arrangements segment margins include advertising, marketing, and commission costs of $3.4 million, $5.4 million and $4.2 million in 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively. Production and DMR segment margins include marketing costs of $3.3 million, $3.8 million and $2.1 million in 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively. Distribution segment margins include marketing costs of $1.5 million, $1.9 million and $0.7 million in 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
(5) Goodwill is allocated on a relative fair market value basis to the IMAX systems segment, theater system maintenance segment and joint revenue sharing segment.

 

121


Table of Contents

(b) Geographic Information

Revenue by geographic area is based on the location of the customer. Revenue related to IMAX DMR is presented based upon the geographic location of the theaters that exhibit the re-mastered films. IMAX DMR revenue is generated through contractual relationships with studios and other third parties and these may not be in the same geographical location as the theater. Prior years’ figures have been reclassified to conform to the current year geographical classification.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011      2010  

Revenue

        

United States

   $ 128,082      $ 110,124      $ 142,899  

Canada

     19,109        21,232        9,204  

Greater China

     44,922        33,265        21,680  

Western Europe

     26,309        18,895        24,011  

Asia (excluding Greater China)

     28,899        22,186        19,646  

Russia & the CIS

     20,130        16,157        17,099  

Latin America

     9,419        6,051        5,221  

Rest of the World

     7,420        8,646        8,854  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 284,290      $ 236,556      $ 248,614  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

No single country in the Rest of the World, Western Europe or Asia (excluding Greater China) classifications comprise more than 5% of total revenue.

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012      2011  

Property, plant and equipment

     

United States

   $ 55,658      $ 54,133  

Canada

     21,779        19,004  

Greater China

     24,764        16,785  

Asia (excluding Greater China)

     7,134        6,486  

Western Europe

     3,556        3,945  

Rest of the World

     719        900  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 113,610      $ 101,253  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

122


Table of Contents

21. Financial Instruments

(a) Financial Instruments

The Company maintains cash with various major financial institutions. The Company’s cash is invested with highly rated financial institutions.

The Company’s accounts receivables and financing receivables are subject to credit risk. The Company’s accounts receivable and financing receivables are concentrated with the theater exhibition industry and film entertainment industry. To minimize the Company’s credit risk, the Company retains title to underlying theater systems leased, performs initial and ongoing credit evaluations of its customers and makes ongoing provisions for its estimate of potentially uncollectible amounts. The Company believes it has adequately provided for related exposures surrounding receivables and contractual commitments.

(b) Fair Value Measurements

The carrying values of the Company’s cash and cash equivalents, accounts receivable, accounts payable and accrued liabilities due within one year approximate fair values due to the short-term maturity of these instruments. The Company’s other financial instruments at December 31, are comprised of the following:

 

     As at December 31, 2012     As at December 31, 2011  
     Carrying
Amount
    Estimated
Fair Value
    Carrying
Amount
    Estimated
Fair Value
 

Borrowings under the Prior Credit Facility

   $ (11,000   $ (11,000   $ (55,083   $ (55,083

Net financed sales receivable

   $ 81,148     $ 78,933     $ 67,300     $ 65,846  

Net investment in sales-type leases

   $ 13,045     $ 13,513     $ 19,414     $ 20,448  

Available-for-sale investment

   $ 1,350     $ 1,350     $ 1,012     $ 1,012  

Foreign exchange contracts — designated forwards

   $ 297     $ 297     $ (182   $ (182

Foreign exchange contracts — non-designated forwards

   $ —       $ —       $ (645   $ (645

The carrying value of borrowings under the Prior Credit Facility approximates fair value as the interest rates offered under the Prior Credit Facility are close to December 31, 2012 and 2011 market rates for the Company for debt of the same remaining maturities (Level 2 input in accordance with the Fair Value Measurements Topic of the FASB ASC hierarchy) as at December 31, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

The estimated fair values of the net financed sales receivable and net investment in sales-type leases are estimated based on discounting future cash flows at currently available interest rates with comparable terms (Level 2 input in accordance with the Fair Value Measurements Topic of the FASB ASC hierarchy) as at December 31, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

The fair value of the Company’s available-for-sale investment is determined using the present value of expected cash flows based on projected earnings and other information readily available from the business venture (Level 3 input in accordance with the Fair Value Measurements Topic of the FASB ASC hierarchy) as at December 31, 2012 and 2011, respectively. The discounted cash flow valuation technique is based on significant unobservable inputs of revenue and expense projections, appropriately risk weighted, as the investment is in a start-up entity. The significant unobservable inputs used in the fair value measurement of the Company’s available-for-sale investment are long-term revenue growth and pretax operating margin. A significant increase (decrease) in any of those inputs in isolation would result in a lower or higher fair value measurement.

The fair value of foreign currency derivatives are determined using quoted prices in active markets (Level 2 input in accordance with the Fair Value Measurements Topic of the FASB ASC hierarchy) as at December 31, 2012 and 2011, respectively. These identical instruments are traded on a closed exchange.

There were no significant transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 during the year ended December 31, 2012 or 2011. When a determination is made to classify an asset or liability within Level 3, the determination is based upon the significance of the unobservable inputs to the overall fair value measurement. The table below sets forth a summary of changes in the fair value of the Company’s available-for-sale investment measured at fair value on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) during the period:

 

123


Table of Contents
     Available For  Sale
Investments
 
     2012     2011  

Beginning balance, January 1,

   $ 1,012     $ 1,500  

Transfers into/out of Level 3

     —         —    

Total gains or losses (realized/unrealized)

    

Included in earnings

     —         —    

Included in other comprehensive income

     338       (488

Purchases, issuances, sales and settlements

     —         —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance, December 31,

   $ 1,350     $ 1,012  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The amount of total gains or losses for the period included in earnings attributable to the change in unrealized gains or losses relating to assets still held at the reporting date

   $ (150   $ —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

There were no transfers in or out of the Company’s level 3 assets during the year ended December 31, 2012.

In the year ended December 31, 2012, the Company recognized a $0.2 million other-than-temporary impairment of its available-for-sale investment, in “Impairment of available-for-sale investment” in the consolidated statement of operations, as the value is not expected to recover based on the length of time and extent to which the market value has been less than cost.

(c) Financing Receivables

The Company’s net investment in leases and its net financed sale receivables are subject to the disclosure requirements of ASC 310 “Receivables”. Due to differing risk profiles of its net investment in leases and its net financed sales receivables, the Company views its net investment in leases and its net financed sale receivables as separate classes of financing receivables. The Company does not aggregate financing receivables to assess impairment.

The Company monitors the credit quality of each customer on a frequent basis through collections and aging analyses. The Company also holds meetings monthly in order to identify credit concerns and whether a change in credit quality classification is required for the customer. A customer may improve in their credit quality classification once a substantial payment is made on overdue balances or the customer has agreed to a payment plan with the Company and payments have commenced in accordance to the payment plan. The change in credit quality indicator is dependent upon management approval.

The Company classifies its customers into four categories to indicate the credit quality worthiness of its financing receivables for internal purposes only:

Good standing — Theater continues to be in good standing with the Company as the client’s payments and reporting are up-to-date.

Credit Watch — Theater operator has begun to demonstrate a delay in payments, has been placed on the Company’s credit watch list for continued monitoring, but active communication continues with the Company. Depending on the size of outstanding balance, length of time in arrears and other factors, transactions may need to be approved by management. These financing receivables are considered to be in better condition than those receivables related to theaters in the “Pre-approved transactions” category, but not in as good of condition as those receivables in “Good standing.”

Pre-approved transactions only — Theater operator is demonstrating a delay in payments with little or no communication with the Company. All service or shipments to the theater must be reviewed and approved by management. These financing receivables are considered to be in better condition than those receivables related to theaters in the “All transactions suspended” category, but not in as good of condition as those receivables in “Credit Watch.” Depending on the individual facts and circumstances of each customer, finance income recognition may be suspended if management believes the receivable to be impaired.

All transactions suspended — Theater is severely delinquent, non-responsive or not negotiating in good faith with the Company. Once a theater is classified as “All transactions suspended”, the theater is placed on nonaccrual status and all revenue recognitions related to the theater are stopped.

 

124


Table of Contents

The following table discloses the recorded investment in financing receivables by credit quality indicator:

 

     As at December 31, 2012      As at December 31, 2011  
     Minimum
Lease
Payments
     Financed
Sales
Receivables
     Total      Minimum
Lease
Payments
     Financed
Sales
Receivables
     Total  

In good standing

   $ 11,508      $ 69,310      $ 80,818      $ 15,667      $ 55,907      $ 71,574  

Credit Watch

     —          10,930        10,930        1,506        3,718        5,224  

Pre-approved transactions

     467        293        760        1,837        7,272        9,109  

Transactions suspended

     2,200        681        2,881        2,237        719        2,956  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 14,175      $ 81,214      $ 95,389      $ 21,247      $ 67,616      $ 88,863  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

While recognition of finance income is suspended, payments received by a customer are applied against the outstanding balance owed. If payments are sufficient to cover any unreserved receivables, a recovery of provision taken on the billed amount, if applicable, is recorded to the extent of the residual cash received. Once the collectibility issues are resolved and the customer has returned to being in good standing, the Company will resume recognition of finance income. During the year ended December 31, 2012, a financing receivable was modified as a troubled debt restructuring. The customer has paid all overdue amounts in accordance with such restructuring which has resulted in a change in the credit quality classification from ‘pre-approved transactions’ to ‘in good standing’.

The Company’s investment in financing receivables on nonaccrual status is as follows:

 

     As at December 31, 2012     As at December 31, 2011  
     Recorded
Investment
     Related
Allowance
    Recorded
Investment
     Related
Allowance
 

Net investment in leases

   $ 2,666      $ (1,130   $ 4,692       $ (1,833

Net financed sales receivables

     1,322        (66     1,329         (316
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 3,988      $ (1,196   $ 6,021       $ (2,149
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Company considers financing receivables with aging between 60-89 days as indications of theaters with potential collection concerns. The Company will begin to focus its review on these financing receivables and increase its discussions internally and with the theater regarding payment status. Once a theater’s aging exceeds 90 days, the Company’s policy is to review and assess collectibility on theater’s past due accounts. Over 90 days past due is used by the Company as an indicator of potential impairment as invoices up to 90 days outstanding could be considered reasonable due to the time required for dispute resolution or for the provision of further information or supporting documentation to the customer.

 

125


Table of Contents

The Company’s aged financing receivables are as follows:

 

     As at December 31, 2012  
     Current      30-89 Days      90+ Days      Billed
Financing
Receivables
     Related
Unbilled
Recorded
Investment
     Total
Recorded
Investment
     Related
Allowances
    Recorded
Investment
Net of
Allowances
 

Net investment in leases

   $ 144      $ 202      $ 1,240      $ 1,586      $ 12,589      $ 14,175      $ (1,130   $ 13,045  

Net financed sales receivables

     1,063        670        1,267        3,000        78,214        81,214        (66     81,148  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,207      $ 872      $ 2,507      $ 4,586      $ 90,803      $ 95,389      $ (1,196   $ 94,193  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     As at December 31, 2011  
     Current      30-89 Days      90+ Days      Billed
Financing
Receivables
     Related
Unbilled
Recorded
Investment
     Total
Recorded
Investment
     Related
Allowances
    Recorded
Investment
Net of
Allowances
 

Net investment in leases

   $ 350      $ 261      $ 1,754      $ 2,365      $ 18,882      $ 21,247      $ (1,833   $ 19,414  

Net financed sales receivables

     723        593        1,029        2,345        65,270        67,616        (316     67,300  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,073      $ 854      $ 2,783      $ 4,710      $ 84,152      $ 88,863      $ (2,149   $ 86,714  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

The Company’s recorded investment in past due financing receivables for which the Company continues to accrue finance income is as follows:

 

     As at December 31, 2012  
     Current      30-89 Days      90+ Days      Billed
Financing
Receivables
     Related
Unbilled
Recorded
Investment
     Related
Allowance
     Recorded
Investment
Past Due
and
Accruing
 

Net investment in leases

   $ 11      $ 59      $ 23      $ 93      $ 1,449      $ —        $ 1,542  

Net financed sales receivables

     223        382        864        1,469        16,173        —          17,642  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 234      $ 441      $ 887      $ 1,562      $ 17,622      $ —        $ 19,184  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     As at December 31, 2011  
     Current      30-89 Days      90+ Days      Billed
Financing
Receivables
     Related
Unbilled
Recorded
Investment
     Related
Allowance
     Recorded
Investment
Past Due
and
Accruing
 

Net investment in leases

   $ 67      $ 118      $ 144      $ 329      $ 3,766      $ —        $ 4,095  

Net financed sales receivables

     202        345        674        1,221        16,343        —          17,564  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 269      $ 463      $ 818      $ 1,550      $ 20,109      $ —        $ 21,659  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

126


Table of Contents

The Company considers financing receivables to be impaired when it believes it to be probable that it will not recover the full amount of principal or interest owing under the arrangement. The Company uses its knowledge of the industry and economic trends, as well as its prior experiences to determine the amount recoverable for impaired financing receivables. The following table discloses information regarding the Company’s impaired financing receivables:

 

     Impaired Financing Receivables
For the Year Ended December 31, 2012
 
     Recorded
Investment
     Unpaid
Principal
     Related
Allowance
    Average
Recorded
Investment
     Interest
Income
Recognized
 

Recorded investment for which there is a related allowance:

             

Net financed sales receivables

   $ 187      $ 220      $ (66   $ 201      $ —    

Recorded investment for which there is no related allowance:

             

Net financed sales receivables

     377        13        —         479        22  

Total recorded investment in impaired loans:

             
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net financed sales receivables

   $ 564      $ 233      $ (66   $ 680      $ 22  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
     Impaired Financing Receivables
For the Year Ended December 31, 2011
 
     Recorded
Investment
     Unpaid
Principal
     Related
Allowance
    Average
Recorded
Investment
     Interest
Income
Recognized
 

Recorded investment for which there is a related allowance:

             

Net financed sales receivables

   $ 927      $ 402      $ (316   $ 972      $ —    

Total recorded investment in impaired loans:

             
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net financed sales receivables

   $ 927      $ 402      $ (316   $ 972      $ —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Company’s activity in the allowance for credit losses for the period and the Company’s recorded investment in financing receivables is as follows:

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2012  
     Net Investment
in Leases
    Net Financed
Sales Receivables
 

Allowance for credit losses:

    

Beginning balance

   $ 1,833     $ 316  

Charge-offs

     (1,019     (109 )(1) 

Provision

     316       (141
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 1,130     $ 66  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment

   $ 1,130     $ 66  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing receivables:

    

Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment

   $ 14,174     $ 81,215  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

127


Table of Contents
     Year Ended December 31, 2011  
     Net Investment
in Leases
    Net Financed
Sales Receivables
 

Allowance for credit losses:

    

Beginning balance

   $ 4,838     $ 66  

Charge-offs

     (4,526     —    

Provision

     1,521       250  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 1,833     $ 316  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment

   $ 1,833     $ 316  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing receivables:

    

Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment

   $ 21,247     $ 67,616  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) As a result of a troubled debt restructuring in the year ended December 31, 2012, the Company recorded a $0.1 million write-down on a $0.5 million recorded investment.

(d) Foreign Exchange Risk Management

The Company is exposed to market risk from changes in foreign currency rates. A majority portion of the Company’s revenues is denominated in U.S. dollars while a substantial portion of its costs and expenses is denominated in Canadian dollars. A portion of the net U.S. dollar cash flows of the Company is periodically converted to Canadian dollars to fund Canadian dollar expenses through the spot market. In Japan, the Company has ongoing operating expenses related to its operations in Japanese yen. Net Japanese yen cash flows are converted to U.S. dollars generally through the spot market. The Company also has cash receipts under leases denominated in Chinese Renminbi, Japanese yen, Canadian dollar and Euros which are converted to U.S. dollars generally through the spot market. The Company’s policy is to not use any financial instruments for trading or other speculative purposes.

The Company entered into a series of foreign currency forward contracts to manage the Company’s risks associated with the volatility of foreign currencies. Certain of these foreign currency forward contracts met the criteria required for hedge accounting under the Derivatives and Hedging Topic of the FASB ASC at inception, and continue to meet hedge effectiveness tests at December 31, 2012 (the “Foreign Currency Hedges”), with settlement dates throughout 2013. Foreign currency derivatives are recognized and measured in the balance sheet at fair value. Changes in the fair value (gains or losses) are recognized in the consolidated statement of operations except for derivatives designated and qualifying as foreign currency hedging instruments. For foreign currency hedging instruments, the effective portion of the gain or loss in a hedge of a forecasted transaction is reported in other comprehensive income and reclassified to the consolidated statement of operations when the forecasted transaction occurs. Any ineffective portion is recognized immediately in the consolidated statement of operations.

The following tabular disclosures reflect the impact that derivative instruments and hedging activities have on the Company’s consolidated financial statements:

 

128


Table of Contents

Notional value of foreign exchange contracts:

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012      2011  

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments:

     

Foreign exchange contracts — Forwards

   $ 8,069      $ 20,581  

Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:

     

Foreign exchange contracts — Forwards

     —          67,341  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 8,069      $ 87,922  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fair value of derivatives in foreign exchange contracts:

 

          As at December 31,  
    

Balance Sheet Location

   2012      2011  

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments:

        

Foreign exchange contracts — Forwards

   Other assets (Accrued liabilities)    $ 297      $ (182

Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:

        

Foreign exchange contracts — Forwards

   Accrued liabilities      —          (645
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
      $ 297      $ (827
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Derivatives in Foreign Currency Hedging relationships are as follows:

 

          Years Ended December 31,  
          2012      2011     2010  

Foreign exchange contracts—Forwards

   Derivative Gain (Loss) Recognized in OCI (Effective Portion)    $ 716      $ (162   $ 797  
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
      $ 716      $ (162   $ 797  
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
    

Location of Derivative Gain

Reclassified from AOCI

into Income (Effective Portion)

   Years Ended December 31,  
        2012      2011     2010  

Foreign exchange contracts—Forwards

   Selling, general and administrative expenses    $ 236      $ 684     $ 665  
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
      $ 236      $ 684     $ 665  
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non Designated Derivatives in Foreign Currency relationships are as follows:

 

    

Location of Derivative Gain (Loss)

   Years Ended December 31,  
         2012      2011     2010  

Foreign exchange contracts—Forwards

   Selling, general and administrative expenses    $ 1,184      $ (1,014   $ 2,036  
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
      $ 1,184      $ (1,014   $ 2,036  
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

129


Table of Contents

(e) Investments in New Business Ventures

The Company accounts for investments in new business ventures using the guidance of the FASB ASC 323 and the FASB ASC 320, as appropriate. As at December 31, 2012, the equity method of accounting is being utilized for an investment with a carrying value of $3.1 million (December 31, 2011 — $4.1 million). For the year ended December 31, 2012, gross revenues, cost of revenue and net loss for the investment were $9.0 million, $12.7 million and $13.4 million, respectively (2011 — $2.3 million, $9.8 million, and $17.7 million, respectively). The Company has determined it is not the primary beneficiary of this VIE, and therefore it has not been consolidated. The difference between the Company’s investment balance and the amount of underlying equity in net assets owned by the Company amounts to $1.1 million and relates to goodwill. In addition, the Company has an investment in preferred stock of another business venture of $1.5 million which meets the criteria for classification as a debt security under the FASB ASC 320 and is recorded at its fair value of $1.3 million at December 31, 2012 (December 31, 2011 — $1.0 million). In the year ended December 31, 2012, the Company recognized an other-than-temporary impairment for its investment of $0.2 million (2011 — $nil). This investment is classified as an available-for-sale investment. The total carrying value of investments in new business ventures at December 31, 2012 and 2011 is $4.4 million and $5.1 million, respectively, and is recorded in Other Assets.

22. Employees’ Pension and Postretirement Benefits

(a) Defined Benefit Plan

The Company has an unfunded U.S. defined benefit pension plan, the SERP, covering Richard L. Gelfond, Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”) of the Company and Bradley J. Wechsler, Chairman of the Company’s Board of Directors. The SERP provides for a lifetime retirement benefit from age 55 determined as 75% of the member’s best average 60 consecutive months of earnings over the member’s employment history. The benefits were 50% vested as at July 2000, the SERP initiation date. The vesting percentage increases on a straight-line basis from inception until age 55. As at December 31, 2010, the benefits of Mr. Gelfond were 100% vested. Upon a termination for cause, prior to a change of control, the executive shall forfeit any and all benefits to which such executive may have been entitled, whether or not vested.

Under the terms of the SERP, if Mr. Gelfond’s employment is terminated other than for cause, he is entitled to receive SERP benefits in the form of a lump sum payment. SERP benefit payments to Mr. Gelfond are subject to a deferral for six months after the termination of his employment, at which time Mr. Gelfond will be entitled to receive interest on the deferred amount credited at the applicable federal rate for short-term obligations. The term of Mr. Gelfond’s current employment agreement has been extended through December 31, 2013, although Mr. Gelfond has not informed the Company that he intends to retire at that time. Under the terms of the extension, Mr. Gelfond also agreed that any compensation earned during 2011, 2012 and 2013 would not be included in calculating his entitlement under the SERP.

In 2010, under the terms of the SERP, the Company made a lump sum payment of $14.7 million to Mr. Wechsler in accordance with the terms of the plan, representing a settlement in full of Mr. Wechsler’s entitlement under the SERP.

The following assumptions were used to determine the obligation and cost status of the Company’s SERP at the plan measurement dates:

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012     2011  

Discount rate

     0.96     1.43

Lump sum interest rate:

    

First 25 years

     n/a        n/a   

First 20 years

     2.67     3.74

Thereafter

     3.01     3.70

Cost of living adjustment on benefits

     1.20     1.20

Rate of increase in qualifying compensation levels

     0.00     0.00

 

130


Table of Contents

The amounts accrued for the SERP are determined as follows:

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011  

Projected benefit obligation:

     

Obligation, beginning of year

   $ 18,990      $ 18,108  

Interest cost

     272        279  

Actuarial loss

     1,104        603  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Obligation, end of year and unfunded status

   $ 20,366      $ 18,990  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following table provides disclosure of the pension benefit obligation recorded in the consolidated balance sheets:

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012     2011  

Accrued benefits cost

   $ (20,366   $ (18,990

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

     3,367        2,628  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net amount recognized in the consolidated balance sheets

   $ (16,999   $ (16,362
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table provides disclosure of pension expense for the SERP for the year ended December 31:

 

     Years ended December 31  
     2012      2011      2010  

Service cost

   $ —        $ —        $ 448  

Interest cost

     272        279        351  

Amortization of actuarial loss

     365        214        —    

Realized actuarial gain of settlement of pension liability

     —          —          (385
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Pension expense

   $ 637      $ 493      $ 414  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The accumulated benefit obligation for the SERP was $20.4 million at December 31, 2012 (2011 — $19.0 million).

The following amounts were included in accumulated other comprehensive income and will be recognized as components of net periodic benefit cost in future periods:

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012      2011      2010  

Unrecognized actuarial loss

   $ 3,367      $ 2,628      $ 2,239  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

No contributions were made for the SERP during 2012. The Company expects interest costs of $0.2 million and amortization of actuarial losses of $0.4 million to be recognized as a component of net periodic benefit cost in 2013.

The following benefit payments are expected to be made as per the current SERP assumptions and the terms of the SERP in each of the next five years, and in the aggregate:

 

2013

   $ —    

2014

     21,058  

2015

     —    

2016

     —    

2017

     —    

Thereafter

     —    
  

 

 

 
   $ 21,058  
  

 

 

 

 

131


Table of Contents

(b) Defined Contribution Pension Plan

The Company also maintains defined contribution pension plans for its employees, including its executive officers. The Company makes contributions to these plans on behalf of employees in an amount up to 5% of their base salary subject to certain prescribed maximums. During 2012, the Company contributed and expensed an aggregate of $1.1 million (2011 — $1.0 million, 2010 — $0.9 million) to its Canadian plan and an aggregate of $0.3 million (2011 — $0.2 million, 2010 — $0.2 million) to its defined contribution employee pension plan under Section 401(k) of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code.

(c) Postretirement Benefits—Executives

The Company has an unfunded postretirement plan for Messrs. Gelfond and Wechsler. The plan provides that the Company will maintain health benefits for Messrs. Gelfond and Wechsler until they become eligible for Medicare and, thereafter, the Company will provide Medicare supplemental coverage as selected by Messrs. Gelfond and Wechsler.

The amounts accrued for the plan are determined as follows:

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012      2011  

Obligation, beginning of year

   $ 502      $ 476  

Interest cost

     13        26  

Actuarial loss

     9        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Obligation, end of year

   $ 524      $ 502  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following details the net cost components, all related to continuing operations, and underlying assumptions of postretirement benefits other than pensions:

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011      2010  

Interest cost

   $ 13      $ 26      $ 26  

Actuarial loss (gain)

     9        —          (6
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 22      $ 26      $ 20  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Weighted average assumptions used to determine the benefit obligation are:

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012     2011     2010  

Discount rate

     3.75      4.20      5.30 

Weighted average assumptions used to determine the net postretirement benefit expense are:

 

     Years Ended December 31  
     2012     2011     2010  

Discount rate

     4.50      4.50      4.50 

The following benefit payments are expected to be made as per the current plan assumptions in each of the next five years:

 

2013

   $ 18  

2014

   $ 19  

2015

   $ 21  

2016

   $ 44  

2017

   $ 30  

Thereafter

   $ 392  
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 524  
  

 

 

 

 

132


Table of Contents

(d) Postretirement Benefits – Canadian Employees

The Company has an unfunded postretirement plan for its Canadian employees upon meeting specific eligibility requirements. The Company will provide eligible participants, upon retirement, with health and welfare benefits.

The amounts accrued for the plan are determined as follows:

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012      2011  

Obligation, beginning of year

   $ 4,052      $ 3,440  

Interest cost

     194        183  

Service cost

     231        195  

Actuarial loss

     129        234  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Obligation, end of year

   $ 4,606      $ 4,052  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The following details the net cost components, all related to continuing operations, and underlying assumptions of postretirement benefits other than pensions:

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011      2010  

Interest cost

   $ 194      $ 183      $ 168  

Service cost

     231        195        160  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 425      $ 378      $ 328  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Weighted average assumptions used to determine the benefit obligation and net postretirement benefit expense are:

 

     As at December 31,  
     2012     2011     2010  

Discount rate

     4.00      4.50      5.00 

The following benefit payments are expected to be made as per the current plan assumptions in each of the next five years:

 

2013

   $ 65  

2014

   $ 60  

2015

   $ 67  

2016

   $ 84  

2017

   $ 98  

Thereafter

   $ 4,232  
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 4,606  
  

 

 

 

In February 2013, the Company amended the Canadian postretirement plan to reduce future benefits provided under the plan. As a result of this change, the Company anticipates the postretirement liability to be reduced by $2.7 million, resulting in a pre-tax curtailment gain in the first quarter of 2013 of approximately $2.4 million.

 

133


Table of Contents

23. Asset Retirement Obligations

The Company has accrued costs related to obligations in respect of required reversion costs for its owned and operated theaters under long-term real estate leases which will become due in the future. The Company does not have any legal restrictions with respect to settling any of these long-term leases. A reconciliation of the Company’s liability in respect of required reversion costs is shown below:

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2012      2011     2010  

Beginning balance, January 1

   $ 230      $ 286     $ 267  

Accretion expense

     19        17       19  

Reduction in asset retirement obligation due to lease renegotiation

     —          (73     —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance, December 31

   $ 249      $ 230     $ 286  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

134


Table of Contents
Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

None

 

Item 9A. Controls and Procedures

EVALUATION OF DISCLOSURE CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

The Company maintains disclosure controls and procedures designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in reports filed under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the specified time periods and that such information is accumulated and communicated to management, including the CEO and CFO, to allow timely discussions regarding required disclosure. There are inherent limitations to the effectiveness of any system of disclosure controls and procedures, including the possibility of human error and the circumvention or overriding of the controls and procedures. Accordingly, even effective disclosure controls and procedures can only provide reasonable assurance of achieving their control objectives.

The Company’s management, with the participation of its CEO and its CFO, has evaluated the effectiveness of the Company’s “disclosure controls and procedures” (as defined in the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 Rules 13a-15(e) or 15d-15(e)) as at December 31, 2012 and has concluded that, as of the end of the period covered by this report, the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures was effective. The Company will continue to periodically evaluate its disclosure controls and procedures and will make modifications from time to time as deemed necessary to ensure that information is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms.

MANAGEMENT’S ANNUAL REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for the Company.

Management has used the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”) framework in Internal Control-Integrated Framework to assess the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

Management has assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting, as at December 31, 2012, and has concluded that such internal control over financial reporting was effective as at that date.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP has audited the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as at December 31, 2012 as stated in their report on page 78.

CHANGES IN INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

There were no changes in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting which occurred during the quarter ended December 31, 2012, that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

Item 9B. Other Information

None.

 

135


Table of Contents

PART III

 

Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

The information required by Item 10 is incorporated by reference from the information under the following captions in the Company’s Proxy Statement: “Item No. 1—Election of Directors;” “Executive Officers;” “Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance;” “Code of Ethics;” and “Audit Committee.”

 

Item 11. Executive Compensation

The information required by Item 11 is incorporated by reference from the information under the following captions in the Company’s Proxy Statement: “Compensation Discussion and Analysis;” “Summary Compensation Table;” “Grant of Plan-Based Awards;” “Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End;” “Options Exercised;” “Pension Benefits;” “Employment Agreements and Potential Payments upon Termination or Change-in-Control;” “Compensation of Directors;” and “Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation.”

 

Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

The information required by Item 12 is incorporated by reference from the information under the following captions in the Company’s Proxy Statement: “Equity Compensation Plans;” “Principal Shareholders of Voting Shares;” and “Security Ownership of Directors and Management.”

 

Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

The information required by Item 13 is incorporated by reference from the information under the following caption in the Company’s Proxy Statement: “Certain Relationships and Related Transactions,” “Review, Approval and Ratification of Transactions with Related Persons,” and “Director Independence.”

 

Item 14. Principal Accounting Fees and Services

The information required by Item 14 is incorporated by reference from the information under the following captions in the Company’s Proxy Statement: “Audit Fees;” “Audit-Related Fees;” “Tax Fees;” “All Other Fees;” and “Audit Committee’s Pre-Approved Policies and Procedures.”

PART IV

 

Item 15. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

(a)(1) Financial Statements

The consolidated financial statements filed as part of this Report are included under Item 8 in Part II.

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm, which covers both the financial statements and financial statement schedule in (a)(2), is included under Item 8 in Part II.

(a)(2) Financial Statement Schedules

Financial statement schedule for each year in the three-year period ended December 31, 2012.

II. Valuation and Qualifying Accounts.

(a)(3) Exhibits

The items listed as Exhibits 10.1 to 10.26 relate to management contracts or compensatory plans or arrangements.

 

136


Table of Contents

Exhibit

No.

    

Description

  3.1       Articles of Amalgamation of IMAX Corporation, dated January 1, 2002, as amended by the Articles of Amendment of IMAX Corporation, dated June 25, 2004. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to IMAX Corporation’s Registration statement on Form S-3 (File No. 333-157300).
  3.2       By-Law No. 1 of IMAX Corporation enacted on June 3, 2004. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2009 (File No. 000-24216).
  *4.1       Shareholders’ Agreement, dated as of January 3, 1994, among WGIM Acquisition Corporation, the Selling Shareholders as defined therein, Wasserstein Perella Partners, L.P., Wasserstein Perella Offshore Partners, L.P., Bradley J. Wechsler, Richard L. Gelfond and Douglas Trumbull (the “Selling Shareholders’ Agreement”).
  *4.2       Amendment, dated as of March 1, 1994, to the Selling Shareholders’ Agreement.
  *4.3       Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of February 9, 1999, by and among IMAX Corporation, Wasserstein Perella Partners, L.P., Wasserstein Perella Offshore Partners, L.P., WPPN Inc., the Michael J. Biondi Voting Trust, Bradley J. Wechsler and Richard L. Gelfond.
  10.1       Stock Option Plan of IMAX Corporation, dated June 18, 2008. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to IMAX Corporation Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2010 (File No. 001-35066).
  *10.2       IMAX Corporation Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan, as amended and restated as of January 1, 2006.
  *10.3       Employment Agreement, dated July 1, 1998, between IMAX Corporation and Bradley J. Wechsler.
  *10.4       Amended Employment Agreement, dated July 12, 2000, between IMAX Corporation and Bradley J. Wechsler.
  10.5       Amended Employment Agreement, dated March 8, 2006, between IMAX Corporation and Bradley J. Wechsler. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2011 (File No. 001-35066).
  10.6       Amended Employment Agreement, dated February 15, 2007, between IMAX Corporation and Bradley, J. Wechsler. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2011 (File No. 001-35066).
  10.7       Amended Employment Agreement, dated December 31, 2007, between IMAX Corporation and Bradley J. Wechsler. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007 (File No. 000-24216).
  10.8       Services Agreement, dated December 11, 2008, between IMAX Corporation and Bradley J. Wechsler. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008 (File No. 000-24216).
  10.9       Services Agreement Amendment, dated February 14, 2011, between IMAX Corporation and Bradley J. Wechsler. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.9 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2010 (File No. 001-35066).
  *10.10       Employment Agreement, dated July 1, 1998, between IMAX Corporation and Richard L. Gelfond.
  *10.11       Amended Employment Agreement, dated July 12, 2000, between IMAX Corporation and Richard L. Gelfond.
  10.12       Amended Employment Agreement, dated March 8, 2006, between IMAX Corporation and Richard L. Gelfond. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.12 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2011 (File No. 001-35066).
  10.13       Amended Employment Agreement, dated February 15, 2007, between IMAX Corporation and Richard L. Gelfond. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.13 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2011 (File No. 001-35066).
  10.14       Amended Employment Agreement, dated December 31, 2007, between IMAX Corporation and Richard L. Gelfond. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.12 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007 (File No. 000-24216).
  10.15       Amended Employment Agreement, dated December 11, 2008, between IMAX Corporation and Richard L. Gelfond. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.14 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008 (File No. 000-2416).
  10.16       Amended Employment Agreement, dated December 20, 2010, between IMAX Corporation and Richard L. Gelfond. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.16 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2010 (File No. 001-35066).
  10.17       Amended Employment Agreement, dated December 12, 2011, between IMAX Corporation and Richard L. Gelfond.

 

137


Table of Contents
   Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.17 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2011 (File No. 001-35066).
  10.18       Employment Agreement, dated March 9, 2006, between IMAX Corporation and Greg Foster. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.18 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2011 (File No. 001-35066).
  10.19       First Amending Agreement, dated December 31, 2007, between IMAX Corporation and Greg Foster. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.14 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007 (File No. 000-24216).
  10.20       Second Amending Agreement, dated April 29, 2010, between IMAX Corporation and Greg Foster. Incorporated by reference to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2010 (File No. 000-24216).
  *10.21       Employment Agreement, dated May 14, 2007, between IMAX Corporation and Joseph Sparacio.
  10.22       First Amending Agreement, dated May 14, 2009, between IMAX Corporation and Joseph Sparacio. Incorporated by reference to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2009 (File No. 000-24216).
  10.23       Second Amending Agreement, dated May 14, 2010, between IMAX Corporation and Joseph Sparacio. Incorporated by reference to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2010 (File No. 000-24216).
  10.24       Third Amending Agreement, dated January 23, 2012, between IMAX Corporation and Joseph Sparacio. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.24 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2011 (File No. 001-35066).
  10.25       Summary of Employment Agreement, effective October 3, 2011 between IMAX Corporation and Mark Welton. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.38 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2011 (File No. 001-35066).
  10.26       Statement of Directors’ Compensation, dated June 5, 2012. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.26 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2012 (File No. 001-35066).
  10.27       Second Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated June 2, 2011 by and between IMAX Corporation, Wells Fargo Capital Finance Corporation and Export Development Canada. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.37 to IMAX Corporation Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 20, 2011 (File No. 001-35066).
  *10.28       Third Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated February 7, 2013, by and between IMAX Corporation, the Guarantors referred to therein, the Lenders referred to therein, Wells Fargo Bank National Association and Wells Fargo Securities, LLC.
  10.29       Securities Purchase Agreement, dated as of May 5, 2008, by and between IMAX Corporation, Douglas Family Trust, James Douglas and Jean Douglas Irrevocable Descendants’ Trust, James E. Douglas, III, and K&M Douglas Trust. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.32 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2008 (File No. 000-24216).
  10.30       Amendment No. 1 to Securities Purchase Agreement, dated December 1, 2008, by and between IMAX Corporation, Douglas Family Trust, James Douglas and Jean Douglas Irrevocable Descendants’ Trust, James E. Douglas, III, and K&M Douglas Trust. Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.34 to IMAX Corporation’s Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008 (File No. 000-24216).
  *21       Subsidiaries of IMAX Corporation.
  *23       Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP.
  *24       Power of Attorney of certain directors.
  *31.1       Certification Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes—Oxley Act of 2002, dated February 21, 2013, by Richard L. Gelfond.
  *31.2       Certification Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes—Oxley Act of 2002, dated February 21, 2013, by Joseph Sparacio.
  *32.1       Certification Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes—Oxley Act of 2002, dated February 21, 2013, by Richard L. Gelfond.
  *32.2       Certification Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes—Oxley Act of 2002, dated February 21, 2013, by Joseph Sparacio.

 

* Filed herewith

 

138


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

IMAX CORPORATION
By   /s/ JOSEPH SPARACIO
  Joseph Sparacio
  Executive Vice-President & Chief Financial Officer

Date: February 21, 2013

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities indicated on February 21, 2013.

 

/S/ RICHARD L. GELFOND

Richard L. Gelfond

Chief Executive Officer & Director (Principal Executive Officer)

  

/S/ JOSEPH SPARACIO

Joseph Sparacio

Executive Vice President & Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial Officer)

 

/S/ JEFFREY VANCE

Jeffrey Vance

Senior Vice-President,

Finance & Controller

(Principal Accounting Officer)

*

Bradley J. Wechsler

Chairman of the Board & Director

  

*

Neil S. Braun

Director

 

*

David W. Leebron

Director

*

Eric A. Demirian

Director

  

*

Garth M. Girvan

Director

 

*

Marc A. Utay

Director

*

Martin Pompadur

Director

    

 

By   * /s/ JOSEPH SPARACIO
  Joseph Sparacio
  (as attorney-in-fact)

 

139


Table of Contents

IMAX CORPORATION

Schedule II

Valuation and Qualifying Accounts

(In thousands of U.S. dollars)

 

      Balance
at
beginning
of year
     Additions/
(recoveries)
charged to
expenses
    Other
additions/
(deductions)(1)
    Balance at
end of year
 

Allowance for net investment in leases

         

Year ended December 31, 2010

   $ 5,734      $ 1,056     $ (1,952   $ 4,838  

Year ended December 31, 2011

   $ 4,838      $ 1,519     $ (4,526   $ 1,831  

Year ended December 31, 2012

   $ 1,831      $ (1,018   $ 317     $ 1,130  

Allowance for financed sale receivables

         

Year ended December 31, 2010

   $ 178      $ (112   $ —       $ 66  

Year ended December 31, 2011

   $ 66      $ —       $ 250     $ 316  

Year ended December 31, 2012

   $ 316      $ (109   $ (141   $ 66  

Allowance for doubtful accounts receivable

         

Year ended December 31, 2010

   $ 2,770      $ 499     $ (1,281   $ 1,988  

Year ended December 31, 2011

   $ 1,988      $ 788     $ (936   $ 1,840  

Year ended December 31, 2012

   $ 1,840      $ 606     $ (882   $ 1,564  

Inventories valuation allowance

         

Year ended December 31, 2010

   $ 3,750      $ 665     $ (16   $ 4,399  

Year ended December 31, 2011

   $ 4,399      $ —       $ (382   $ 4,017  

Year ended December 31, 2012

   $ 4,017      $ 552     $ (151   $ 4,418  

Deferred income tax valuation allowance

         

Year ended December 31, 2010

   $ 77,999      $ (68,220   $ (1,850   $ 7,929  

Year ended December 31, 2011

   $ 7,929      $ (1,264   $ (611   $ 6,054  

Year ended December 31, 2012

   $ 6,054      $ 93     $ (34   $ 6,113  

 

(1) Deductions represent write-offs of amounts previously charged to the provision.

 

140